Etsi TS 127 007

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 188

ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.

0 (2008-04)
Technical Specification
Digital cellular telecommunications system (Phase 2+);
Universal Mobile Telecommunications System (UMTS);
AT command set for User Equipment (UE)
(3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8)


GLOBAL SYSTEM FOR
MOBILE COMMUNICATIONS
R



ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 1 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8



Reference
RTS/TSGC-0127007v830
Keywords
GSM, UMTS
ETSI
650 Route des Lucioles
F-06921 Sophia Antipolis Cedex - FRANCE

Tel.: +33 4 92 94 42 00 Fax: +33 4 93 65 47 16

Siret N348 623 562 00017 - NAF 742 C
Association but non lucratif enregistre la
Sous-Prfecture de Grasse (06) N7803/88

Important notice
Individual copies of the present document can be downloaded from:
http://www.etsi.org
The present document may be made available in more than one electronic version or in print. In any case of existing or
perceived difference in contents between such versions, the reference version is the Portable Document Format (PDF).
In case of dispute, the reference shall be the printing on ETSI printers of the PDF version kept on a specific network drive
within ETSI Secretariat.
Users of the present document should be aware that the document may be subject to revision or change of status.
Information on the current status of this and other ETSI documents is available at
http://portal.etsi.org/tb/status/status.asp
If you find errors in the present document, please send your comment to one of the following services:
http://portal.etsi.org/chaircor/ETSI_support.asp
Copyright Notification
No part may be reproduced except as authorized by written permission.
The copyright and the foregoing restriction extend to reproduction in all media.

European Telecommunications Standards Institute 2008.
All rights reserved.

DECT
TM
, PLUGTESTS
TM
, UMTS
TM
, TIPHON
TM
, the TIPHON logo and the ETSI logo are Trade Marks of ETSI registered
for the benefit of its Members.
3GPP
TM
is a Trade Mark of ETSI registered for the benefit of its Members and of the 3GPP Organizational Partners.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 2 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Intellectual Property Rights
IPRs essential or potentially essential to the present document may have been declared to ETSI. The information
pertaining to these essential IPRs, if any, is publicly available for ETSI members and non-members, and can be found
in ETSI SR 000 314: "Intellectual Property Rights (IPRs); Essential, or potentially Essential, IPRs notified to ETSI in
respect of ETSI standards", which is available from the ETSI Secretariat. Latest updates are available on the ETSI Web
server (http://webapp.etsi.org/IPR/home.asp).
Pursuant to the ETSI IPR Policy, no investigation, including IPR searches, has been carried out by ETSI. No guarantee
can be given as to the existence of other IPRs not referenced in ETSI SR 000 314 (or the updates on the ETSI Web
server) which are, or may be, or may become, essential to the present document.
Foreword
This Technical Specification (TS) has been produced by ETSI 3rd Generation Partnership Project (3GPP).
The present document may refer to technical specifications or reports using their 3GPP identities, UMTS identities or
GSM identities. These should be interpreted as being references to the corresponding ETSI deliverables.
The cross reference between GSM, UMTS, 3GPP and ETSI identities can be found under
http://webapp.etsi.org/key/queryform.asp.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 3 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Contents
Intellectual Property Rights ................................................................................................................................2
Foreword.............................................................................................................................................................2
Foreword.............................................................................................................................................................7
1 Scope........................................................................................................................................................8
2 References ................................................................................................................................................9
3 Definitions and abbreviations.................................................................................................................13
3.1 Definitions........................................................................................................................................................13
3.2 Abbreviations ...................................................................................................................................................13
4 AT command syntax ..............................................................................................................................14
4.1 Command line ..................................................................................................................................................14
4.2 Information responses and result codes............................................................................................................15
4.3 ITU-T V.250 [14] TE-TA interface commands ...............................................................................................15
5 General commands.................................................................................................................................16
5.1 Request manufacturer identification +CGMI ...................................................................................................16
5.2 Request model identification +CGMM............................................................................................................16
5.3 Request revision identification +CGMR..........................................................................................................17
5.4 Request product serial number identification +CGSN.....................................................................................17
5.5 Select TE character set +CSCS ........................................................................................................................18
5.6 Request international mobile subscriber identity +CIMI .................................................................................19
5.7 Multiplexing mode +CMUX............................................................................................................................19
5.8 ITU-T V.250 [14] generic TA control commands............................................................................................22
5.9 PCCA STD-101 [17] select wireless network +WS46.....................................................................................22
5.10 Informative examples .......................................................................................................................................23
6 Call control commands and methods .....................................................................................................24
6.1 Select type of address +CSTA..........................................................................................................................24
6.2 ITU-T V.250 [14] dial command D..................................................................................................................24
6.3 Direct dialling from phonebooks......................................................................................................................25
6.4 Call mode +CMOD..........................................................................................................................................26
6.4A Voice Call Mode +CVMOD ............................................................................................................................26
6.5 Hangup call +CHUP.........................................................................................................................................27
6.6 Alternating mode call control method..............................................................................................................27
6.7 Select bearer service type +CBST....................................................................................................................29
6.8 Radio link protocol +CRLP..............................................................................................................................31
6.9 Service reporting control +CR..........................................................................................................................32
6.10 Extended error report +CEER..........................................................................................................................32
6.11 Cellular result codes +CRC..............................................................................................................................33
6.12 HSCSD device parameters +CHSD .................................................................................................................34
6.13 HSCSD transparent call configuration +CHST................................................................................................35
6.14 HSCSD non-transparent call configuration +CHSN........................................................................................36
6.15 HSCSD current call parameters +CHSC..........................................................................................................36
6.16 HSCSD parameters report +CHSR ..................................................................................................................37
6.17 HSCSD automatic user initiated upgrading + CHSU.......................................................................................38
6.18 HSCSD non-transparent asymmetry configuration +CHSA............................................................................38
6.19 Single numbering scheme +CSNS ...................................................................................................................39
6.20 Voice Hangup Control +CVHU.......................................................................................................................40
6.21 V.120 rate adaption protocol +CV120 .............................................................................................................40
6.22 Settings date format +CSDF.............................................................................................................................41
6.23 Silence Command +CSIL.................................................................................................................................42
6.24 Settings time format +CSTF.............................................................................................................................43
6.25 ITU-T V.250 [14] call control commands........................................................................................................44
6.26 ITU-T V.250 [14] data compression commands ..............................................................................................44
6.27 Informative examples .......................................................................................................................................44

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 4 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
7 Network service related commands .......................................................................................................45
7.1 Subscriber number +CNUM............................................................................................................................45
7.2 Network registration +CREG...........................................................................................................................46
7.3 PLMN selection +COPS ..................................................................................................................................48
7.4 Facility lock +CLCK........................................................................................................................................49
7.5 Change password +CPWD...............................................................................................................................51
7.6 Calling line identification presentation +CLIP.................................................................................................52
7.7 Calling line identification restriction +CLIR....................................................................................................53
7.8 Connected line identification presentation +COLP..........................................................................................54
7.9 Called line identification presentation +CDIP..................................................................................................54
7.10 Closed user group +CCUG...............................................................................................................................55
7.11 Call forwarding number and conditions +CCFC..............................................................................................56
7.12 Call waiting +CCWA.......................................................................................................................................58
7.13 Call related supplementary services +CHLD...................................................................................................59
7.14 Call deflection +CTFR.....................................................................................................................................60
7.15 Unstructured supplementary service data +CUSD...........................................................................................61
7.16 Advice of Charge +CAOC...............................................................................................................................62
7.17 Supplementary service notifications +CSSN ...................................................................................................63
7.18 List current calls +CLCC .................................................................................................................................64
7.19 Preferred PLMN list +CPOL............................................................................................................................66
7.20 Selection of preferred PLMN list +CPLS.........................................................................................................67
7.21 Read operator names +COPN ..........................................................................................................................68
7.22 eMLPP Priority Registration and Interrogation +CAEMLPP..........................................................................68
7.23 eMLPP subscriptions +CPPS...........................................................................................................................69
7.24 Fast call setup conditions +CFCS.....................................................................................................................69
7.25 Automatic answer for eMLPP Service +CAAP ...............................................................................................70
7.26 User to User Signalling Service 1 +CUUS1.....................................................................................................70
7.27 Preferred network indication +CPNET ............................................................................................................72
7.28 Preferred network status +CPNSTAT..............................................................................................................73
7.29 Current Packet Switched Bearer +CPSB.........................................................................................................73
7.30 Informative examples .......................................................................................................................................74
8 Mobile Termination control and status commands ................................................................................76
8.1 Phone activity status +CPAS............................................................................................................................77
8.2 Set phone functionality +CFUN.......................................................................................................................78
8.3 Enter PIN +CPIN .............................................................................................................................................79
8.4 Battery charge +CBC .......................................................................................................................................80
8.5 Signal quality +CSQ.........................................................................................................................................81
8.6 Mobile Termination control mode +CMEC.....................................................................................................81
8.7 Keypad control +CKPD...................................................................................................................................82
8.8 Display control +CDIS.....................................................................................................................................83
8.9 Indicator control +CIND..................................................................................................................................84
8.10 Mobile Termination event reporting +CMER..................................................................................................85
8.11 Select phonebook memory storage +CPBS......................................................................................................86
8.12 Read phonebook entries +CPBR......................................................................................................................88
8.13 Find phonebook entries +CPBF .......................................................................................................................89
8.14 Write phonebook entry +CPBW......................................................................................................................91
8.15 Clock +CCLK ..................................................................................................................................................92
8.16 Alarm +CALA..................................................................................................................................................93
8.17 Generic SIM access +CSIM.............................................................................................................................94
8.18 Restricted SIM access +CRSM........................................................................................................................94
8.19 Secure control command +CSCC.....................................................................................................................96
8.20 Alert sound mode +CALM...............................................................................................................................97
8.21 Ringer sound level +CRSL...............................................................................................................................97
8.22 Vibrator mode +CVIB......................................................................................................................................98
8.23 Loudspeaker volume level +CLVL..................................................................................................................98
8.24 Mute control +CMUT ......................................................................................................................................99
8.25 Accumulated call meter +CACM.....................................................................................................................99
8.26 Accumulated call meter maximum +CAMM.................................................................................................100
8.27 Price per unit and currency table +CPUC ......................................................................................................100
8.28 Call Meter maximum event +CCWE .............................................................................................................101
8.29 Power class +CPWC ......................................................................................................................................101

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 5 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
8.30 Set Language +CLAN....................................................................................................................................102
8.31 Language Event +CLAE ................................................................................................................................103
8.32 Set Greeting Text +CSGT..............................................................................................................................104
8.33 Set Voice Mail Number +CSVM...................................................................................................................104
8.34 Ring Melody Control +CRMC.......................................................................................................................105
8.35 Ring Melody Playback +CRMP.....................................................................................................................106
8.36 Master Reset +CMAR....................................................................................................................................107
8.37 List all available AT commands +CLAC.......................................................................................................107
8.38 Delete alarm +CALD.....................................................................................................................................108
8.39 Postpone or dismiss an alarm +CAPD ...........................................................................................................108
8.40 Automatic Time Zone Update +CTZU ..........................................................................................................109
8.41 Time Zone Reporting +CTZR........................................................................................................................109
8.42 Enter protocol mode+CPROT........................................................................................................................110
8.43 Generic UICC Logical Channel access +CGLA............................................................................................111
8.44 Restricted UICC Logical Channel access +CRLA.........................................................................................112
8.45 Open Logical Channel +CCHO......................................................................................................................113
8.46 Close Logical Channel +CCHC .....................................................................................................................114
8.47 EAP authentication +CEAP ...........................................................................................................................114
8.48 EAP Retrieve Parameters +CERP..................................................................................................................116
8.49 UICC Application Discovery +CUAD...........................................................................................................116
8.50 Mobile Originated GPS Location Request +CMOLRG.................................................................................117
8.51 Informative examples ...............................................................................................................................120
9 Mobile Termination errors ...................................................................................................................123
9.1 Report Mobile Termination error +CMEE.....................................................................................................123
9.2 Mobile Termination error result code +CME ERROR...................................................................................124
9.2.1 General errors ...........................................................................................................................................124
9.2.2 GPRS-related errors..................................................................................................................................125
9.2.2.1 Errors related to a failure to perform an Attach ........................................................................................125
9.2.2.2 Errors related to a failure to Activate a Context .......................................................................................126
9.2.2.3 Other GPRS errors....................................................................................................................................126
9.2.3 VBS / VGCS and eMLPP -related errors..................................................................................................126
9.3 Informative examples .....................................................................................................................................126
10 Commands for Packet Domain.............................................................................................................127
10.1 Commands specific to MTs supporting the Packet Domain...........................................................................127
10.1.1 Define PDP Context +CGDCONT...........................................................................................................127
10.1.2 Define Secondary PDP Context +CGDSCONT.......................................................................................129
10.1.3 Traffic Flow Template +CGTFT..............................................................................................................130
10.1.4 Quality of Service Profile (Requested) +CGQREQ..................................................................................132
10.1.5 Quality of Service Profile (Minimum acceptable) +CGQMIN.................................................................134
10.1.6 3G Quality of Service Profile (Requested) +CGEQREQ.........................................................................135
10.1.7 3G Quality of Service Profile (Minimum acceptable) +CGEQMIN ........................................................138
10.1.8 3G Quality of Service Profile (Negotiated) +CGEQNEG........................................................................142
10.1.9 PS attach or detach +CGATT...................................................................................................................143
10.1.10 PDP context activate or deactivate +CGACT...........................................................................................144
10.1.11 PDP Context Modify +CGCMOD............................................................................................................145
10.1.12 Enter data state +CGDATA......................................................................................................................145
10.1.13 Configure local Octet Stream PAD parameters +CGCLOSP (Obsolete) .................................................147
10.1.14 Show PDP address +CGPADDR..............................................................................................................147
10.1.15 Automatic response to a network request for PDP context activation +CGAUTO..................................147
10.1.16 Manual response to a network request for PDP context activation +CGANS..........................................148
10.1.17 GPRS mobile station class +CGCLASS...................................................................................................150
10.1.12 Configure local triple-X PAD parameters +CGCLPAD (GPRS only) (Obsolete) ...................................151
10.1.18 Packet Domain event reporting +CGEREP ..............................................................................................151
10.1.19 GPRS network registration status +CGREG ............................................................................................152
10.1.20 Select service for MO SMS messages +CGSMS......................................................................................154
10.2 Modem compatibility commands ...................................................................................................................154
10.2.1 MT originated PDP context activation......................................................................................................154
10.2.1.1 Request Packet Domain service 'D' .....................................................................................................154
10.2.1.2 Request Packet Domain IP service 'D' ................................................................................................156
10.2.2 Network requested PDP context activation ..............................................................................................156

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 6 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
10.2.2.1 Automatic response to a network request for PDP context activation 'S0' ..........................................157
10.2.2.2 Manual acceptance of a network request for PDP context activation 'A' ............................................157
10.2.2.3 Manual rejection of a network request for PDP context activation 'H' ...............................................157
11 Commands for VGCS and VBS...........................................................................................................157
11.1 Commands specific to MTs supporting the VGCS and VBS.........................................................................158
11.1.1 Accept an incoming Voice Group or Voice Broadcast Call +CAJOIN....................................................158
11.1.2 Reject an incoming Voice Group or Voice Broadcast Call +CAREJ .......................................................158
11.1.3 Leave an ongoing Voice Group or Voice Broadcast Call +CAHLD........................................................159
11.1.4 Talker Access for Voice Group Call +CAPTT.........................................................................................159
11.1.5 Voice Group Call Uplink Status Presentation +CAULEV.......................................................................160
11.1.6 List current Voice Group and Voice Broadcast Calls +CALCC ..............................................................161
11.1.7 Voice Group or Voice Broadcast Call State Attribute Presentation +CACSP..........................................162
11.1.8 NCH Support Indication +CANCHEV.....................................................................................................163
11.1.9 Originator to Dispatcher Information +COTDI ........................................................................................163
11.2 Modem compatibility commands ...................................................................................................................164
11.2.1 Request VGCS or VBS service 'D' ...........................................................................................................164
11.2.2 Termination of an Voice Group or Voice Broadcast Call 'H' ...................................................................165
11.3 SIM Commands supporting the VGCS and VBS...........................................................................................165
11.3.1 VGCS subscriptions and GId status +CGCS ............................................................................................165
11.3.2 VBS subscriptions and GId status +CBCS ...............................................................................................166
11.4 Informative examples .....................................................................................................................................166
Annex A (normative): Summary of commands from other standards .........................................167
Annex B (normative): Summary of result codes .............................................................................169
Annex C (informative): Commands from TIA IS-101 ......................................................................171
C.1 Introduction..........................................................................................................................................171
C.2 Commands............................................................................................................................................172
C.2.1 Select mode +FCLASS ..................................................................................................................................172
C.2.2 Buffer threshold setting +VBT.......................................................................................................................172
C.2.3 Calling number ID presentation +VCID ........................................................................................................173
C.2.4 Receive gain selection +VGR ........................................................................................................................173
C.2.5 Transmit gain selection +VGT.......................................................................................................................173
C.2.6 Initialise voice parameters +VIP ....................................................................................................................174
C.2.7 Inactivity timer +VIT .....................................................................................................................................174
C.2.8 Line selection +VLS.......................................................................................................................................174
C.2.9 Receive data state +VRX ...............................................................................................................................176
C.2.10 Select compression method +VSM................................................................................................................176
C.2.11 DTMF and tone generation +VTS..................................................................................................................177
C.2.12 Tone duration +VTD......................................................................................................................................177
C.2.13 Transmit data state +VTX..............................................................................................................................178
Annex D (informative): Bibliography.................................................................................................179
Annex E (informative): Mobile originated alternating voice/data call example.............................180
Annex F (informative): Mobile terminated voice followed by data call example...........................181
Annex G (informative): Voice call example........................................................................................182
Annex H (informative): Change History ............................................................................................183
History............................................................................................................................................................187


ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 7 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Foreword
This Technical Specification (TS) has been produced by the 3
rd
Generation Partnership Project (3GPP).
The contents of the present document are subject to continuing work within the TSG and may change following formal
TSG approval. Should the TSG modify the contents of the present document, it will be re-released by the TSG with an
identifying change of release date and an increase in version number as follows:
Version x.y.z
where:
x the first digit:
1 presented to TSG for information;
2 presented to TSG for approval;
3 or greater indicates TSG approved document under change control.
y the second digit is incremented for all changes of substance, i.e. technical enhancements, corrections,
updates, etc.
z the third digit is incremented when editorial only changes have been incorporated in the document.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 8 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
1 Scope
The present document specifies a profile of AT commands and recommends that this profile be used for controlling
Mobile Termination (MT) functions and GSM/UMTS network services from a Terminal Equipment (TE) through
Terminal Adaptor (TA). The command prefix +C is reserved for Digital Cellular in ITU-T Recommendation
V.250 [14]. The present document has also the syntax details used to construct these extended GSM/UMTS commands.
Commands from ITU-T Recommendation V.250 [14] and existing digital cellular standards (TIA IS-99 [15] and TIA
IS-135 [16]) are used whenever applicable. Some of the new commands are defined such way that they can be easily
applied to MT of networks other than GSM/UMTS. ITU-T T.31 [11] and T.32 [12] fax AT commands may be used for
GSM/UMTS fax transmission from TE. GSM/UMTS Short Message Service AT commands are defined in 3GPP TS
27.005 [24]. GPRS AT commands are defined in clause 10 of this specification. The present document assumes an
abstract architecture comprising a TE (e.g. a computer) and a MT interfaced by a TA (see figure 1). The span of control
of the defined commands should allow to handle any physical implementation that this abstract architecture may lead
to:
- TA, MT and TE as three separate entities;
- TA integrated under the MT cover, and the TE implemented as a separate entity;
- TA integrated under the TE cover, and the MT implemented as a separate entity;
- TA and MT integrated under the TE cover as a single entity.
The commands described in the present document may be observed on the link between the TE and the TA. However,
most of the commands retrieve information about the MT, not about the TA.

TE TA MT
AT cmds
responses
MT control
MT status
USER & APPLICATIONS NETWORK
network messages

Figure 1: Setup
Interface between TE and TA is intended to operate over existing serial (ITU-T Recommendation V.24) cables, infrared
link, and all link types with similar behaviour. For correct operation many of the defined commands require eight bit
data and therefore it is recommended that TE-TA link is set to eight bits/ byte mode. (For infrared operation
implementation refer informative references IrDA. For embedding AT commands and data during on-line data state
refer TIA-617/ITU-T V.80.) Interface between TA and MT is dependent on the interface in the MT.
The functional blocks shown in Figure 1, using AT commands, shall follow the principles described in the interactions
handling framework 3GPP TS 23.227 [63].

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 9 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
2 References
The following documents contain provisions which, through reference in this text, constitute provisions of the present
document.
References are either specific (identified by date of publication, edition number, version number, etc.) or
non-specific.
For a specific reference, subsequent revisions do not apply.
For a non-specific reference, the latest version applies. In the case of a reference to a 3GPP document (including
a GSM document), a non-specific reference implicitly refers to the latest version of that document in the same
Release as the present document.
[1] 3GPP TS 22.002: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Bearer Services (BS) supported by a GSM
Public Land Mobile Network (PLMN)".
[2] 3GPP TS 22.003: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Teleservices supported by a GSM Public
Land Mobile Network (PLMN)".
[3] 3GPP TS 22.081: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Line identification supplementary services
- Stage 1".
[4] 3GPP TS 22.082: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Call Forwarding (CF) supplementary
services - Stage 1".
[5] 3GPP TS 22.083: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Call Waiting (CW) and Call Hold (HOLD)
supplementary services - Stage 1".
[6] 3GPP TS 22.088: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Call Barring (CB) supplementary services -
Stage 1".
[7] 3GPP TS 23.003: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Numbering, addressing and identification".
[8] 3GPP TS 24.008: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Mobile Radio Interface Layer 3
specification; Core Network Protocols-Stage 3".
[9] GSM MoU SE.13, GSM MoU Permanent Reference Document SE.13: "GSM Mobile Network
Codes and Names".
[10] ITU-T Recommendation E.212: "Identification plan for land mobile stations".
[11] ITU-T Recommendation T.31: "Asynchronous facsimile DCE control, service class 1".
[12] ITU-T Recommendation T.32: "Asynchronous facsimile DCE control, service class 2".
[13] ITU-T Recommendation T.50: "International Reference Alphabet (IRA) (Formerly International
Alphabet No. 5 or IA5) - Information technology - 7-bit coded character set for information
exchange".
[14] ITU-T Draft new Recommendation V.250: "Serial asynchronous automatic dialling and control".
[15] Telecommunications Industry Association TIA IS-99: "Data Services Option Standard for
Wideband Spread Spectrum Digital Cellular System".
[16] Telecommunications Industry Association TIA IS-135: "800 MHz Cellular Systems, TDMA
Services, Async Data and Fax".
[17] Portable Computer and Communications Association PCCA STD-101 Data Transmission Systems
and Equipment: "Serial Asynchronous Automatic Dialling and Control for Character Mode DCE
on Wireless Data Services".
[18] 3GPP TS 24.022: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Radio Link Protocol (RLP) for data and
telematic services on the Mobile Station - Base Station System (MS - BSS) interface and the Base
Station System - Mobile-services Switching Centre (BSS - MSC) interface".

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 10 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
[19] 3GPP TS 22.030: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Man Machine Interface (MMI) of the
Mobile Station (MS)".
[20] 3GPP TS 45.008: "Digital cellular telecommunication system (Phase 2+); Radio subsystem link
control".
[21] 3GPP TS 22.085: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Closed User Group (CUG) supplementary
services - Stage 1".
[22] 3GPP TS 22.084: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; MultiParty (MPTY) supplementary
services - Stage 1".
[23] 3GPP TS 22.090: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Unstructured Supplementary Service Data
(USSD) - Stage 1".
[24] 3GPP TS 27.005: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Use of Data Terminal Equipment - Data
Circuit terminating Equipment (DTE - DCE) interface for Short Message Service (SMS) and Cell
Broadcast Service (CBS)".
[25] 3GPP TS 23.038: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Alphabet and language specific
information".
[26] 3GPP TS 22.024: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Description of Charge Advice Information
(CAI)".
[27] 3GPP TS 22.086: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Advice of Charge (AoC) supplementary
services - Stage 1".
[28] 3GPP TS 51.011: "Digital cellular telecommunication system (Phase 2+); Specification of the
Subscriber Identity Module - Mobile Equipment (SIM-ME) interface".
[29] 3GPP TS 22.034: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; High Speed Circuit Switched Data
(HSCSD) - Stage 1".
[30] 3GPP TS 22.091: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Explicit Call Transfer (ECT)
supplementary service - Stage 1".
[31] 3GPP TS 22.072: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Call Deflection (CD) supplementary
service - Stage 1".
[32] ISO/IEC10646: "Universal Multiple-Octet Coded Character Set (UCS)"; UCS2, 16 bit coding.
[33] 3GPP TS 22.022: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Personalization of GSM Mobile Equipment
(ME) Mobile functionality specification".
[34] 3GPP TS 27.060: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; General requirements on Mobile Stations
(MS) supporting General Packet Radio Bearer Service (GPRS)".
[35] CCITT Recommendation V.110: "Support of data terminal equipments (DTEs) with V-Series
interfaces by an integrated services digital network".
[36] CCITT Recommendation V.120: "Support by an ISDN of data terminal equipment with V-Series
type interfaces with provision for statistical multiplexing".
[37] ITU-T Recommendation X.31: "Support of packet mode terminal equipment by an ISDN".
[38] 3GPP TS 45.005: "Digital cellular telecommunication system (Phase 2+); Radio transmission and
reception".
[39] 3GPP TS 29.061: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; General Packet Radio Service (GPRS);
Interworking between the Public Land Mobile Network (PLMN) supporting GPRS and Packet
Data Networks (PDN)".
[40] 3GPP TS 23.081: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Technical Specification Group Core
Network; Line identification supplementary services - Stage 2".

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 11 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
[41] 3GPP TS 27.001: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Technical Specification Group Core
Network; General on Terminal Adaptation Functions (TAF) for Mobile Stations (MS)".
[42] 3GPP TS 29.007: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Technical Specification Group Core
Network; General requirements on interworking between the Public Land Mobile Network
(PLMN) and the Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN) or Public Switched Telephone
Network (PSTN)".
[43] Infrared Data Association; Specification of Ir Mobile Communications (IrMC).
[44] IrDA Object Exchange Protocol.
[45] 3GPP TS 27.010: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Terminal Equipment to User Equipment
(TE-UE) multiplexer protocol User Equipment (UE)".
[46] 3GPP TS 23.107: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Quality of Service, Concept and
Architecture".
[47] 3GPP TS 23.060: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; General Packet Radio Service (GPRS)
Service description; Stage 2".
[48] 3GPP TS 23.067: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Enhanced Multi-Level Precedence and Pre-
emption service (eMLPP) - Stage 2".
[49] 3GPP TS 43.068: "Digital cellular telecommunication system (Phase 2+); Voice Group Call
service (VGCS) - Stage 2".
[50] 3GPP TS 43.069: "Digital cellular telecommunication system (Phase 2+); Voice Broadcast Service
(VBS) - Stage 2".
[51] 3GPP TS 24.067: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Enhanced Multi-Level Precedence and Pre-
emption service (eMLPP) - Stage 3".
[52] 3GPP TS 44.068: "Digital cellular telecommunication system (Phase 2+); Voice Group Call
service (VGCS) - Stage 3".
[53] 3GPP TS 44.069: "Digital cellular telecommunication system (Phase 2+); Voice Broadcast Service
(VBS) - Stage 3".
[54] 3GPP TS 22.067: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Technical Specification Group Services
and System Aspects; enhanced Multi-Level Precedence and Pre-emption service (eMLPP) - Stage
1".
[55] 3GPP TS 42.068: "Digital cellular telecommunication system (Phase 2+); Voice Group Call
service (VGCS) - Stage 1".
[56] 3GPP TS 42.069: "Digital cellular telecommunication system (Phase 2+); Voice Broadcast Service
(VBS) - Stage 1".
[57] void
[58] 3GPP TS 22.087: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Technical Specification Group Services
and System Aspects;User-to-User Signalling (UUS) - Stage 1".
[59] 3GPP TS 31.102: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Technical Specification Group Terminals;
Characteristics of the USIM Application".
[60] ETSI TS 102 221 "Smart Cards; UICC-Terminal interface; Physical and logical characteristics
(Release 1999)".
[61] 3GPP TS 44.065: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; General Packet Radio Service (GPRS);
Mobile Station (MS) Serving GPRS Support Node (SGSN); Subnetwork Dependent
Convergence Protocol (SNDCP)".
[62] 3GPP TS 25.323: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Packet Data Convergence Protocol
(PDCP)".

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 12 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
[63] 3GPP TS 23.227 "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Applications and User interaction in the
UE-Principles and specific requirements".
[64] 3GPP TS 23.101: "3rd Generation Partnership Project; Technical Specification Group Services
and System Aspects; General UMTS Architecture."
[65] 3GPP TS 31.101: "UICC-Terminal Interface; Physical and Logical Characteristics."
[66] ETSI TS 102 310: "Smart Cards; Extensible Authentication Protocol support in the UICC".
[67] ETSI TS 102 221: "Smart cards; UICC-Terminal interface; Physical and logical characteristics".
[68] RFC 3748, June 2004: "Extensible Authentication Protocol (EAP)".
[69] RFC 3629, November 2003: "UTF-8, a transformation format of ISO 10646".
[70] 3GPP TS 44.318: "Generic Access (GA) to the A/Gb interface; Mobile GA interface layer 3
specification".
[71] 3GPP TS 44.060: "General Packet Radio Service (GPRS); Mobile Station (MS) - Base Station
System (BSS) interface; Radio Link Control/Medium Access Control (RLC/MAC) protocol".
[72] 3GPP TS 25.308: "High Speed Downlink Packet Access (HSDPA): Overall Description; Stage 2".
[73] 3GPP TS 25.319: "Enhanced Uplink; Overall Description; Stage 2".
[74] 3GPP TS 25.331: "Radio Resource Control (RRC) protocol specification".
[75] 3GPP TS 24.216: "Communication Continuity Management Object (MO)".
[76] 3GPP TS 23.032: "Universal Geographical Area Description (GAD)".
[77] 3GPP TS 25.305 "User Equipment (UE) positioning in Universal Terrestrial Radio Access
Network (UTRAN); Stage 2".
[78] IEC 61162: "Maritime navigation and radio communication equipment and systems Digital
interfaces".

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 13 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
3 Definitions and abbreviations
3.1 Definitions
For the purposes of the present document, the following syntactical definitions apply (refer also clause 4):
<CR> Carriage return character, which value is specified with command S3.
<LF> Linefeed character, which value is specified with command S4.
<...> Name enclosed in angle brackets is a syntactical element. Brackets themselves do not appear in the
command line.
[...] Optional subparameter of a command or an optional part of TA information response is enclosed
in square brackets. Brackets themselves do not appear in the command line. When subparameter is
not given in parameter type commands, new value equals to its previous value. In action type
commands, action should be done on the basis of the recommended default setting of the
subparameter.
underline Underlined defined subparameter value is the recommended default setting of this subparameter.
In parameter type commands, this value should be used in factory settings which are configured
by V.250 [14] command &F0. In action type commands, this value should be used when
subparameter is not given.
3.2 Abbreviations
For the purposes of the present document, the following abbreviations apply:
AT ATtention; this two-character abbreviation is always used to start a command line to be sent from
TE to TA
ASCI Advanced Speech Call Items, including VGCS, VBS and eMLPP
BCD Binary Coded Decimal
eMLPP Enhanced Multi-Level Precedence and Pre-emption Service
ETSI European Telecommunications Standards Institute
FTM Frame Tunnelling Mode (refer 3GPP TS 27.001 [41] and 3GPP TS 29.007[42])
HSCSD High Speed Circuit Switched Data
IMEI International Mobile station Equipment Identity
IRA International Reference Alphabet (ITU-T T.50 [13])
IrDA Infrared Data Association
ISO International Standards Organization
ITU-T International Telecommunication Union - Telecommunications Standardization Sector
ME Mobile Equipment
MoU Memorandum of Understanding (GSM operator joint)
MT Mobile Termination
PCCA Portable Computer and Communications Association
PTT Push to Talk
RDI Restricted Digital Information
RLP Radio Link Protocol
SIM Subscriber Identity Module
TA Terminal Adaptor, e.g. a GSM data card (equal to DCE; Data Circuit terminating Equipment)
TE Terminal Equipment, e.g. a computer (equal to DTE; Data Terminal Equipment)
TIA Telecommunications Industry Association
UDI Unrestricted Digital Information
UE User Equipment
UICC Universal Integrated Circuit Card
USIM Universal Subscriber Identity Module
VBS Voice Broadcast Service
VGCS Voice Group Call Service

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 14 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
4 AT command syntax
This clause summarizes general aspects on AT commands and issues related to them.
TE software implementors must take account that future versions of this specification may include additional
parameters beyond what is expected in any response to an AT Set Command, Read Command, Test Command, or
unsolicited result code. Implementations must therefore analyse all parameters provided from the TA and discard
(ignore) any parameters received following the parameters expected by the TE software.
For further information refer ITU-T Recommendation V.250 [14].
4.1 Command line
See figure 2 for general structure of a command line. Standardized basic commands are found only in V.250 [14].
GSM/UMTS commands use syntax rules of extended commands. Every extended command has a test command
(trailing =?) to test the existence of the command and to give information about the type of its subparameters.
Parameter type commands also have a read command (trailing ?) to check the current values of subparameters. Action
type commands do not store the values of any of their possible subparameters, and therefore do not have a read
command.
ATCMD1 CMD2=12; +CMD1; +CMD2=,,15; +CMD2?; +CMD2=?<CR>
command line prefix
basic command
(no + prefix)
subparameter
extended command
(prefixed with +)
extended commands are
delimited with semicolon
subparameters
may be omitted
command line
termination character
read command for checking
current subparameter values
test command for checking
possible subparameter values

Figure 2: Basic structure of a command line
If verbose responses are enabled with command V1 and all commands in a command line has been performed
successfully, result code <CR><LF>OK<CR><LF> is sent from the TA to the TE. If numeric responses are enabled
with command V0, result code 0<CR> is sent instead.
If verbose responses are enabled with command V1 and subparameter values of a command are not accepted by the TA
(or command itself is invalid, or command cannot be performed for some reason), result code
<CR><LF>ERROR<CR><LF> is sent to the TE and no subsequent commands in the command line are processed. If
numeric responses are enabled with command V0, result code 4<CR> is sent instead. ERROR (or 4) response may be
replaced by +CME ERROR: <err> (refer clause 9) when command was not processed due to an error related to MT
operation.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 15 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
4.2 Information responses and result codes
The TA response for the example command line of figure 2 could be as shown in figure 3. Here, verbose response
format is enabled with command V1. If numeric format V0 would have been used, <CR><LF> headers of information
responses would have been left out and final result code changed to 0<CR>.
<CR><LF>+CMD2: 3,0,15,"GSM"<CR><LF>
<CR><LF>+CMD2: (0-3),(0,1),(0-12,15),("GSM","IRA")<CR><LF>
<CR><LF>OK<CR><LF>
information response to +CMD2?
information response to +CMD2=?
final result code
also string type subparameters possible
shows acceptable ranges of each subparameter

Figure 3: Response to a command line
So called intermediate result codes inform about progress of TA operation (e.g. connection establishment CONNECT),
and so called unsolicited result codes indicate occurrence of an event not directly associated with issuance of a
command from TE (e.g. ring indication RING).
4.3 ITU-T V.250 [14] TE-TA interface commands
Table 1 summarizes V.250 [14] commands relating to command line and response formatting, and TA-TE interface
operation. All are applicable to GSM/UMTS terminals.
Table 1: V.250 commands relating to TE-TA interface
Command Subclause Impl. Use in GSM/UMTS
S3=[<value>] 6.2.1 mand. command line termination character (mandatory default setting IRA 13)
S4=[<value>] 6.2.2 mand. response formatting character (recommended default IRA 10)
S5=[<value>] 6.2.3 mand. command line editing character (recommended default IRA 8)
E[<value>] 6.2.4 mand. command echo (recommended default 1 i.e. TA echoes commands
back)
Q[<value>] 6.2.5 mand. result code suppression (recommended default 0 i.e. TA transmits result
codes)
V[<value>] 6.2.6 mand. TA response format (recommended default 1 i.e. verbose format)
X[<value>] 6.2.7 mand. defines CONNECT result code format; values manufacturer specific
&C[<value>] 6.2.8 mand. determines how ITU-T V.24 circuit 109 (or equivalent) relates to the
detection of received line signal from remote end (recommended default
1 i.e. 109 operation relates to detection of received signal)
&D[<value>] 6.2.9 mand. determines how TA responds when ITU-T V.24 circuit 108/2 (or
equivalent) is changed from ON to OFF condition during online data
state
+IPR=[<value>] 6.2.10 opt. fixed TE data rate (recommended default 0 i.e. automatic detection)
+ICF=[<format>[
,<parity>]]
6.2.11 opt. TE-TA character framing (recommended default 3,3 i.e. eight data bits,
no parity, 1 stop bit)
+IFC=[<by_te> [
,<by_ta>]]
6.2.12 opt. TE-TA local flow control (recommended default 2,2 i.e. TE uses ITU-T
V.24 circuit 133 (or equivalent), and TA circuit 106 (or equivalent))
+ILRR=[<value>] 6.2.13 opt. determines whether the used local TE-TA data rate is informed using
intermediate result code +ILRR: <rate> before going online data
state after call answering or originating


ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 16 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
5 General commands
ITU-T Recommendation V.250 [14] includes "Generic DCE Control" commands with the prefix +G. These commands
are for the identification of the TA. Four of those commands are adapted here to be the identification commands of the
MT. Syntax is otherwise similar but the prefix is +CG. TIA IS-99 [15] uses same commands for base station
identification.
5.1 Request manufacturer identification +CGMI
Table 2: +CGMI action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CGMI <manufacturer>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CGMI=?

Description
Execution command causes the TA to return one or more lines of information text <manufacturer>, determined by
the MT manufacturer, which is intended to permit the user of the TA to identify the manufacturer of the MT to which it
is connected to. Typically, the text will consist of a single line containing the name of the manufacturer, but
manufacturers may choose to provide more information if desired. Refer subclause 9.2 for possible <err> values.
Defined values
<manufacturer>: the total number of characters, including line terminators, in the information text shall not
exceed 2048 characters.
Text shall not contain the sequence 0<CR> or OK<CR>
Implementation
Optional.
5.2 Request model identification +CGMM
Table 3: +CGMM action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CGMM <model>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CGMM=?

Description
Execution command causes the TA to return one or more lines of information text <model>, determined by the MT
manufacturer, which is intended to permit the user of the TA to identify the specific model of the MT to which it is
connected to. Typically, the text will consist of a single line containing the name of the product, but manufacturers may
choose to provide more information if desired. Refer to subclause 9.2 for possible <err> values.
Defined values
<model>: the total number of characters, including line terminators, in the information text shall not exceed 2048
characters.
Text shall not contain the sequence 0<CR> or OK<CR>

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 17 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Implementation
Optional.
5.3 Request revision identification +CGMR
Table 4: +CGMR action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CGMR <revision>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CGMR=?

Description
Execution command causes the TA to return one or more lines of information text <revision>, determined by the
MT manufacturer, which is intended to permit the user of the TA to identify the version, revision level or date, or other
pertinent information of the MT to which it is connected to. Typically, the text will consist of a single line containing
the version of the product, but manufacturers may choose to provide more information if desired. Refer subclause 9.2
for possible <err> values.
Defined values
<revision>: the total number of characters, including line terminators, in the information text shall not exceed
2048 characters.
Text shall not contain the sequence 0<CR> or OK<CR>
Implementation
Optional.
5.4 Request product serial number identification +CGSN
Table 5: +CGSN action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CGSN <sn>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CGSN=?

Description
Execution command causes the TA to return one or more lines of information text <sn>, determined by the MT
manufacturer, which is intended to permit the user of the TA to identify the individual MT to which it is connected to.
Typically, the text will consist of a single line containing the IMEI (International Mobile station Equipment Identity;
refer 3GPP TS 23.003 [7]) number of the MT, but manufacturers may choose to provide more information if desired.
Refer subclause 9.2 for possible <err> values.
Defined values
<sn>: the total number of characters, including line terminators, in the information text shall not exceed 2048
characters.
Text shall not contain the sequence 0<CR> or OK<CR>
Implementation
Optional.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 18 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
5.5 Select TE character set +CSCS
Table 6: +CSCS parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CSCS=[<chset>]
+CSCS? +CSCS: <chset>
+CSCS=?
+CSCS: (list of supported <chset>s)

Description
Set command informs TA which character set <chset> is used by the TE. TA is then able to convert character strings
correctly between TE and MT character sets.
When TA-TE interface is set to 8-bit operation and used TE alphabet is 7-bit, the highest bit shall be set to zero.
NOTE 1: It is manufacturer specific how the internal alphabet of MT is converted to/from the TE alphabet.
Read command shows current setting and test command displays conversion schemes implemented in the TA.
Defined values
<chset> (conversion schemes not listed here can be defined by manufacturers):
"GSM" GSM 7 bit default alphabet (3GPP TS 23.038 [25]); this setting causes easily software flow control
(XON/XOFF) problems.
"HEX" Character strings consist only of hexadecimal numbers from 00 to FF; e.g. "032FE6" equals three 8-
bit characters with decimal values 3, 47 and 230; no conversions to the original MT character set shall
be done.
NOTE 2: If MT is using GSM 7 bit default alphabet, its characters shall be padded with 8th bit (zero) before
converting them to hexadecimal numbers (i.e. no SMS-style packing of 7-bit alphabet).
"IRA" International reference alphabet (ITU-T T.50 [13]).
"PCCPxxx" PC character set Code Page xxx
"PCDN" PC Danish/Norwegian character set
"UCS2" 16-bit universal multiple-octet coded character set (ISO/IEC10646 [32]); UCS2 character strings are
converted to hexadecimal numbers from 0000 to FFFF; e.g. "004100620063" equals three 16-bit
characters with decimal values 65, 98 and 99.
"UTF-8" Octet (8-bit) lossless encoding of UCS characters (RFC 3629 [69]); UTF-8 encodes each UCS
character as a variable number of octets, where the number of octets depends on the integer value
assigned to the UCS character. The input format shall be a stream of octets. It shall not be converted
to hexadecimal numbers as in "HEX" or "UCS2". This character set requires an 8-bit TA TE
interface.
"8859-n" ISO 8859 Latin n (1-6) character set
"8859-C" ISO 8859 Latin/Cyrillic character set
"8859-A" ISO 8859 Latin/Arabic character set
"8859-G" ISO 8859 Latin/Greek character set
"8859-H" ISO 8859 Latin/Hebrew character set
Implementation
Mandatory when a command using the setting of this command is implemented.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 19 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
5.6 Request international mobile subscriber identity +CIMI
Table 7: +CIMI action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CIMI <IMSI>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CIMI=?

Description
Execution command causes the TA to return <IMSI>, which is intended to permit the TE to identify the individual
SIM card or active application in the UICC (GSM or USIM) which is attached to MT. Refer subclause 9.2 for possible
<err> values.
Defined values
<IMSI>: International Mobile Subscriber Identity (string without double quotes)
Implementation
Optional.
5.7 Multiplexing mode +CMUX
Table 8: +CMUX parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CMUX=<mode>[,<subset>[,
<port_speed>[,<N1>[,<T1>
[,<N2>[,<T2>[,<T3>
[,<k>]]]]]]]]
+CME ERROR: <err>

+CMUX? +CMUX: <mode>,[<subset>],<port_speed>,
<N1>,<T1>, <N2>,<T2>,<T3>[,<k>]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CMUX=? +CMUX: (list of supported <mode>s),(list of supported
<subset>s),(list of supported <port_speed>s),(list of
supported <N1>s),(list of supported <T1>s),(list of
supported <N2>s),(list of supported <T2>s),(list of
supported <T3>s),(list of supported <k>s)

Description
This command is used to enable/disable the 3GPP TS 27.010 [45] multiplexing protocol control channel. Refer to
subclause 9.2 for possible <err> values. The AT command sets parameters for the Control Channel. If the parameters
are left out, the default value is used.
Read command returns the current mode and the settings.
Test command returns the supported modes and parameters.
It is recommended that the MT/TA/TE should autobaud to the +CMUX command up to and including an interface speed
of 9600 bits/s.
The OK or +CME ERROR: <err> response is returned at the speed of the +CMUX command prior to entering
<mode>.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 20 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
It is recommended that whenever the multiplexer control channel is released the MT/TA/TE should assume an interface
rate of up to and including 9600 bits/s for auto bauding purposes irrespective of any previous higher speed having been
selected.
If a +CMUX command is issued whilst in any multiplexer mode then that +CMUX command shall be ignored and the
MT/TA shall return an +CME ERROR: <err> response.
Defined values
<operation> (multiplexer Transparency Mechanism)
0 Basic option
1 Advanced option
<subset>:
This parameter defines the way in which the multiplexer control channel is set up. A virtual channel may
subsequently be set up differently but in the absence of any negotiation for the settings of a virtual channel, the
virtual channel shall be set up according to the control channel <subset> setting.
0 UIH frames used only
1 UI frames used only
2 I frames used only
Default value: 0
<port_speed> (transmission rate):
1 9 600 bit/s
2 19 200 bit/s
3 38 400 bit/s
4 57 600 bit/s
5 115 200 bit/s
6 230 400 bits/s
<N1> (maximum frame size):
1- 32768
default Value : 31 (64 if Advanced option is used)
<T1> (acknowledgement timer in units of ten milliseconds):
1-255, where 10 is default (100 ms)
<N2> (maximum number of re-transmissions):
0-100, where 3 is default
<T2> (response timer for the multiplexer control channel in units of ten milliseconds):
2-255, where 30 is default (300 ms)
NOTE: T2 must be longer than T1.
<T3> (wake up response timer in seconds):
1-255, where 10 is default
<k> (window size, for Advanced operation with Error Recovery options):

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 21 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
1-7, where 2 is default
Implementation
Mandatory, if 3GPP TS 27.010 [45] supported in the MT/TA.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 22 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
5.8 ITU-T V.250 [14] generic TA control commands
Table 9: V.250 generic TA control commands
Command Subclause Impl. Use in GSM/UMTS
Z[<value>] 6.1.1 mand. TA sets all parameters to their defaults as specified by a user
memory profile or by the manufacturer, and resets TA
&F[<value>] 6.1.2 mand. TA sets all parameters to their defaults as specified by the
manufacturer
I[<value>] 6.1.3 opt. request manufacturer specific information about the TA (software
cannot use this command to determine the capabilities of a TA)
+GMI 6.1.4 mand. request TA manufacturer identification (may equal to +CGMI)
+GMM 6.1.5 mand. request TA model identification (may equal to +CGMM)
+GMR 6.1.6 mand. request TA revision identification (may equal to +CGMR)
+GSN 6.1.7 opt. request TA serial number identification (may equal to +CGSN)
+GOI 6.1.8 opt. request ISO system global object identification of the TA (general
format defined in ITU-T Recommendation X.208; encoding rules
in ITU-T Recommendation X.209)
+GCAP 6.1.9 mand. request overall capabilities of TA; the response code for a TA
building on this document shall be +CGSM
+GCI=<T.35> 6.1.10 opt. selects the country of installation for the TA using ITU-T
Recommendation T.35 Annex A country codes

5.9 PCCA STD-101 [17] select wireless network +WS46
PCCA STD-101 [17] includes a command to select the cellular network (Wireless Data Service; WDS) to operate with
the TA. PCCA calls this WDS-Side Stack Selection. This command may be used when TA is asked to indicate the
networks in which it can operate.
Table 10: +WS46 parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+WS46=[<n>]
+WS46? <n>
+WS46=?
(list of supported <n>s)

Description
Set command selects the WDS side stack <n> to be used by the TA. Read command shows current setting and test
command displays side stacks implemented in the TA.
Defined values for Query
<n>:
12 GSM Digital Cellular Systems (GERAN only)
22 UTRAN only
25 3GPP Systems (both GERAN and UTRAN)
NOTE: These 3 values are mutually exclusive. e.g. if value '25' is returned, value '12' and '22' shall not be
returned.
Defined values for Set
<n>:

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 23 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
12 3GPP System
22, 25 Not used. If received, shall be treated as if 12 had been received or an ERROR shall be returned.
refer PCCA STD-101 [17] for other values.
Implementation
Mandatory in PCCA STD-101, but optional for GSM/UMTS.
5.10 Informative examples
When beginning to build a communication link, a general TE application controlling a TA needs to determine the TA
and the MT to which it is connected. V.250 [14] has seven commands for TA identification from which four are
mandatory to be implemented in a TA. An example of this command sequence requesting manufacturer (+GMI), model
(+GMM), revision (+GMR) and serial number (+GSN) information would be:
AT+GMI
Manufacturer ABC
OK
AT+GMM
GSM Ultimate Data Device
OK
AT+GMR
1.00
OK
AT+GSN
987612345-123
OK

The maximum lengths of the information responses are defined to be 2048 characters, but it is recommended that they
are kept as simple as in the example. The serial number command is defined as optional. Another optional command is
Global Object Identification command (+GOI) which should return the object identifiers of ITU-T Recommendation
X.208 as numeric strings delimited by periods. The Complete Capabilities List command (+GCAP) should indicate the
major capability areas of the TA. The support of different areas is presented in the response of +GCAP command. Each
area may be presented by the selection command name of a specific capability area (e.g. +FCLASS for fax support) or
some other predefined response. For instance, a GSM TA with fax capabilities could respond as follows:
AT+GCAP
+GCAP: +CGSM,+FCLASS,+W
OK

The first supported area in the response is presented with +CGSM. It is the response text to show that some or all GSM
commands of the present document are supported. Second response text (+FCLASS) informs that some fax or voice
capabilities are present, and the third text (+W) about the presence of wireless commands as specified by PCCA
STD-101 [17]. Command +FCLASS=? (refer e.g. ITU-T T.31 [11] and T.32 [12]) should be used to query the
supported fax capabilities and +WS46=? to query the wireless data services available:
AT+FCLASS=?;+WS46=?
0,1,2,2.0
(12)
OK

The TA of this example supports GSM data services, and fax service class 1 (TIA-578-A), 2 (manufacturer specific)
and 2.0 (ITU-T T.32 [12]/ TIA-592).
The present document defines commands for MT identification which are similar to those for TA identification in
V.250 [14], for an example:
AT+CGMI
Mobile Manufacturer XYZ
OK
AT+CGMM
GSM Phone 1234
OK
AT+CGMR
1.00
OK
AT+CGSN
123456121234561

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 24 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
OK

Manufacturer, model and version commands work similarly as for TA, except that the serial number query returns the
International Mobile Station Equipment Identity (IMEI) number. IMEI is fifteen digits long and consists of a type
approval code, a final assembly code, a serial number and a spare digit (refer 3GPP TS 23.003 [7]). When the TA is
implemented inside MT, the responses for both TA and MT queries will most likely follow the responses of MT
identification.
6 Call control commands and methods
This clause describes the control of GSM/UMTS calls. Normal data and fax call control is done as in ITU-T
Recommendations V.250 [14], T.31 [11] and T.32 [12]. For voice call originating, refer subclause "ITU-T V.250 dial
command D".
6.1 Select type of address +CSTA
Table 11: +CSTA parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CSTA=[<type>]
+CSTA? +CSTA: <type>
+CSTA=?
+CSTA: (list of supported <type>s)

Description
Set command selects the type of number for further dialling commands (D) according to GSM/UMTS specifications.
Test command returns values supported a compound value.
Defined values
<type>: type of address octet in integer format (refer TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.4.7); default 145 when dialling
string includes international access code character "+", otherwise 129
Implementation
Mandatory when other than default value allowed.
6.2 ITU-T V.250 [14] dial command D
V.250 [14] dial command D lists characters that may be used in a dialling string for making a call or controlling
supplementary services in accordance with 3GPP TS 22.030 [19]. Their use in GSM/UMTS is listed in this subclause,
as well as new dial modifiers applicable only to GSM/UMTS are introduced. For a MT supporting AT commands only,
it is mandatory to support the control of supplementary services in accordance with 3GPP TS 22.030 [19] through the
dial command or through the specific supplementary service commands (+CCFC, +CLCK, etc.), where 3GPP TS 22.030
[19] identifies the supplementary services as mandatory.
V.250 dialling digits
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 * # + A B C (implementation of these characters is mandatory for GSM/UMTS)
D (implementation of this character is optional for GSM/UMTS, and it is ignored)
V.250 modifier characters
, (implementation of this character is mandatory for GSM/UMTS, but it may be ignored)
T P (implementation of these characters is mandatory for GSM/UMTS, but they are ignored)
! W @ (implementation of these characters is optional for GSM/UMTS, and they are ignored)

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 25 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
V.250 semicolon character
In GSM/UMTS, when semicolon character is given after dialling digits (or modifiers), a voice call originated to the
given address. TA returns to command state immediately (or after possible +COLP result code; refer subclause
"Connected line identification presentation +COLP"). Refer Annex G for a detailed example.
GSM/UMTS modifier characters
> (refer subclause "Direct dialling from phonebooks")
I or i (override the CLIR supplementary service subscription default value for this call; I = invocation (restrict CLI
presentation) and i = suppression (allow CLI presentation); refer subclause "Calling line identification restriction
+CLIR")
G or g (control the CUG supplementary service information for this call; uses index and info values set with command
+CCUG; refer subclause "Closed user group +CCUG")
6.3 Direct dialling from phonebooks
GSM/UMTS MT and SIM/UICC can contain phonebooks which have a phone number and an alphanumeric field for
each phonebook entry location. The use of V.250 [14] dialling command ensures that direct dialling from MT and
SIM/UICC phonebook is possible through ordinary communications software which just gives the phone number field
to be filled and then use the D command to originate the call. Available memories may be queried with Select
Phonebook Storage test command +CPBS=?, and location range for example with Read Phonebook Entries test
command +CPBR=?.
Execute commands
1. D><str>[I][G][;] originate call to phone number which corresponding alphanumeric field is <str> (if
possible, all available memories should be searched for the correct entry).
2. D>mem<n>[I][G][;] originate call to phone number in memory mem entry location <n> (available memories
may be queried with Select Phonebook Storage test command +CPBS=?; mem could be
e.g. ME).
3. D><n>[I][G][;] originate call to phone number in entry location <n> (it is manufacturer specific which
memory storage of MT, SIM/UICC and TA is used; command Select Phonebook Memory
Storage +CPBS setting is recommended to be used).
Semicolon character shall be added when voice call is originated. CLIR and CUG per call base modifiers may also be
present.
Responses
Possible error responses include +CME ERROR: <err> when error is related to MT functionality. Refer
subclause 9.2 for possible error values. Otherwise TA responses can have values defined by V.250 [14] and commands
Service Reporting Control +CR and Connected Line Identification Presentation +COLP. Detailed error report of an
unsuccessful originated call failed in a GSM/UMTS network error can be obtained with command Extended Error
Report +CEER (if implemented).
Defined values
<str>: string type value, which should equal to an alphanumeric field in at least one phonebook entry in the
searched memories; used character set should be the one selected with Select TE Character Set +CSCS
<n>: integer type memory location should be in the range of locations available in the memory used
Implementation
Mandatory when direct dialling is implemented. Also phonebook commands implementation is required.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 26 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
6.4 Call mode +CMOD
Table 12: +CMOD parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CMOD=[<mode>]
+CMOD? +CMOD: <mode>
+CMOD=?
+CMOD: (list of supported <mode>s)

Description
Set command selects the call mode of further dialling commands (D) or for next answering command (A). Mode can be
either single or alternating (in the present document, terms "alternating mode" and "alternating call" refer to all
GSM/UMTS bearer and teleservices that incorporate more than one basic service (voice, data, fax) within one call).
When single mode is selected the call originating and hangup procedures are similar to procedures specified in ITU-T
Recommendations V.250 [14], T.31 [11] and T.32 [12]. In GSM/UMTS there can be voice followed by data (refer
3GPP TS 22.002 [1]), alternating voice/data (refer 3GPP TS 22.002 [1]) and alternating voice/fax calls (refer 3GPP TS
22.003 [2]). Refer next two subclauses for alternating call control methods.
Test command returns values supported as a compound value.
NOTE: +CMOD shall be set to zero after a successfully completed alternating mode call. It shall be set to zero also
after a failed answering. The power-up, factory (&F) and user resets (Z) shall also set the value to zero.
This reduces the possibility that alternating mode calls are originated or answered accidentally.
Defined values
<mode>:
0 single mode
1 alternating voice/fax (teleservice 61)
2 alternating voice/data (bearer service 61)
3 voice followed by data (bearer service 81)
also all other values below 128 are reserved by the present document
Implementation
Mandatory when alternating mode calls are implemented in the TA.
6.4A Voice Call Mode +CVMOD
Table 13: +CVMOD action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CVMOD=[<voice mode>]
+CVMOD? +CVMOD: <voice mode>
+CVMOD=? +CMOD: (list of supported
<voice_mode>s)

Description
Set command selects the voice call mode for making a Mobile Originated voice call from the UE. The voice call mode
can be CS_ONLY, VOIP_ONLY, CS_PREFERRED or VOIP_PREFERRED. The default mode is CS_ONLY. Type of
VoIP session preferred (e.g. SIP VoIP, IMS VoIP) is manufacturer specific issue.


ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 27 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
NOTE1:
- If the Call Mode is set to CS_ONLY, then the ATD command will make a call in CS mode.
- If the Call Mode is set to VOIP_ONLY, then the ATD command will make a call in VoIP mode.
- If the Call Mode is set to CS_PREFERRED, then the ATD command gives preference for CS based voice call.
- If the Call Mode is set to VOIP_PREFERRED, then the ATD command gives preference for VoIP based voice call
NOTE2: The preferences are not applicable for the emergency call.
NOTE3: The preferences are not applicable if operator has set preferences for UE originated calls/sessions, 3GPP
TS 24.216 subclause 5.6 [75]

Test command returns the values supported by the UE.

Defined values
0 CS_ONLY
1 VOIP_ONLY
2 CS_PREFERRED
3 VOIP_PREFERRED

Implementation
Optional.
6.5 Hangup call +CHUP
Table 13: +CHUP action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CHUP
+CHUP=?

Description
Execution command causes the TA to hangup the current GSM/UMTS call of the MT.
NOTE: The purpose of this command is not to replace the V.250 [14] command H, but to give an assured
procedure to terminate an alternating mode call. Refer next subclause.
Implementation
Mandatory when alternating mode calls implemented in the TA.
6.6 Alternating mode call control method
This subclause describes the procedure to handle alternating mode calls with AT commands. Procedures are mandatory
when alternating mode calls are implemented in the TA.
NOTE: ATH and drop DTR will not necessarily cause a hangup from voice mode. If the +CVHU is implemented
the behaviour shall be controlled by its setting.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 28 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Voice followed by data call (bearer service 81)
Figure 4 shows commands to start the call, to switch from voice to data (In-Call Modification) and to hang up the call.
+CMOD and +FCLASS commands indicate the current settings before dialling or answering command, not that they
shall be given just before D or A command. Refer subclause "Cellular result codes +CRC" for possible +CRING result
code values. Refer Annex F for a detailed example.
VOICE DATA
HANGUP
AT+CHUP or
remote initiated hangup
(or ATH
or drop DTR)
ATD or ATA or
remote initiated
ATDxxx;
AT+CMOD=3
AT+FCLASS=0
TA sets +CMOD=0
+CRING: VOICE/XXX
AT+CMOD=3;+FCLASS=0
MT MO
ATH or
drop DTR or
AT+CHUP or
remote initiated hangup
ATA

Figure 4: Voice followed by data call
Voice/ data call (bearer service number 61)
Figure 5 shows the commands to start the call, to switch between modes (In-Call Modification) and to hang up the call.
+CMOD and +FCLASS commands indicate the current settings before dialling or answering command, not that they
shall be given just before D or A command. Refer subclause "Cellular result codes +CRC" for possible +CRING result
code values. Refer Annex E for a detailed example.
VOICE DATA
HANGUP
AT+CHUP or
remote initiated hangup
AT+CHUP or
remote initiated hangup
(or ATH
or drop DTR)
ATD or ATA or
remote initiated
ATH or drop DTR or
remote initiated
ATDxxx ATDxxx;
AT+CMOD=2
AT+FCLASS=0
TA sets +CMOD=0
+CRING: ALT VOICE/XXX
AT+CMOD=2;+FCLASS=0
+CRING: ALT XXX/VOICE
AT+CMOD=2;+FCLASS=0
MT voice first
MT data first MO
ATA ATA

Figure 5: Alternating voice and data call

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 29 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Voice/ fax call (teleservice number 61)
Figure 6 shows the commands to start the call, to switch between modes (In-Call Modification) and to hang up the call.
+CMOD and +FCLASS commands indicate the current settings before dialling or answering command, not that they
shall be given just before D or A command. The parameter "x" of +FCLASS command can be 1, 1.0, 2 or 2.0.
NOTE: The transition from fax mode to voice mode is for further study.
VOICE FAX
HANGUP
ATD or
remote initiated
ATDxxx ATDxxx;
AT+CMOD=1
AT+FCLASS=x
TA sets +CMOD=0
+CRING: ALT VOICE/FAX
AT+CMOD=1;+FCLASS=x
+CRING: ALT FAX/VOICE
AT+CMOD=1;+FCLASS=x
MT voice first
MT fax first MO
ATA ATA
refer ITU-T T.31 [11] and T.32 [12]
for different hangup possibilities
(also AT+CHUP shall hangup)
AT+CHUP or
remote initiated hangup
(or ATH
or drop DTR)

Figure 6: Alternating voice and fax call
6.7 Select bearer service type +CBST
Table 14: +CBST parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CBST=[<speed>[,<name>[,<ce>]]]
+CBST? +CBST: <speed>,<name>,<ce>
+CBST=? +CBST: (list of supported <speed>s),(list of
supported <name>s),(list of supported <ce>s)

Description
Set command selects the bearer service <name> with data rate <speed>, and the connection element <ce> to be used
when data calls are originated (refer 3GPP TS 22.002 [1]). Values may also be used during mobile terminated data call
setup, especially in case of single numbering scheme calls (refer +CSNS).
Test command returns values supported as compound values.
Defined values
NOTE: The default values of the subparameters are manufacturer specific since they depend on the purpose of the
device and data services provided by it. Not all combinations of these subparameters are supported by
GSM/UMTS (refer 3GPP TS 22.002 [1]).

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 30 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
<speed>:
0 autobauding (automatic selection of the speed; this setting is possible in case of 3.1 kHz modem
and non-transparent service)
1 300 bps (V.21)
2 1200 bps (V.22)
3 1200/75 bps (V.23)
4 2400 bps (V.22bis)
5 2400 bps (V.26ter)
6 4800 bps (V.32)
7 9600 bps (V.32)
12 9600 bps (V.34)
14 14400 bps (V.34)
15 19200 bps (V.34)
16 28800 bps (V.34)
17 33600 bps (V.34)
34 1200 bps (V.120)
36 2400 bps (V.120)
38 4800 bps (V.120)
39 9600 bps (V.120)
43 14400 bps (V.120)
47 19200 bps (V.120)
48 28800 bps (V.120)
49 38400 bps (V.120)
50 48000 bps (V.120)
51 56000 bps (V.120)
65 300 bps (V.110)
66 1200 bps (V.110)
68 2400 bps (V.110 or X.31 flag stuffing)
70 4800 bps (V.110 or X.31 flag stuffing)
71 9600 bps (V.110 or X.31 flag stuffing)
75 14400 bps (V.110 or X.31 flag stuffing)
79 19200 bps (V.110 or X.31 flag stuffing)
80 28800 bps (V.110 or X.31 flag stuffing)
81 38400 bps (V.110 or X.31 flag stuffing)
82 48000 bps (V.110 or X.31 flag stuffing)
83 56000 bps (V.110 or X.31 flag stuffing; this setting can be used in conjunction with asynchronous
non-transparent UDI or RDI service in order to get FTM)
84 64000 bps (X.31 flag stuffing; this setting can be used in conjunction with asynchronous non-
transparent UDI service in order to get FTM)
115 56000 bps (bit transparent)
116 64000 bps (bit transparent)
120 32000 bps (PIAFS32k)
121 64000 bps (PIAFS64k)
130 28800 bps (multimedia)
131 32000 bps (multimedia)
132 33600 bps (multimedia)
133 56000 bps (multimedia)
134 64000 bps (multimedia)

also all other values below 128 are reserved by the present document.
<name>:
0 data circuit asynchronous (UDI or 3.1 kHz modem)
1 data circuit synchronous (UDI or 3.1 kHz modem)
2 PAD Access (asynchronous) (UDI)
3 Packet Access (synchronous) (UDI)
4 data circuit asynchronous (RDI)
5 data circuit synchronous (RDI)
6 PAD Access (asynchronous) (RDI)

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 31 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
7 Packet Access (synchronous) (RDI)
also all other values below 128 are reserved by the present document.
<ce>:
0 transparent
1 non-transparent
2 both, transparent preferred
3 both, non-transparent preferred
Implementation
Mandatory when data calls implemented.
6.8 Radio link protocol +CRLP
Table 15: +CRLP parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CRLP=[<iws>[,<mws>[,<T1>
[,<N2>[,<ver>[,<T4>]]]]]]

+CRLP? +CRLP: <iws>,<mws>,<T1>,<N2>[,<ver1>[,<T4>]]
[<CR><LF>+CRLP: <iws>,<mws>,<T1>,<N2>[,<ver2>[,<T4>]]
[...]]
+CRLP=?
+CRLP: (list of supported <iws>s),(list of supported <mws>s),
(list of supported <T1>s),(list of supported <N2>s)[,<ver1>
[,(list of supported <T4>s)]]
[<CR><LF>+CRLP: (list of supported <iws>s),(list of supported
<mws>s),(list of supported <T1>s),(list of supported <N2>s)
[,<ver1>[,(list of supported <T4>s)]]
[...]]

Description
Radio link protocol (RLP) parameters used when non-transparent data calls are originated may be altered with set
command. Available command subparameters depend on the RLP versions implemented by the device (e.g. <ver>
may not be available if device supports only versions 0 and 1).
NOTE 1: If radio link protocol is not used, but some other error correcting protocol (for transparent data calls),
V.250 [14] Error Control Selection test command +ES=? may be used to indicate the presence of the
protocol.
Read command returns current settings for each supported RLP version <verx>. Only RLP parameters applicable to
the corresponding <verx> are returned.
Test command returns values supported as a compound value. If MT/TA supports several RLP versions <verx>, the
RLP parameter value ranges for each <verx> are returned in a separate line.
Defined values
<ver>, <verx>: RLP version number in integer format; when version indication is not present it shall equal 0
NOTE 2: Versions 0 and 1 share the same parameter set. Read and test commands shall return only one line for this
set (where <verx> is not present).
<iws>, <mws>, <T1>, <N2>, <T4>: IWF to MS window size, MS to IWF window size, acknowledgement timer
T1, retransmission attempts N2, re-sequencing period T4 in integer format (default values and value ranges
depend on RLP version; refer 3GPP TS 24.022 [18]): T1 and T4 are in units of 10 ms.
Implementation

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 32 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Mandatory when RLP implemented.
6.9 Service reporting control +CR
Table 16: +CR parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CR=[<mode>]
+CR? +CR: <mode>
+CR=?
+CR: (list of supported <mode>s)

Description
Set command controls whether or not intermediate result code +CR: <serv> is returned from the TA to the TE. If
enabled, the intermediate result code is transmitted at the point during connect negotiation at which the TA has
determined which speed and quality of service will be used, before any error control or data compression reports are
transmitted, and before the intermediate result code CONNECT is transmitted.
NOTE: This command replaces V.250 [14] command Modulation Reporting Control +MR, which is not
appropriate for use in the GSM/UMTS network. Possible error control (other than radio link protocol) and
data compression reporting can be enabled with V.250 commands Error Control Reporting +ER and Data
Compression Reporting +DR.
Test command returns values supported as a compound value.
Defined values
<mode>:
0 disables reporting
1 enables reporting
<serv>:
ASYNC asynchronous transparent
SYNC synchronous transparent
REL ASYNC asynchronous non-transparent
REL SYNC synchronous non-transparent
GPRS [<L2P>] GPRS
The optional <L2P> proposes a layer 2 protocol to use between the MT and the TE. It is defined in the Enter GPRS
Data Mode (+CGDATA) command.
Implementation
Mandatory when data calls implemented.
6.10 Extended error report +CEER
Table 17: +CEER action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CEER +CEER: <report>
+CEER=?


ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 33 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Description
Execution command causes the TA to return one or more lines of information text <report>, determined by the MT
manufacturer, which should offer the user of the TA an extended report of the reason for
- the failure in the last unsuccessful call setup (originating or answering) or in-call modification;
- the last call release;
- the last unsuccessful GPRS attach or unsuccessful PDP context activation;
- the last GPRS detach or PDP context deactivation.
Typically, the text will consist of a single line containing the cause information given by GSM/UMTS network in
textual format.
Defined values
<report>: the total number of characters, including line terminators, in the information text shall not exceed 2041
characters.
Text shall not contain the sequence 0<CR> or OK<CR>.
Implementation
Optional.
6.11 Cellular result codes +CRC
Table 18: +CRC parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CRC=[<mode>]
+CRC? +CRC: <mode>
+CRC=?
+CRC: (list of supported <mode>s)

Description
Set command controls whether or not the extended format of incoming call indication or GPRS network request for
PDP context activation or notification for VBS/VGCS calls is used. When enabled, an incoming call is indicated to the
TE with unsolicited result code +CRING: <type> instead of the normal RING.
Test command returns values supported as a compound value.
NOTE: Similar command may be found in TIA IS-99 [15] and TIA IS-135 [16].
Defined values
<mode>:
0 disables extended format
1 enables extended format
<type>:
ASYNC [,<priority>[,<subaddr>,<satype>]] asynchronous transparent
SYNC [,<priority>[,<subaddr>,<satype>]] synchronous transparent
REL ASYNC [,<priority>[,<subaddr>,<satype>]] asynchronous non-transparent
REL SYNC [,<priority>[,<subaddr>,<satype>]] synchronous non-transparent

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 34 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
FAX [,<priority>[,<subaddr>,<satype>]] facsimile (TS 62)
VOICE [,<priority>[,<subaddr>,<satype>]] normal voice (TS 11)
VOICE/XXX [,<priority>[,<subaddr>,<satype>]] voice followed by data (BS 81) (XXX is
ASYNC, SYNC, REL ASYNC or REL SYNC)
ALT VOICE/XXX [,<priority>[,<subaddr>,<satype>]] alternating voice/data, voice first (BS 61)
ALT XXX/VOICE [,<priority>[,<subaddr>,<satype>]] alternating voice/data, data first (BS 61)
ALT VOICE/FAX [,<priority>[,<subaddr>,<satype>]] alternating voice/fax, voice first (TS 61)
ALT FAX/VOICE [,<priority>[,<subaddr>,<satype>]] alternating voice/fax, fax first (TS 61)
GPRS <PDP_type>, <PDP_addr>[, [<L2P>][,<APN>]] GPRS network request for PDP context
activation
VGC <GCA>, <GId>, <ackflag> [,<priority>] voice group call (TS 91)
VBC <GCA>, <GId>, <ackflag> [,<priority>] voice broadcast call (TS 92)
The optional <priority> indicates the eMLPP priority level of the incoming call by paging, notification or setup
message. The priority level values are as defined in eMLPP specification 3GPP TS 22.067 [54].
<subaddr>: string type subaddress of format specified by <satype>
<satype>: type of subaddress octet in integer format (refer 3GPP TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.4.8)
<PDP_type> ,<PDP_addr> and <APN> are as defined in the Define PDP Context (+CGDCONT) command. The
optional <L2P> proposes a layer 2 protocol to use between the MT and the TE. It is defined in the Enter GPRS Data
Mode (+CGDATA) command. If the MT is unable to announce to the TE the network's request (for example it is in
V.250 online data state) the MT shall reject the request. No corresponding unsolicited result code shall be issued when
the MT returns to a command state.
<GCA> is a part of the group call reference as specified in 3GPP TS 23.003 [7] and indicates group call area.
<GId> is a part of the group call reference as specified in 3GPP TS 23.003 [7] and indicates group call
identification.The <ackflag>=1 proposes that a predefined confirmation procedure is to be used after the call is ended.
For <ackflag>=0 no confirmation procedure is required.
Implementation
Mandatory when data or fax circuit mode calls implemented or for a MT supporting AT commands only and eMLPP or
VGCS or VBS is implemented.
6.12 HSCSD device parameters +CHSD
Table 19: +CHSD action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CHSD +CHSD: <mclass>,<maxRx>,<maxTx>,<sum>,<codings>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CHSD=?

Description
Execution command returns information about HSCSD features (refer 3GPP TS 22.034 [29]) supported by the MT/TA.
Refer subclause 9.2 for possible <err> values.
The return information is only applicable in GERAN.
Defined values

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 35 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
<mclass>: integer type; multislot class
<maxRx>: integer type; maximum number of receive timeslots that MT can use
<maxTx>: integer type; maximum number of transmit timeslots that MT can use
<sum>: integer type; total number of receive and transmit timeslots that MT can use at the same time (per TDMA
frame). The following applies in a HSCSD call: 1 (receive slots) + (transmit slots) <sum>
<codings> is a sum of integers each representing a supported channel coding (e.g. value 5 indicates that 4,8k and
9,6k channel codings are supported):
1 4,8k full rate data traffic channel
4 9,6k full rate data traffic channel
8 14,4k full rate data traffic channel
16 28,8k full rate data traffic channel (only possible when 14.4k is supported)
32 32,0k full rate data traffic channel (only possible in a two-timeslot configuration)
64 43,2k full rate data traffic channel (only possible when 14.4k is supported)
Implementation
Mandatory when HSCSD implemented.
This command is not applicable to UTRAN single mode UE.
6.13 HSCSD transparent call configuration +CHST
Table 20: +CHST parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CHST=[<wRx>[,<codings>]]
+CHST? +CHST: <wRx>,<codings>
+CHST=?

Description
Set command controls parameters for transparent HSCSD calls in GERAN. Changing them during a call does not affect
the current call.
NOTE: In UTRAN, values set with this command are not needed. The only applicable parameter is <SPEED>,
which is set with +CBST command.
Defined values
<wRx>: integer type; wanted amount of receive timeslots. Default value 0 indicates that TA shall calculate a proper
value from currently selected fixed network user rate (<speed> subparameter from +CBST command) and
<codings>
<codings>: a sum of integers each representing a channel coding that is accepted for transparent HSCSD calls.
Default value 0 indicates that all supported codings are accepted (refer +CHSD command for other values)
Implementation
Mandatory when transparent HSCSD implemented.
This command is not applicable to UTRAN single mode UE.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 36 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
6.14 HSCSD non-transparent call configuration +CHSN
Table 21: +CHSN parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CHSN=[<wAiur>[,<wRx>[,<topRx>
[,<codings>]]]]

+CHSN? +CHSN: <wAiur>,<wRx>,<topRx>,<codings>
+CHSN=? +CHSN: (list of supported <wAiur>s), (list of supported
<wRx>s),(list of supported <topRx>,(list of supported
<codings>s)

Description
Set command controls parameters for originating non-transparent HSCSD calls. Values may also be used during mobile
terminated data call setup. In GERAN, changing <topRx> or <codings> value during a call does not affect the
current call. In GERAN, changing of <wAiur> or <wRx> affects the current call only if <topRx> was non-zero when
call was established.
Defined values
<wAiur>: integer type; wanted air interface user rate. Default value 0 indicates that TA shall calculate a proper
value from currently selected fixed network user rate (<speed> subparameter from +CBST command),
<codings>, and <wRx> (or <maxRx> from +CHSD command if <wRx>=0). Other values:
1 9600 bps
2 14400 bps
3 19200 bps
4 28800 bps
5 38400 bps
6 43200 bps
7 57600 bps
<wRx>: integer type; wanted amount of receive timeslots. Default value 0 indicates that TA shall calculate a proper
value from currently selected <wAiur> and <codings>. This parameter is not applicable to UTRAN single
mode UE.
<topRx>: integer type; top value for <wRx> that user is going to request during the next established non-
transparent HSCSD call. Default value 0 indicates that user is not going to change <wAiur>/<wRx> during the
next call. This parameter is not applicable to UTRAN single mode UE.
<codings>: a sum of integers each representing a channel coding that is accepted for non-transparent HSCSD
calls. Default value 0 indicates that all supported codings are accepted (refer +CHSD command for other values).
This parameter is not applicable to UTRAN single mode UE.
Implementation
Mandatory when non-transparent HSCSD implemented.
6.15 HSCSD current call parameters +CHSC
Table 22: +CHSC action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CHSC +CHSC: <rx>,<tx>,<aiur>,<coding>

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 37 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
+CHSC=?

Description
Execution command returns information about current HSCSD call. If no HSCSD call is active, all parameters returned
shall equal zero. If HSCSD call is active in UTRAN, all non-applicable parameters returned shall be equal to zero. (It is
manufacturer specific whether non-zero information is returned in case of an active normal single-slot data call.)
Defined values
<rx>: integer type; number of receive timeslots currently in use. This parameter is not applicable in UTRAN.
<tx>: integer type; number of transmit timeslots currently in use. This parameter is not applicable in UTRAN.
<aiur>: integer type; current air interface user rate (in case of transparent service this equals fixed network user
rate) (refer +CHSN command for possible values). For the two-timeslot ECSD bit transparent configuration the
following additional values apply:
8 56000 bps
9 64000 bps
<coding>: current channel coding (refer +CHSD command for possible values). This parameter is not applicable
in UTRAN.
Implementation
Optional.
6.16 HSCSD parameters report +CHSR
Table 23: +CHSR action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CHSR=[<mode>]
+CHSR? +CHSR: <mode>
+CHSR=? +CHSR: (list of supported <mode>s)

Description
Enabled command returns intermediate result code +CHSR: <type> from the TA to the TE when an HSCSD call is
being set up. The result code represents the current (negotiated or renegotiated) HSCSD parameters. If enabled, the
intermediate result code is transmitted at the point of the call setup negotiation where the TA has determined what type
of an HSCSD connection will be used. Result code transmission is done after possible service (+CR), error control
(+ER), and/or compression (+DR) reporting but before possible TE-TA rate (+ILRR) reporting and before the
intermediate result code CONNECT is transmitted. The format of the intermediate result code is:
+CHSR: <rx>,<tx>,<aiur>,<coding>
For the value definitions, refer to +CHSN and +CHSC commands. For instance, for a non-transparent HSCSD call, result
code '+CHSR: 2,2,4,8' means that the call has two timeslots in both up- and downlink, the air interface user rate is
28800 bps, and the used channel coding TCH/F14.4.
In UTRAN, all non-applicable parameters returned shall be equal to zero.
Defined values
<mode>:
0 disables reporting
1 enables reporting

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 38 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Implementation
Mandatory when HSCSD implemented
6.17 HSCSD automatic user initiated upgrading + CHSU
Table 24: +CHSU parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CHSU=<mode>
+CHSU? +CHSU: <mode>
+CHSU=?
+CHSU: (list of supported <mode>s)

Description
Set command controls whether or not automatic user initiated service level upgrading shall be used for non-transparent
HSCSD calls. "Automatic" means that, if enabled, the ME/TA shall use the UP bit in the received RLP frames to
determine when to initiate user initiated service level upgrading (i.e. when to modify the +CHSN parameters <wAiur>
and/or <wRx> for the current call). Refer to 3GPP TS 27.001 for details on the interpretation of the UP bit(s).
NOTE1: The validity of the UP bit in the RLP frames depends on the result of the RLP negotiations. The UP bit
shall only be used if the result of the RLP negotiations were successful with respect to the UP bit.
NOTE2: This command is only applicable in GERAN.
Defined values
<mode>:
0 disables use of UP bit for upgrading
1 enables use of UP bit for upgrading
Implementation
Optional
This command is not applicable to UTRAN single mode UE.
6.18 HSCSD non-transparent asymmetry configuration +CHSA
Table 25: +CHSA parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CHSA=<mode>
+CHSA? +CHSA: <mode>
+CHSA=?
+CHSA: (list of supported <mode>s)

Description
Set command controls the preferred asymmetry bias for non-transparent ECSD calls. Downlink biased asymmetry
means that 8-PSK modulation is preferred downlink and GMSK modulation uplink. Uplink based asymmetry means
that 8-PSK modulation is preferred uplink and GMSK downlink. Changing of <mode> affects the current call only if
<topRx> (refer +CHSN) was non-zero when call was established.
Test command returns values supported by the MT/TA as compound values. The <mode> subparameter range
indirectly indicates the UE Type; range (0-1) indicates UE Type A and range (0-2) indicates UE Type B.
NOTE1: ECSD is also controlled by +CHSD, +CHSN and +CHST.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 39 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
NOTE2: This command is only applicable in GERAN.
Defined values
<mode>:
0 No preference
1 Downlink biased asymmetry
2 Uplink biased asymmetry
Implementation
Mandatory when non-transparent ECSD is implemented.
This command is not applicable to UTRAN single mode UE.
6.19 Single numbering scheme +CSNS
Table 26: +CSNS parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CSNS=[<mode>]
+CSNS? +CSNS: <mode>
+CSNS=?
+CSNS: (list of supported <mode>s)

Description
Set command selects the bearer or teleservice to be used when mobile terminated single numbering scheme call is
established. Parameter values set with +CBST command shall be used when <mode> equals to a data service.
Test command returns values supported as compound values.
Defined values
<mode>:
0 voice
1 alternating voice/fax, voice first (TS 61)
2 fax (TS 62)
3 alternating voice/data, voice first (BS 61)
4 data
5 alternating voice/fax, fax first (TS 61)
6 alternating voice/data, data first (BS 61)
7 voice followed by data (BS 81)
Implementation
Optional.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 40 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
6.20 Voice Hangup Control +CVHU
Table 27: +CVHU parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CVHU=[<mode>]
+CVHU? +CVHU:<mode>
+CVHU=?
+CVHU:(list of supported <mode>s)

Description
Set command selects whether ATH or "drop DTR" shall cause a voice connection to be disconnected or not. By voice
connection is also meant alternating mode calls that are currently in voice mode. (See subclause 6.6).
NOTE: When <mode> = 2, this command must be seen in conjunction with the V.250 [14] command &D. Else
&D shall be ignored.
Defined values
<mode>:
0 "Drop DTR" ignored but OK response given. ATH disconnects.
1 "Drop DTR" and ATH ignored but OK response given.
2 "Drop DTR" behaviour according to &D setting. ATH disconnects.
Implementation
Optional
6.21 V.120 rate adaption protocol +CV120
Table 28: +CV120 parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CV120=[<rah>[,<mfm>[,
<mode>[,<llineg>[,
<assign>[,<negtype>]]]]]]

+CV120? +CV120: <rah>,<mfm>,<mode>,<llineg>,
<assign>,<negtype>
+CV120=? +CV120: (list of supported <rah>s),(list of supported
<mfm>s),(list of supported <mode>s),(list of supported
<llineg>s),(list of supported <assign>s),(list of
supported <negtype>s)

Description
Set command sets the values of the V.120 protocol parameters (defined in CCITT V.120) that are carried in the GSM
BC and/or LLC information elements.
Read command returns current settings for the V.120 parameters.
Test command returns values supported as a compound value.
Defined values
<rah>
0 rate adaption header not included

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 41 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
1 rate adaption header included (mandatory for protocol sensitive modes).
<mfm>
0 multiple frame establishment not supported, only UI frames allowed
1 multiple frame establishment supported, both I and UI frames allowed.
<mode>
0 bit transparent mode of operation
1 protocol sensitive mode of operation.
<llineg>
0 no negotiation, LLI = 256 only
1 negotiation allowed. Note - <negtype> indicates the connection over which the negotiation is performed.
<assign>
0 message originator is "default assignee"
1 message originator is "assignor only".
<negtype>
0 negotiation is done using logical link zero
1 negotiation is done with USER INFORMATION messages on a temporary signalling connection.
GSM/UMTS does not support all the possible modes of V.120 operation. However, in order to accommodate possible
future additions, the complete set of parameters is included in the command.
The permitted values are: 1, 1 or 0, 1, 0, 0, 0.
A recommended set of default values is: 1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0.
Implementation
Mandatory, if the MT supports V.120 interworking.
6.22 Settings date format +CSDF
Table 29: +CSDF parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CSDF=[[<mode>]
[,<auxmode>]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CSDF? +CSDF:<mode>[,<auxmode>]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CSDF=?
+CSDF:(list of supported <mode>s)
[, (list of supported <auxmode>s)]
+CME ERROR: <err>

Description
This command sets the date format via MMI of the date information presented to the user, which is specified by use of
the <mode> parameter. The <mode> affects the date format on the phone display and doesn't affect the date format of
the AT command serial interface. The command also sets the date format of the TE-TA interface, which is specified by
use of the <auxmode> parameter (e.g. the <auxmode> affects the <time> of +CCLK and +CALA). If the parameter is
omitted ("+CSDF =","+CSDF =<mode>","+CSDF=,<auxmode>"),then this sets the default value.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 42 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Defined values
<mode>:
NOTE: It is manufacturer specific which modes that are supported.
1 DD-MMM-YYYY
NOTE: Presentation of MMM is language dependent.
2 DD-MM-YY
3 MM/DD/YY
4 DD/MM/YY
5 DD.MM.YY
6 YYMMDD
7 YY-MM-DD
8-255 Manufacturer specific
<auxmode>:
1 yy/MM/dd (default)
2 yyyy/MM/dd
also all other values are reserved by the present document
NOTE: The <time> format of +CCLK and +CALA "yy/MM/dd,hh:mm:sszz" when <auxmode>=1 and it is
"yyyy/MM/dd,hh:mm:sszz" when <auxmode>=2. If the MT does not support time zone information
then the three last characters may be omitted (see +CCLK command).
Implementation
Optional
6.23 Silence Command +CSIL
Table 30: +CSIL parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CSIL=[<mode>] +CME ERROR: <err>
+CSIL? +CSIL:<mode>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CSIL=?
+CSIL:(list of supported <mode>s)
+CME ERROR: <err>

Description
Set command enables/disables the silent mode. When the phone is in silent mode, all sounds from MT are suppressed
except voice.
Read command reads the current setting.
Test command lists the supported modes.
Defined values
<mode>:
0 Silent mode off

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 43 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
1 Silent mode on
Implementation
Optional
6.24 Settings time format +CSTF
Table 31: +CSTF parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CSTF=[<mode>] +CME ERROR: <err>
+CSTF? +CSTF:<mode>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CSTF=?
+CSTF:(list of supported <mode>s)
+CME ERROR: <err>

Description
Set command sets the time format of the time information presented to the user.
Read commands reads the current setting.
Test commands reads the supported <modes>s.
Defined values
<mode>:
1 HH:MM (24 hour clock)
2 HH:MM a.m./p.m.
3-7 Manufacturer specific
Implementation
Optional

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 44 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
6.25 ITU-T V.250 [14] call control commands
Table 32: V.250 call control commands
Command Subclause Impl. Use in GSM/UMTS
D[<dial_
string>][;]
6.3.1 mand. originates a call
T 6.3.2 mand. ignored (select tone dialling)
P 6.3.3 mand. ignored (select pulse dialling)
A 6.3.5 mand. answer a call
H[<value>] 6.3.6 mand. hang-up a single mode call; for alternate mode call refer subclause
"Hangup call +CHUP" (only value equal to zero needed)
O[<value>] 6.3.7 mand. returns TA to online data state from online command mode (only value
equal to zero needed)
S0=[<value>] 6.3.8 mand. sets the number of call indications (rings) before automatically
answering the call; value equalling zero disables automatic answering
and is the default
S6=[<value>] 6.3.9 mand. ignored (pause before blind dialling)
S7=[<value>] 6.3.10 mand. sets number of seconds to wait for completion of call answering or
originating procedure before giving up and disconnecting
S8=[<value>] 6.3.11 mand. sets number of seconds to wait when comma dial modifier encountered
in dial string of D command (default is 2 seconds)
S10=[<value>] 6.3.12 mand. sets number of tenths of seconds to wait before disconnecting after TA
has indicated the absence of received line signal
L[<value>] 6.3.13 mand. ignored (monitor speaker loudness)
M[<value>] 6.3.14 mand. ignored (monitor speaker mode)

6.26 ITU-T V.250 [14] data compression commands
Table 33: V.250 data compression commands
Command Subclause Impl. Use in GSM/UMTS
+DS=[<dir>[,<neg>
[,<P1>[,<P2>]]]]
6.6.1 mand.
when
V.42bis
controls ITU-T Recommendation V.42bis data compression
functions; for subparameter defaults in GSM/UMTS refer
3GPP TS 24.022 [18]
+DR=[<value>] 6.6.2 mand.
when
V.42bis
determines whether the use of V.42bis is informed using
intermediate result code +DR: <type> before going
online data state after call answering or originating

6.27 Informative examples
The alternating mode call handling (voice and fax, or voice and data) and the data call setup commands are defined such
that the dialling command of V.250 [14] (D) still always originates a call. The purpose is to support all current TE
applications using the dialling command as default. Fax calls are controlled following the rules of ITU-T T.31 [11] and
T.32 [12] standards.
An example where a voice call is originated:
ATD+1 812 555673I; (type of address defaults to 145, CLI presentation is restricted for this call)
OK (call setup was successful)

An example where a voice call is attempted from a phonebook:
ATD>"Doe Joe"G; (enable CUG control for this call)
+CME ERROR: 22 (entry "Doe Joe" is not found)


ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 45 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Also supplementary services may be controlled using dial command according to 3GPP TS 22.030 [19]. An example of
call forwarding on no reply for telephony with the adjustment of the no reply condition timer on 25 seconds:
ATD**61*+1812555673*11*25#
OK (modification was successful)

Two new commands are created for controlling the alternating mode calls. First one, Call Mode (+CMOD), selects
between single and alternating mode. Because this is a crucial command, it is defined that the value is set back to
zero (single mode) after every successfully originated alternating mode call. Also on power-up and factory or user
resets, the value is set to zero. The second new command, Hangup Call (+CHUP), is not a replacement of V.250 [14]
command H, but a command which reliably disconnects the call in GSM/UMTS network. This is defined because the H
command is used to switch from fax or data mode to voice mode.
The setting of GSM/UMTS bearer service (data circuit duplex asynchronous and synchronous, PAD access circuit
asynchronous, or data packet duplex synchronous), is done with Select Bearer Service Type (+CBST). It chooses one of
the four mentioned bearer services, the data rate of the service (or actually the modulation when modem IWFs are
used), and enables or disables RLP. Command Radio Link Protocol (+CRLP) is used to set the RLP parameters in the
radio path.
Service Reporting Control command (+CR) is defined similarly as the reporting of modulation, V.18, error control, and
data compression which are V.250 [14] features used to show information about the type of the established connection
before the CONNECT intermediate result code. +CR command has one subparameter which specifies whether the
intermediate result code +CR: <serv> is returned or not. The result code should be returned before any V.250 [14]
reporting result codes. An example of setting up an asynchronous 9600 bit/s modem connection with service reporting:
AT+CBST=7,0,1 (asynchronous modem 9600 bit/s and RLP)
OK
AT+CR=1 (enable reporting)
OK
ATD1234567890
+CR: REL ASYNC
CONNECT 9600

As GSM/UMTS network offers more information about the reason of the failure in call originating and answering than
normal PSTN, it is useful to add an extra command to return this information to the TE. This information should not be
returned always after unsuccessful call originating or answering, because many TE applications look for just the regular
NO CARRIER, BUSY, NO ANSWER and CONNECT messages. Action command Extended Error Report (+CEER) does
not have any subparameters, and it returns the cause of the latest call setup failure. This information may be the textual
presentation of the GSM/UMTS network failure code (refer TS 24.008 [8] Annex H), or some other information defined
by the TA manufacturer.
7 Network service related commands
This clause describes GSM/UMTS network related commands, which are not covered in call control clause of the
present document. Commands include GSM/UMTS supplementary service handling, MSISDN query, MT and network
facility locking, and network registration information query.
7.1 Subscriber number +CNUM
Table 34: +CNUM action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CNUM +CNUM: [<alpha1>],<number1>,<type1>[,<speed>,<service>[,<itc>]]
[<CR><LF>+CNUM: [<alpha2>],<number2>,<type2>[,<speed>,<service>
[,<itc>]]
[...]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CNUM=?

Description

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 46 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Action command returns the MSISDNs related to the subscriber (this information can be stored in the SIM/UICC or in
the MT). When storing information in the SIM/UICC, if a SIM card is present or if a UICC with an active GSM
application is present, the information is stored in the EF
MSISDN
under DF
Telecom
. If a UICC with an active USIM
application is present, the information is stored in the EF
MSISDN
under ADF
USIM
). If subscriber has different MSISDN for
different services, each MSISDN is returned in a separate line. Refer subclause 9.2 for possible <err> values.
Defined values
<alphax>: optional alphanumeric string associated with <numberx>; used character set should be the one
selected with command Select TE Character Set +CSCS
<numberx>: string type phone number of format specified by <typex>
<typex>: type of address octet in integer format (refer TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.4.7)
<speed>: as defined in subclause 6.7
<service> (service related to the phone number):
0 asynchronous modem
1 synchronous modem
2 PAD Access (asynchronous)
3 Packet Access (synchronous)
4 voice
5 fax
also all other values below 128 are reserved by the present document
<itc> (information transfer capability):
0 3,1 kHz
1 UDI
Implementation
Optional.
7.2 Network registration +CREG
Table 35: +CREG parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CREG=[<n>]
+CREG? +CREG: <n>,<stat>[,<lac>,<ci>[,<AcT>]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CREG=?
+CREG: (list of supported <n>s)

Description
Set command controls the presentation of an unsolicited result code +CREG: <stat> when <n>=1 and there is a
change in the MT network registration status, or code +CREG: <stat>[,<lac>,<ci>[,<AcT>]] when <n>=2
and there is a change of the network cell.
Read command returns the status of result code presentation and an integer <stat> which shows whether the network
has currently indicated the registration of the MT. Location information elements <lac>, <ci> and <AcT>are
returned only when <n>=2 and MT is registered in the network. Refer subclause 9.2 for possible <err> values.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 47 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Defined values
<n>:
0 disable network registration unsolicited result code
1 enable network registration unsolicited result code +CREG: <stat>
2 enable network registration and location information unsolicited result code +CREG:
<stat>[,<lac>,<ci>[,<AcT>]]
<stat>: registration status
0 not registered, MT is not currently searching a new operator to register to
1 registered, home network
2 not registered, but MT is currently searching a new operator to register to
3 registration denied
4 unknown
5 registered, roaming
<lac>: string type; two byte location area code in hexadecimal format (e.g. "00C3" equals 195 in decimal)
<ci>: string type; four byte UTRAN/GERAN cell ID in hexadecimal format
<AcT>: access technology of the registered network
0 GSM
1 GSM Compact
2 UTRAN
3 GSM w/EGPRS (see NOTE 1)
4 UTRAN w/HSDPA (see NOTE 2)
5 UTRAN w/HSUPA (see NOTE 2)
6 UTRAN w/HSDPA and HSUPA (see NOTE 2)
NOTE 1: 3GPP TS 44.060 [71] specifies the System Information messages which give the information about
whether the serving cell supports EGPRS.
NOTE 2: 3GPP TS 25.331 [74] specifies the System Information blocks which give the information about whether
the serving cell supports HSDPA or HSUPA.
Implementation
Optional.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 48 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
7.3 PLMN selection +COPS
Table 36: +COPS parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+COPS=[<mode>[,<format>
[,<oper>[,< AcT>]]]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+COPS?
+COPS: <mode>[,<format>,<oper>[,< AcT>]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+COPS=?
+COPS: [list of supported (<stat>,long alphanumeric <oper>
,short alphanumeric <oper>,numeric <oper>[,< AcT>])s]
[,,(list of supported <mode>s),(list of supported <format>s)]
+CME ERROR: <err>

Description
Set command forces an attempt to select and register the GSM/UMTS network operator. <mode> is used to select
whether the selection is done automatically by the MT or is forced by this command to operator <oper> (it shall be
given in format <format>) to a certain access technology, indicated in <AcT>. If the selected operator is not
available, no other operator shall be selected (except <mode>=4). If the selected access technology is not available,
then the same operator shall be selected in other access technology. The selected operator name format shall apply to
further read commands (+COPS?) also. <mode>=2 forces an attempt to deregister from the network. The selected
mode affects to all further network registration (e.g. after <mode>=2, MT shall be unregistered until <mode>=0 or 1 is
selected). Refer subclause 9.2 for possible <err> values. This command should be abortable when
registration/deregistration attempt is made.
Read command returns the current mode, the currently selected operator and the current Access Technology. If no
operator is selected, <format>, <oper> and < AcT> are omitted.
Test command returns a set of five parameters, each representing an operator present in the network. A set consists of
an integer indicating the availability of the operator <stat>, long and short alphanumeric format of the name of the
operator, numeric format representation of the operator and access technology. Any of the formats may be unavailable
and should then be an empty field. The list of operators shall be in order: home network, networks referenced in SIM or
active application in the UICC (GSM or USIM) in the following order: HPLMN selector, User controlled PLMN
selector, Operator controlled PLMN selector and PLMN selector (in the SIM or GSM application), and other networks.
It is recommended (although optional) that after the operator list TA returns lists of supported <mode>s and
<format>s. These lists shall be delimited from the operator list by two commas.
The access technology selected parameters, <AcT>, should only be used in terminals capable to register to more than
one access technology. Selection of <AcT> does not limit the capability to cell reselections, even though an attempt is
made to select an access technology, the phone may still re-select a cell in another access technology.
Defined values
<mode>:
0 automatic (<oper> field is ignored)
1 manual (<oper> field shall be present, and <AcT> optionally)
2 deregister from network
3 set only <format> (for read command +COPS?), do not attempt registration/deregistration (<oper> and <
AcT> fields are ignored); this value is not applicable in read command response
4 manual/automatic (<oper> field shall be present); if manual selection fails, automatic mode (<mode>=0) is
entered
<format>:

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 49 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
0 long format alphanumeric <oper>
1 short format alphanumeric <oper>
2 numeric <oper>
<oper>: string type; <format> indicates if the format is alphanumeric or numeric; long alphanumeric format can
be upto 16 characters long and short format up to 8 characters (refer GSM MoU SE.13 [9]); numeric format is
the GSM Location Area Identification number (refer TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.1.3) which consists of a three
BCD digit country code coded as in ITU-T E.212 Annex A [10], plus a two BCD digit network code, which is
administration specific; returned <oper> shall not be in BCD format, but in IRA characters converted from
BCD; hence the number has structure: (country code digit 3)(country code digit 2)(country code digit 1)(network
code digit 3)(network code digit 2)(network code digit 1)
<stat>:
0 unknown
1 available
2 current
3 forbidden
<AcT> access technology selected:
0 GSM
1 GSM Compact
2 UTRAN
3 GSM w/EGPRS (see NOTE 1)
4 UTRAN w/HSDPA (see NOTE 2)
5 UTRAN w/HSUPA (see NOTE 2)
6 UTRAN w/HSDPA and HSUPA (see NOTE 2)
NOTE 1: 3GPP TS 44.060 [71] specifies the System Information messages which give the information about
whether the serving cell supports EGPRS.
NOTE 2: 3GPP TS 25.331 [74] specifies the System Information blocks which give the information about whether
the serving cell supports HSDPA or HSUPA.
Implementation
Optional.
7.4 Facility lock +CLCK
Table 37: +CLCK action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CLCK=<fac>,<mode>[,<passwd>[
,<class>]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
when <mode>=2 and command successful:
+CLCK: <status>[,<class1>
[<CR><LF>+CLCK: <status>,<class2>
[...]]
+CLCK=?
+CLCK: (list of supported <fac>s)
+CME ERROR: <err>


ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 50 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Description
Execute command is used to lock, unlock or interrogate a MT or a network facility <fac>. Password is normally
needed to do such actions. When querying the status of a network service (<mode>=2) the response line for 'not active'
case (<status>=0) should be returned only if service is not active for any <class>. Refer subclause 9.2 for possible
<err> values. This command should be abortable when network facilities are set or interrogated.
Call barring facilities are based on GSM/UMTS supplementary services (refer 3GPP TS 22.088 [6]). The interaction of
these with other commands based on other GSM/UMTS supplementary services is described in the GSM/UMTS
standard.
Test command returns facility values supported as a compound value.
Defined values
<fac> values reserved by the present document:
"CS" CNTRL (lock CoNTRoL surface (e.g. phone keyboard))
"PS" PH-SIM (lock PHone to SIM/UICC card) (MT asks password when other than current SIM/UICC card
inserted; MT may remember certain amount of previously used cards thus not requiring password when they
are inserted)
"PF" lock Phone to the very First inserted SIM/UICC card (also referred in the present document as PH-FSIM)
(MT asks password when other than the first SIM/UICC card is inserted)
"SC" SIM (lock SIM/UICC card) (SIM/UICC asks password in MT power-up and when this lock command
issued)
"AO" BAOC (Barr All Outgoing Calls) (refer 3GPP TS 22.088 [6] clause 1)
"OI" BOIC (Barr Outgoing International Calls) (refer 3GPP TS 22.088 [6] clause 1)
"OX" BOIC-exHC (Barr Outgoing International Calls except to Home Country) (refer 3GPP TS 22.088 [6] clause
1)
"AI" BAIC (Barr All Incoming Calls) (refer 3GPP TS 22.088 [6] clause 2)
"IR" BIC-Roam (Barr Incoming Calls when Roaming outside the home country) (refer 3GPP TS 22.088 [6] clause
2)
"NT" barr incoming calls from numbers Not stored to TA memory
"NM" barr incoming calls from numbers Not stored to MT memory
"NS" barr incoming calls from numbers Not stored to SIM/UICC memory
"NA" barr incoming calls from numbers Not stored in Any memory
"AB" All Barring services (refer 3GPP TS 22.030 [19]) (applicable only for <mode>=0)
"AG" All outGoing barring services (refer 3GPP TS 22.030 [19]) (applicable only for <mode>=0)
"AC" All inComing barring services (refer 3GPP TS 22.030 [19]) (applicable only for <mode>=0)
"FD" SIM card or active application in the UICC (GSM or USIM) fixed dialling memory feature (if PIN2
authentication has not been done during the current session, PIN2 is required as <passwd>)
"PN" Network Personalization (refer 3GPP TS 22.022 [33])
"PU" network sUbset Personalization (refer 3GPP TS 22.022 [33])
"PP" service Provider Personalization (refer 3GPP TS 22.022 [33])
"PC" Corporate Personalization (refer 3GPP TS 22.022 [33])

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 51 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
<mode>:
0 unlock
1 lock
2 query status
<status>:
0 not active
1 active
<passwd>: string type; shall be the same as password specified for the facility from the MT user interface or with
command Change Password +CPWD
<classx> is a sum of integers each representing a class of information (default 7):
1 voice (telephony)
2 data (refers to all bearer services; with <mode>=2 this may refer only to some bearer service if TA does not
support values 16, 32, 64 and 128)
4 fax (facsimile services)
8 short message service
16 data circuit sync
32 data circuit async
64 dedicated packet access
128 dedicated PAD access
Implementation
The call barring supplementary service control is mandatory for MT supporting AT commands only and not supporting
the control through dial command D.
7.5 Change password +CPWD
Table 38: +CPWD action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CPWD=<fac>,<oldpwd>,<newpwd> +CME ERROR: <err>
+CPWD=?
+CPWD: list of supported (<fac>,<pwdlength>)s
+CME ERROR: <err>

Description
Action command sets a new password for the facility lock function defined by command Facility Lock +CLCK. Refer
subclause 9.2 for possible <err> values.
Test command returns a list of pairs which present the available facilities and the maximum length of their password.
Defined values
<fac>:
"P2" SIM PIN2
refer Facility Lock +CLCK for other values

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 52 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
<oldpwd>, <newpwd>: string type; <oldpwd> shall be the same as password specified for the facility from the
MT user interface or with command Change Password +CPWD and <newpwd> is the new password; maximum
length of password can be determined with <pwdlength>
<pwdlength>: integer type maximum length of the password for the facility
Implementation
Optional.
7.6 Calling line identification presentation +CLIP
Table 39: +CLIP parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CLIP=[<n>]
+CLIP? +CLIP: <n>,<m>
+CLIP=?
+CLIP: (list of supported <n>s)

Description
This command refers to the GSM/UMTS supplementary service CLIP (Calling Line Identification Presentation) that
enables a called subscriber to get the calling line identity (CLI) of the calling party when receiving a mobile terminated
call. Set command enables or disables the presentation of the CLI at the TE. It has no effect on the execution of the
supplementary service CLIP in the network.
When the presentation of the CLI at the TE is enabled (and calling subscriber allows), +CLIP:
<number>,<type>[,<subaddr>,<satype>[,[<alpha>][,<CLI validity>]]] response is returned
after every RING (or +CRING: <type>; refer subclause "Cellular result codes +CRC") result code sent from TA to
TE. It is manufacturer specific if this response is used when normal voice call is answered.
Read command gives the status of <n>, and also triggers an interrogation of the provision status of the CLIP service
according 3GPP TS 22.081 [3] (given in <m>).Test command returns values supported as a compound value.
Defined values
<n> (parameter sets/shows the result code presentation status to the TE):
0 disable
1 enable
<m> (parameter shows the subscriber CLIP service status in the network):
0 CLIP not provisioned
1 CLIP provisioned
2 unknown (e.g. no network, etc.)
<number>: string type phone number of format specified by <type>
<type>: type of address octet in integer format (refer TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.4.7)
<subaddr>: string type subaddress of format specified by <satype>
<satype>: type of subaddress octet in integer format (refer TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.4.8)
<alpha>: optional string type alphanumeric representation of <number> corresponding to the entry found in
phonebook; used character set should be the one selected with command Select TE Character Set +CSCS
<CLI validity>:

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 53 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
0 CLI valid
1 CLI has been withheld by the originator.
2 CLI is not available due to interworking problems or limitations of originating network.
When CLI is not available ( <CLI validity>=2), <number> shall be an empty string ("") and <type> value will
not be significant. Nevertheless, TA may return the recommended value 128 for <type> ((TON/NPI unknown in
accordance with TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.4.7).
When CLI has been withheld by the originator, (<CLI validity>=1) and the CLIP is provisioned with the
"override category" option (refer 3GPP TS 22.081[3] and 3GPP TS 23.081[40]), <number> and <type> is provided.
Otherwise, TA shall return the same setting for <number> and <type> as if the CLI was not available.
Implementation
Optional.
7.7 Calling line identification restriction +CLIR
Table 40: +CLIR parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CLIR=[<n>]
+CLIR? +CLIR: <n>,<m>
+CLIR=?
+CLIR: (list of supported <n>s)

Description
This command refers to CLIR-service according to 3GPP TS 22.081 [3] that allows a calling subscriber to enable or
disable the presentation of the CLI to the called party when originating a call.
Set command overrides the CLIR subscription (default is restricted or allowed) when temporary mode is provisioned as
a default adjustment for all following outgoing calls. This adjustment can be revoked by using the opposite command..
If this command is used by a subscriber without provision of CLIR in permanent mode the network will act according
3GPP TS 22.081 [3].
Read command gives the default adjustment for all outgoing calls (given in <n>), and also triggers an interrogation of
the provision status of the CLIR service (given in <m>). Test command returns values supported as a compound value.
NOTE: On a per call base CLIR functionality is explained in subclause "ITU-T V.250 [14] dial command".
Defined values
<n> (parameter sets the adjustment for outgoing calls):
0 presentation indicator is used according to the subscription of the CLIR service
1 CLIR invocation
2 CLIR suppression
<m> (parameter shows the subscriber CLIR service status in the network):
0 CLIR not provisioned
1 CLIR provisioned in permanent mode
2 unknown (e.g. no network, etc.)
3 CLIR temporary mode presentation restricted
4 CLIR temporary mode presentation allowed

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 54 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Implementation
Optional.
7.8 Connected line identification presentation +COLP
Table 41: +COLP parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+COLP=[<n>]
+COLP? +COLP: <n>,<m>
+COLP=?
+COLP: (list of supported <n>s)

Description
This command refers to the GSM/UMTS supplementary service COLP (Connected Line Identification Presentation)
that enables a calling subscriber to get the connected line identity (COL) of the called party after setting up a mobile
originated call. The command enables or disables the presentation of the COL at the TE. It has no effect on the
execution of the supplementary service COLR in the network.
When enabled (and called subscriber allows), +COLP:
<number>,<type>[,<subaddr>,<satype> [,<alpha>]] intermediate result code is returned from TA to
TE before any +CR or V.250 [14] responses. It is manufacturer specific if this response is used when normal voice call
is established.
Read command gives the status of <n>, and also triggers an interrogation of the provision status of the COLP service
according 3GPP TS 22.081 [3] (given in <m>).
Test command returns values supported as a compound value.
Defined values
<n> (parameter sets/shows the result code presentation status to the TE):
0 disable
1 enable
<m> (parameter shows the subscriber COLP service status in the network):
0 COLP not provisioned
1 COLP provisioned
2 unknown (e.g. no network, etc.)
<number>, <type>, <subaddr>, <satype>, <alpha>: refer +CLIP
Implementation
Optional.
7.9 Called line identification presentation +CDIP
Table 42: +CDIP parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CDIP=[<n>]
+CDIP? +CDIP: <n>,<m>
+CDIP=?
+CDIP: (list of supported <n>s)


ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 55 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Description
This command related to a network service that provides "multiple called numbers (called line identifications) service"
to an MT. This command enables a called subscriber to get the called line identification of the called party when
receiving a mobile terminated call. Set command enables or disables the presentation of the called line identifications at
the TE.
When the presentation of the called line identification at the TE is enabled,
+CDIP:<number>,<type>[,<subaddr>,<satype>] response is returned after every RING (or +CRING:
<type>; refer subclause "Cellular result codes +CRC") result code sent from TA to TE. It is manufacturer specific if
this response is used when normal voice call is answered.
Read command gives the status of <n>, and also triggers an interrogation of the provision status of the "multiple called
numbers" service. Test command returns values supported as a compound value.
Defined values
<n> (parameter sets/shows the result code presentation status to the TE):
0 disable
1 enable
<m> (parameter shows the subscriber "multiple called numbers" service status in the network):
0 "multiple called numbers service" is not provisioned
1 "multiple called numbers service" is provisioned
2 unknown (e.g. no network, etc.)
<number>: string type phone number of format specified by <type>
<type>: type of address octet in integer format (refer TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.4.7)
<subaddr>: string type subaddress of format specified by <satype>
<satype>: type of subaddress octet in integer format (refer TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.4.8)
Implementation
Optional.
7.10 Closed user group +CCUG
Table 43: +CCUG parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CCUG=[<n>[,<index>[,<info>]]]
+CCUG? +CCUG: <n>,<index>,<info>
+CCUG=?

Description
This command allows control of the Closed User Group supplementary service (refer 3GPP TS 22.085 [21]). Set
command enables the served subscriber to select a CUG index, to suppress the Outgoing Access (OA), and to suppress
the preferential CUG.
Set command with <n>=1 enables to control the CUG information on the air interface as a default adjustment for all
following outgoing calls. The interaction of this command with other commands based on other GSM/UMTS
supplementary services is described in the GSM/UMTS standard.
NOTE: On a per call base CUG functionality is explained in subclause "ITU-T V.250 [14] dial command".

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 56 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Defined values
<n>:
0 disable CUG temporary mode
1 enable CUG temporary mode
<index>:
0...9 CUG index
10 no index (preferred CUG taken from subscriber data)
<info>:
0 no information
1 suppress OA
2 suppress preferential CUG
3 suppress OA and preferential CUG
Implementation
Optional.
7.11 Call forwarding number and conditions +CCFC
Table 44: +CCFC action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CCFC=<reason>,<mode>
[,<number>[,<type>
[,<class>
[,<subaddr>[,<satype>
[,<time>]]]]]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
when <mode>=2 and command successful:
+CCFC: <status>,<class1>[,<number>,<type>
[,<subaddr>,<satype>[,<time>]]][
<CR><LF>+CCFC: <status>,<class2>[,<number>,<type>
[,<subaddr>,<satype>[,<time>]]]
[...]]
+CCFC=?
+CCFC: (list of supported <reason>s)

Description
This command allows control of the call forwarding supplementary service according to 3GPP TS 22.082 [4].
Registration, erasure, activation, deactivation, and status query are supported. When querying the status of a network
service (<mode>=2) the response line for 'not active' case (<status>=0) should be returned only if service is not
active for any <class>.
Test command returns reason values supported as a compound value.
Defined values
<reason>:
0 unconditional
1 mobile busy
2 no reply
3 not reachable

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 57 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
4 all call forwarding (refer 3GPP TS 22.030 [19])
5 all conditional call forwarding (refer 3GPP TS 22.030 [19])
<mode>:
0 disable
1 enable
2 query status
3 registration
4 erasure
<number>: string type phone number of forwarding address in format specified by <type>
<type>: type of address octet in integer format (refer TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.4.7); default 145 when dialling
string includes international access code character "+", otherwise 129
<subaddr>: string type subaddress of format specified by <satype>
<satype>: type of subaddress octet in integer format (refer TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.4.8); default 128
<classx> is a sum of integers each representing a class of information (default 7):
1 voice (telephony)
2 data (refers to all bearer services; with <mode>=2 this may refer only to some bearer service if TA does not
support values 16, 32, 64 and 128)
4 fax (facsimile services)
8 short message service
16 data circuit sync
32 data circuit async
64 dedicated packet access
128 dedicated PAD access
<time>:
1...30 when "no reply" is enabled or queried, this gives the time in seconds to wait before call is forwarded,
default value 20
<status>:
0 not active
1 active
Implementation
Mandatory for MT supporting AT commands only and not supporting the control through dial command D.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 58 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
7.12 Call waiting +CCWA
Table 45: +CCWA parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CCWA=[<n>[,<mode>[,<class>]]] +CME ERROR: <err>
when <mode>=2 and command successful
+CCWA: <status>,<class1>
[<CR><LF>+CCWA: <status>,<class2>
[...]]
+CCWA? +CCWA: <n>
+CCWA=?
+CCWA: (list of supported <n>s)

Description
This command allows control of the Call Waiting supplementary service according to 3GPP TS 22.083 [5]. Activation,
deactivation and status query are supported. When querying the status of a network service (<mode>=2) the response
line for 'not active' case (<status>=0) should be returned only if service is not active for any <class>. Parameter
<n> is used to disable/enable the presentation of an unsolicited result code +CCWA:
<number>,<type>,<class>,[<alpha>][,<CLI validity>[,<subaddr>,<satype>
[,<priority> ]]] to the TE when call waiting service is enabled. Command should be abortable when network is
interrogated.
The interaction of this command with other commands based on other GSM/UMTS supplementary services is described
in the GSM/UMTS standards.
Test command returns values supported as a compound value.
Defined values
<n> (sets/shows the result code presentation status to the TE):
0 disable
1 enable
<mode> (when <mode> parameter is not given, network is not interrogated):
0 disable
1 enable
2 query status
<classx> is a sum of integers each representing a class of information (default 7):
1 voice (telephony)
2 data (refers to all bearer services; with <mode>=2 this may refer only to some bearer service if TA does not
support values 16, 32, 64 and 128)
4 fax (facsimile services)
8 short message service
16 data circuit sync
32 data circuit async
64 dedicated packet access
128 dedicated PAD access

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 59 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
<status>:
0 not active
1 active
<number>: string type phone number of calling address in format specified by <type>
<type>: type of address octet in integer format (refer TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.4.7)
<alpha>: optional string type alphanumeric representation of <number> corresponding to the entry found in
phonebook; used character set should be the one selected with command Select TE Character Set +CSCS
<CLI validity>:
0 CLI valid
1 CLI has been withheld by the originator.
2 CLI is not available due to interworking problems or limitations of originating network.
When CLI is not available (<CLI validity>=2), <number> shall be an empty string ("") and <type> value will
not be significant. Nevertheless, TA may return the recommended value 128 for <type> ((TON/NPI unknown in
accordance with TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.4.7).
When CLI has been withheld by the originator, (<CLI validity>=1) and the CLIP is provisioned with the
"override category" option (refer 3GPP TS 22.081[3] and 3GPP TS 23.081[40]), <number> and <type> is provided.
Otherwise, TA shall return the same setting for <number> and <type> as if the CLI was not available.
<subaddr>: string type subaddress of format specified by <satype>
<satype>: type of subaddress octet in integer format (refer TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.4.8)
<priority>: optional digit type parameter indicating that the eMLPP priority level of the incoming call. The priority
level values are as defined in eMLPP specification 3GPP TS 22.067 [54].

Implementation
Optional.
7.13 Call related supplementary services +CHLD
Table 46: +CHLD action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CHLD=[<n>] +CME ERROR: <err>
+CHLD=?
[+CHLD: (list of supported <n>s)]

Description
This command allows the control of the following call related services:
- a call can be temporarily disconnected from the MT but the connection is retained by the network;
- multiparty conversation (conference calls);
- the served subscriber who has two calls (one held and the other either active or alerting) can connect the
other parties and release the served subscriber's own connection.
Calls can be put on hold, recovered, released, added to conversation, and transferred similarly as defined in 3GPP TS
22.030 [19]. Refer subclause 9.2 for possible <err> values.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 60 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
This is based on the GSM/UMTS supplementary services HOLD (Call Hold; refer 3GPP TS 22.083 [5] clause 2),
MPTY (MultiParty; refer 3GPP TS 22.084 [22]) and ECT (Explicit Call Transfer; refer 3GPP TS 22.091 [29]). The
interaction of this command with other commands based on other GSM/UMTS supplementary services is described in
the GSM/UMTS standards.
NOTE: Call Hold, MultiParty and Explicit Call Transfer are only applicable to teleservice 11.
It is recommended (although optional) that test command returns a list of operations which are supported. The call
number required by some operations shall be denoted by "x" (e.g. +CHLD: (0,1,1x,2,2x,3)).
Defined values
<n>: integer type; equals to numbers entered before SEND button in 3GPP TS 22.030 [19] subclause 6.5.5.1
NOTE: The "directory number" case shall be handled with dial command D, and the END case with hangup
command H (or +CHUP). The 4*"directory number" case is handled with +CTFR command.
Implementation
Optional.
7.14 Call deflection +CTFR
Table 47: +CTFR action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CTFR=<number>[,<type>[,<subaddr>[,<satype>]]] +CME ERROR: <err>
+CTFR=?

Description
This refers to a service that causes an incoming alerting call to be forwarded to a specified number. Action command
does this. Refer subclause 9.2 for possible <err> values.
This is based on the GSM/UMTS supplementary service CD (Call Deflection; refer 3GPP TS 22.072 [30]). The
interaction of this command with other commands based on other GSM/UMTS supplementary services is described in
the GSM/UMTS standards.
NOTE: Call Deflection is only applicable to teleservice 11.
Defined values
<number>: string type phone number of format specified by <type>
<type>: type of address octet in integer format (refer TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.4.7); default 145 when dialling
string includes international access code character "+", otherwise 129
<subaddr>: string type subaddress of format specified by <satype>
<satype>: type of subaddress octet in integer format (refer TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.4.8); default 128
Implementation
Optional.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 61 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
7.15 Unstructured supplementary service data +CUSD
Table 48: +CUSD parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CUSD=[<n>[,<str>[,<dcs>]]] +CME ERROR: <err>
+CUSD? +CUSD: <n>
+CUSD=?
+CUSD: (list of supported <n>s)

Description
This command allows control of the Unstuctured Supplementary Service Data (USSD) according to 3GPP TS
22.090 [23]. Both network and mobile initiated operations are supported. Parameter <n> is used to disable/enable the
presentation of an unsolicited result code (USSD response from the network, or network initiated operation) +CUSD:
<m>[,<str>,<dcs>] to the TE. In addition, value <n>=2 is used to cancel an ongoing USSD session.
When <str> is given, a mobile initiated USSD-string or a response USSD-string to a network initiated operation is
sent to the network. The response USSD-string from the network is returned in a subsequent unsolicited +CUSD result
code.
NOTE: In case of successful mobile initiated operation, TA implemented according to a version prior to 6 of this
standard, waits the USSD response from the network and sends it to the TE before the final result code.
This will block the AT command interface for the period of the operation. Such TA does not support <n>
value 2.
The interaction of this command with other commands based on other GSM/UMTS supplementary services is described
in the GSM/UMTS standards.
Test command returns values supported as a compound value.
Defined values
<n>:
0 disable the result code presentation to the TE
1 enable the result code presentation to the TE
2 cancel session (not applicable to read command response)
<str>: string type USSD-string (when <str> parameter is not given, network is not interrogated):
- if <dcs> indicates that 3GPP TS 23.038 [25] 7 bit default alphabet is used:
- if TE character set other than "HEX" (refer command Select TE Character Set +CSCS): MT/TA
converts GSM alphabet into current TE character set according to rules of 3GPP TS 27.005 [24]
Annex A
- if TE character set is "HEX": MT/TA converts each 7-bit character of GSM alphabet into two IRA
character long hexadecimal number (e.g. character (GSM 23) is presented as 17 (IRA 49 and 55))
- if <dcs> indicates that 8-bit data coding scheme is used: MT/TA converts each 8-bit octet into two IRA
character long hexadecimal number (e.g. octet with integer value 42 is presented to TE as two characters
2A (IRA 50 and 65))
<dcs>: 3GPP TS 23.038 [25] Cell Broadcast Data Coding Scheme in integer format (default 0)

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 62 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
<m>:
0 no further user action required (network initiated USSD-Notify, or no further information needed after mobile
initiated operation)
1 further user action required (network initiated USSD-Request, or further information needed after mobile
initiated operation)
2 USSD terminated by network
3 other local client has responded
4 operation not supported
5 network time out
Implementation
Optional.
7.16 Advice of Charge +CAOC
Table 49: +CAOC parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CAOC[=<mode>] [+CAOC: <ccm>]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CAOC? +CAOC: <mode>
+CAOC=? [+CAOC: (list of supported <mode>s]

Description
This refers to Advice of Charge supplementary service (3GPP TS 22.024 [26] and 3GPP TS 22.086 [27]) that enables
subscriber to get information about the cost of calls. With <mode>=0, the execute command returns the current call
meter value from the MT.
The command also includes the possibility to enable an unsolicited event reporting of the CCM information. The
unsolicited result code +CCCM: <ccm> is sent when the CCM value changes, but not more that every 10 seconds.
Deactivation of the unsolicited event reporting is made with the same command.
Refer subclause 9.2 for possible <err> values.
NOTE: Advice of Charge values stored in the SIM card or in the active application in the UICC (GSM or USIM)
(ACM, ACMmax, PUCT) can be accessed with generic or restricted SIM access command (+CSIM or
+CRSM)).Those values can be more readily accessed with commands +CACM, +CAMM and +CPUC.
The Read command indicates whether the unsolicited reporting is activated or not. Read command is available when the
unsolicited result code is supported.
It is recommended (although optional) that the test command returns the supported mode values.
Defined values
<mode>:
0 query CCM value
1 deactivate the unsolicited reporting of CCM value
2 activate the unsolicited reporting of CCM value

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 63 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
<ccm>: string type; three bytes of the current call meter value in hexadecimal format (e.g. "00001E" indicates
decimal value 30); value is in home units and bytes are similarly coded as ACMmax value in the SIM card or in
the active application in the UICC (GSM or USIM)
Implementation
Optional.
7.17 Supplementary service notifications +CSSN
Table 50: +CSSN parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CSSN=[<n>[,<m>]]
+CSSN? +CSSN: <n>,<m>
+CSSN=?
+CSSN: (list of supported <n>s),(list of supported <m>s)

Description
This command refers to supplementary service related network initiated notifications. The set command
enables/disables the presentation of notification result codes from TA to TE.
When <n>=1 and a supplementary service notification is received after a mobile originated call setup, intermediate
result code +CSSI: <code1>[,<index>] is sent to TE before any other MO call setup result codes presented in
the present document or in V.250 [14]. When several different <code1>s are received from the network, each of them
shall have its own +CSSI result code.
When <m>=1 and a supplementary service notification is received during a mobile terminated call setup or during a
call, or when a forward check supplementary service notification is received, unsolicited result code +CSSU:
<code2>[,<index>[,<number>,<type>[,<subaddr>,<satype>]]] is sent to TE. In case of MT call
setup, result code is sent after every +CLIP result code (refer command "Calling line identification presentation
+CLIP") and when several different <code2>s are received from the network, each of them shall have its own +CSSU
result code.
Test command returns values supported as a compound value.
Defined values
<n> (parameter sets/shows the +CSSI result code presentation status to the TE):
0 disable
1 enable
<m> (parameter sets/shows the +CSSU result code presentation status to the TE):
0 disable
1 enable
<code1> (it is manufacturer specific, which of these codes are supported):
0 unconditional call forwarding is active
1 some of the conditional call forwardings are active
2 call has been forwarded
3 call is waiting
4 this is a CUG call (also <index> present)
5 outgoing calls are barred

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 64 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
6 incoming calls are barred
7 CLIR suppression rejected
8 call has been deflected
<index>: refer "Closed user group +CCUG"
<code2> (it is manufacturer specific, which of these codes are supported):
0 this is a forwarded call (MT call setup)
1 this is a CUG call (also <index> present) (MT call setup)
2 call has been put on hold (during a voice call)
3 call has been retrieved (during a voice call)
4 multiparty call entered (during a voice call)
5 call on hold has been released (this is not a SS notification) (during a voice call)
6 forward check SS message received (can be received whenever)
7 call is being connected (alerting) with the remote party in alerting state in explicit call transfer operation (during
a voice call)
8 call has been connected with the other remote party in explicit call transfer operation (also number and
subaddress parameters may be present) (during a voice call or MT call setup)
9 this is a deflected call (MT call setup)
10 sdditional incoming call forwarded
<number>: string type phone number of format specified by <type>
<type>: type of address octet in integer format (refer TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.4.7)
<subaddr>: string type subaddress of format specified by <satype>
<satype>: type of subaddress octet in integer format (refer TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.4.8)
Implementation
Optional.
7.18 List current calls +CLCC
Table 51:+CLCC action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CLCC [+CLCC: <id1>,<dir>,<stat>,<mode>,<mpty>[,
<number>,<type>[,<alpha>[,<priority>]]]
[<CR><LF>+CLCC: <id2>,<dir>,<stat>,<mode>,<mpty>[,
<number>,<type>[,<alpha>[,<priority>]]]
[...]]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CLCC=?

Description
Returns list of current calls of MT. If command succeeds but no calls are available, no information response is sent to
TE. Refer subclause 9.2 for possible <err> values.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 65 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Defined values
<idx>: integer type; call identification number as described in 3GPP TS 22.030 [19] subclause 4.5.5.1; this number
can be used in +CHLD command operations
<dir>:
0 mobile originated (MO) call
1 mobile terminated (MT) call
<stat> (state of the call):
0 active
1 held
2 dialing (MO call)
3 alerting (MO call)
4 incoming (MT call)
5 waiting (MT call)
<mode> (bearer/teleservice):
0 voice
1 data
2 fax
3 voice followed by data, voice mode
4 alternating voice/data, voice mode
5 alternating voice/fax, voice mode
6 voice followed by data, data mode
7 alternating voice/data, data mode
8 alternating voice/fax, fax mode
9 unknown
<mpty>:
0 call is not one of multiparty (conference) call parties
1 call is one of multiparty (conference) call parties
<number>: string type phone number in format specified by <type>
<type>: type of address octet in integer format (refer TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.4.7)
<alpha>: string type alphanumeric representation of <number> corresponding to the entry found in phonebook;
used character set should be the one selected with command Select TE Character Set +CSCS
<priority>: optional digit type parameter indicating the eMLPP priority level of the call, values specified in
3GPP TS 22.067 [54]
Implementation
Optional. Recommended when +CHLD command is implemented.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 66 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
7.19 Preferred PLMN list +CPOL
Table 52:+CPOL parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CPOL=[<index>][,
<format>[,<oper>[,<GS
M_AcT>,<GSM_Compact_A
cT>,<UTRAN_AcT>]]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CPOL? +CPOL:
<index1>,<format>,<oper1>[,<GSM_AcT1>,<GSM_Com
pact_AcT1>,<UTRAN_AcT1>]
[<CR><LF>+CPOL:
<index2>,<format>,<oper2>[,<GSM_AcT2>,<GSM_Com
pact_AcT2>,<UTRAN_AcT2>]
[...]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CPOL=? +CPOL: (list of supported <index>s),(list of supported
<format>s)
+CME ERROR: <err>

Description
This command is used to edit the PLMN selector with Access Technology lists in the SIM card or active application in
the UICC(GSM or USIM).
Execute command writes an entry in the SIM/USIM list of preferred PLMNs, previously selected by the command
+CPLS. If no list has been previously selected, the User controlled PLMN selector with Access Technology,
EF
PLMNwAcT,
is the one accessed by default. If <index> is given but <oper> is left out, entry is deleted. If <oper> is
given but <index> is left out, <oper> is put in the next free location. If only <format> is given, the format of the
<oper> in the read command is changed. The Access Technology selection parameters, <GSM_AcT>,
<GSM_Compact_AcT> and <UTRAN_AcT>, are required when writing User controlled PLMN selector with Access
Technology, EF EF
PLMNwAcT
, Operator controlled PLMN selector with Access Technology EF
OPLMNwAcT
and HPLMN
selector with Access Technology EF
HPLMNwAcT
, see TS 31.102. Refer subclause 9.2 for possible <err> values.
NOTE1: MT may also update the User controlled PLMN selector with Access Technology, EF
PLMNwAcT
,
automatically when new networks are selected.
NOTE2: The Operator controlled PLMN selector with Access Technology EF
OPLMNwAcT
, can only be written if the
write access condition in the SIM/USIM has been previously verified.
Read command returns all used entries from the SIM/USIM list of preferred PLMNs, previously selected by the
command +CPLS, with the Access Technologies for each PLMN in the list.
Test command returns the whole index range supported by the SIM.
Defined values
<indexn>: integer type; the order number of operator in the SIM/USIM preferred operator list
<format>:
0 long format alphanumeric <oper>
1 short format alphanumeric <oper>
2 numeric <oper>
<opern>: string type; <format> indicates if the format is alphanumeric or numeric (see +COPS)
<GSM_AcTn>: GSM access technology:

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 67 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
0 access technology not selected
1 access technology selected
<GSM_Compact_AcTn>: GSM compact access technology:
0 access technology not selected
1 access technology selected
<UTRA_AcTn>: UTRA access technology:
0 access technology not selected
1 access technology selected
Implementation
Optional.
7.20 Selection of preferred PLMN list +CPLS
Table 53:+CPLS parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CPLS=<list> +CME ERROR: <err>
+CPLS? +CPLS: <list>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CPLS=?
+CPLS: (list of supported <list>s)
+CME ERROR: <err>

Description
This command is used to select one PLMN selector with Access Technology list in the SIM card or active application
in the UICC(GSM or USIM), that is used by +CPOL command.
Execute command selects a list in the SIM/USIM. Refer subclause 9.2 for possible <err> values.
Read command returns the selected PLMN selector list from the SIM/USIM
Test command returns the whole index range supported lists by the SIM./USIM
Defined values
<list>:
0 User controlled PLMN selector with Access Technology EF
PLMNwAcT
, if not found in the SIM/UICC then PLMN
preferred list EF
PLMNsel
(this file is only available in SIM card or GSM application selected in UICC)
1 Operator controlled PLMN selector with Access Technology EF
OPLMNwAcT

2 HPLMN selector with Access Technology EF
HPLMNwAcT

Implementation
Optional.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 68 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
7.21 Read operator names +COPN
Table 54:+COPN action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+COPN +COPN: <numeric1>,<alpha1>
[<CR><LF>+COPN: <numeric2>,<alpha2>
[...]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+COPN=?

Description
Execute command returns the list of operator names from the MT. Each operator code <numericn> that has an
alphanumeric equivalent <alphan> in the MT memory shall be returned. Refer subclause 9.2 for possible <err>
values.
Defined values
<numericn>: string type; operator in numeric format (see +COPS)
<alphan>: string type; operator in long alphanumeric format (see +COPS)
Implementation
Optional.
7.22 eMLPP Priority Registration and Interrogation +CAEMLPP
Table 55: CAEMLPP parameter command syntax
Command Possible Response(s)
+CAEMLPP=<priority> +CME ERROR: <err>
+CAEMLPP? +CAEMLPP:
<default_priority>,<max_priority>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CAEMLPP=?

Description
The execute command is used to change the default priority level of the user in the network. The requested priority level
is checked against the eMLPP subscription of the user stored on the SIM card or in the active application in the UICC
(GSM or USIM) EF
eMLPP
. If the user doesn't have subscription for the requested priority level an ERROR or +CMEE
ERROR result code is returned.
The read command triggers an interrogation of the provision of the maximum priority level which the service subscriber
is allowed to use and default priority level activated by the user.
If the service is not provisioned, a result code including the SS-Status (?) parameter is returned.
Defined Values
<priority>: integer type parameter which identifies the default priority level to be activated in the network,
values specified in 3GPP TS 22.067 [54]
<default_priority>: integer type parameter which identifies the default priority level which is activated in
the network, values specified in 3GPP TS 22.067 [54]

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 69 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
<max_priority>: integer type parameter which identifies the maximum priority level for which the service
subscriber has a subscription in the network, values specified in 3GPP TS 22.067 [54]
Implementation
Mandatory for a MT supporting AT commands only and supplemantery service eMLPP is implemented.
7.23 eMLPP subscriptions +CPPS
Table 56: +CPPS action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CPPS +CPPS: <priority>[,<priority>
[...]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CPPS=?
Description
This command returns all eMLPP priority subscriptions of the user stored on the SIM card or in the active application in
the UICC (GSM or USIM) EF
eMLPP
. If no explicit priority level subscription is stored on the SIM card or in the active
application in the UICC (GSM or USIM) EF
eMLPP
the result code OK is returned.
Defined values
<priority>: integer type, eMLPP subscription to priority level {0,1,..,4} as defined in 3GPP TS 22.067 [45].
Implementation
Mandatory for a MT supporting AT commands only and eMLPP is implemented.

7.24 Fast call setup conditions +CFCS
Table 57: +CFCS action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CFCS=<priority>,<status> +CME ERROR: <err>
+CFCS? +CFCS: <priority>[,<priority>
[...]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CFCS=? +CFCS: (list of supported
<priority>,<status>)
Description
The set command is used to edit the status of the priority level for fast call set-up stored on the SIM card or in the active
application in the UICC (GSM or USIM) EF
eMLPP
. If the user has no subscription to the priority level status he wants to
edit, an ERROR or +CME ERROR result code is returned.
The read command returns all enabled priority levels for fast call set-up stored on the SIM card or in the active
application in the UICC (GSM or USIM) EF
eMLPP.
If no priority level is enabled for fast call set-up, the result code OK
is returned.

Defined values
<priority>: integer type, eMLPP fast call set-up priority level {0,1,..,4} as defined in 3GPP TS 22.067 [45]
<status>: integer type

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 70 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
0 disable <priority> for fast call set-up
1 enable <priority> for fast call set-up
Implementation
Mandatory for a MT supporting AT commands only and eMLPP is implemented.

7.25 Automatic answer for eMLPP Service +CAAP
Table 58: +CAAP action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CAAP=<priority>,<status> +CME ERROR: <err>
+CAAP? +CAAP: <priority>[,<priority>
[...]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CAAP=? +CAAP: (list of supported
<priority>,<status>)
Description
The set command is used to edit the status of the priority level for automatic answering for eMLPP stored on the SIM
card or in the active application in the UICC (GSM or USIM) EF
AAeM
. If the user has no subscription to the priority
level status he wants to edit, an ERROR or +CME ERROR result code is returned.
The read command returns all enabled priority levels for automatic answering for eMLPP stored on the SIM card or in
the active application in the UICC (GSM or USIM) EF
AAeM.
If no priority level is enabled for automatic answering for
eMLPP, the result code OK is returned.
Defined values
<priority>: eMLPP automatic answer priority level value {A,B,0,1,..,4} as defined in 3GPP TS 22.067 [45]
<status>: integer type
0 disable eMLPP <priority> for automatic answering
1 enable eMLPP <priority> for automatic answering
Implementation
Mandatory for a MT supporting AT commands only and eMLPP is implemented.

7.26 User to User Signalling Service 1 +CUUS1
Table 59: +CUUS1 action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+ CUUS1 =[<n>[,<m>[,<message>[,<UUIE>
[,<message>[,<UUIE>[,...]]]]]]]
+CME ERROR: <err>

+ CUUS1? + CUUS1: <n>,<m>[,<message>,<UUIE>
[,<message>,<UUIE>[,...]]]
+ CUUS1=? + CUUS1: (list of supported <n>s), (list of
supported <m>s), (list of supported <message>s),
(list of supported <messageI>s),(list of supported
<messageU>s)


ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 71 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Description
This command allows control of the User-to-User Signalling Supplementary Service 1 (UUS1) according to 3G 22.087
[58].
Parameters <message> and <UUIE> are used to activate/deactivate the implicit request of the User-to-User
Signalling Supplementary Service 1.
When <message> and <UUIE> are both present the string specified in <UUIE> is included as the value part of the
User-to-User Information Element (as defined in 3G 24.008) into all subsequent messages of type <message>. If
parameter <message> is present but parameter <UUIE> is not present then the User-to-User Information Element
shall not be present in subsequent messages of type <message>.
Parameters <n> and <m> are used to enable/disable the presentation of incoming User-to-User Information Elements.
When <n> = 1 and a User-to-User Information is received after a mobile originated call setup or after hanging up a call,
intermediate result code +CUUS1I: <messageI>,<UUIE> is sent to the TE.
When <m> = 1 and a User-to-User Information is received during a mobile terminated call setup or during a remote
party call hangup, unsolicited result code +CUUS1U: <messageU>,<UUIE> is sent to the TE.
Test command returns values supported as a compound value.
The interaction of this command with other commands based on other supplementary services is described in the 3G
standard.
Defined values
<n> (parameter sets/shows the +CUUS1I result code presentation status in the TA)
0 disable.
1 enable.
<m> (parameter sets/shows the +CUUS1U result code presentation status in the TA)
0 disable.
1 enable.
<message> (type of message containing the outgoing User-to-User Information Element)
0 ANY
1 SETUP
2 ALERT
3 CONNECT
4 DISCONNECT
5 RELEASE
6 RELEASE_COMPLETE
<messageI> (type of message containing the intermediate User-to-User Information Element)
0 ANY
1 ALERT
2 PROGRESS
3 CONNECT (sent after +COLP if enabled)
4 RELEASE

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 72 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
<messageU> (type of message containing the unsollicited User-to-User Information Element)
0 ANY
1 SETUP (returned after +CLIP if presented, otherwise after every RING or +CRING)
2 DISCONNECT
3 RELEASE_COMPLETE

< UUIE>: the User-user Information Element (as defined in 3G 24.008) in hexadecimal character format (for
hexadecimal format, refer +CSCS).
NOTE: If the TA does not distinguish the type of message containing the User-to-user Information Element, it
can use the value for ANY message.
Implementation
Optional.
7.27 Preferred network indication +CPNET
Table 59A: +CPNET parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CPNET=<Pref_net>
+CPNET? +CPNET: <Pref_net>
+CPNET=?
+CPNET: (list of supported <Pref_net>s)

Description
This command indicates whether the terminal has preference <Pref_net> for GERAN/UTRAN or GAN, see
3GPP TS 44.318 [70].
Read command returns the current preference for GERAN/UTRAN or GAN.
Test command returns the parameter indicating preference <Pref_net> for GERAN/UTRAN or GAN.
Defined values
<Pref_net>: Indicates the preference for GERAN/UTRAN or GAN.
0 GERAN/UTRAN shall be used. The terminal uses GERAN/UTRAN coverage only.
1 GAN shall be used. The terminal used GAN coverage only.
2 GERAN/UTRAN preferred. The terminal prefers to stay in GERAN/UTRAN rather than GAN.
3 GAN preferred. The terminal prefers to stay in GAN rather than GERAN/UTRAN.
NOTE: Usage of value 0 or 1 will prevent the terminal from changing between GERAN/UTRAN and GAN. E.g.
setting <Pref_net> to 1 indicates that only GAN will be used, and prevents the terminal from using
available GERAN/UTRAN coverage.
Implementation
Optional.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 73 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
7.28 Preferred network status +CPNSTAT
Table 59B: +CPNSTAT parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CPNSTAT=[<n>]
+CPNSTAT? +CPNSTAT: <n>,<stat>
+CPNSTAT=?
+CPNSTAT: (list of supported <n>s)

Description
Set command controls the presentation of an unsolicited result code +CPNSTAT: <stat> when <n>=1 and there is a
change in the preferred network indication status.
Read command returns the status of result code presentation <n> and an integer <stat> which shows whether the
terminal is in GERAN/UTRAN or GAN, see 3GPP TS 44.318 [70].
NOTE: Further details about registration status are available using commands +CREG (see subclause 7.2 or) and
+CGREG (see subclause 10.1.19).
Test command returns the list of supported unsolicited result codes.
Defined values
<n>:
0 disable preferred network indication unsolicited result code.
1 enable preferred network indication unsolicited result code +CPNSTAT: <stat>.
<stat>: Preferred network indication status.
0 Requested network not available.
1 GERAN/UTRAN used.
2 GAN used.
Implementation
Optional.
7.29 Current Packet Switched Bearer +CPSB
Table 59C: +CPSB parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CPSB=[<n>] +CME ERROR: <err>
+CPSB? +CPSB: <n> [,<cid>, <curr_bearer>]

+CME ERROR: <err>
+CPSB=?
+CPSB: (list of supported <n>s)

Description
Set command controls the presentation of an unsolicited result code
+CPSB: <cid>,<curr_bearer> when <n>=1 and the PDP context corresponding to <cid> is in the PDP-
ACTIVE state and there is a change in the current bearer due to the reception of a control or signalling message from
the network as specified in 3GPP TS 44.060 [71] or 3GPP TS 25.331 [74].

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 74 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Read command returns the current status of unsolicited result code presentation <n>. Also the parameters <cid>,
<curr_bearer> are returned for each defined context only when <n=1> and the PDP context corresponding to <cid> is in
the PDP-ACTIVE state.
Test command returns the list of supported <n>s.
Defined values
<n>:
0 disable the presentation of the unsolicited result code
1 enable the presentation of the unsolicited result code
+CPSB: <cid>,<curr_bearer>
<cid>: A numeric parameter which specifies a particular PDP context definition. The <cid> parameter is local to the
TE-MT interface and identifies only those PDP contexts which have been setup via AT command.
<curr_bearer>: The current packet switched bearer which is established between the UE and network
0 There is currently no packet switched bearer between the UE and the network (e.g. RAB is released in UMTS or
the TBF is released in GSM). This would mean that there is no bearer associated to the PDP context referred to
by the <cid> parameter and hence no data transfer is currently occuring on that particular PDP context. This
result code covers the case where the PDP context is active but there is no bearer associated with it.
1 GPRS. (See 3GPP TS 44.060 [71] for definition of GPRS TBF Mode)
2 EGPRS. (See 3GPP TS 44.060 [71] for definition of EGPRS TBF Mode)
3 Non-HSUPA in uplink and non-HSDPA in downlink. (See NOTE 1 to NOTE 3)
4 HSUPA in uplink and non-HSDPA in downlink. (See NOTE 1 to NOTE 4)
5 Non-HSUPA in uplink and HSDPA in downlink. (See NOTE1 to NOTE 4)
6 HSUPA in uplink and HSDPA in downlink. (See NOTE 1 to NOTE 4)

NOTE 1: The term 'non-HSDPA' means a non-HSDPA UMTS bearer. 3GPP TS 25.331 [74] specifies the criterion
to be satisfied in order for a downlink UMTS RAB to be termed as HSDPA. If those criterion are not met,
then the downlink UMTS RAB would be termed as 'non-HSDPA' by this AT command.
NOTE 2: The term 'non-HSUPA' means a non-HSUPA UMTS bearer. 3GPP TS 25.331 [74] specifies the criterion
to be satisfied in order for an uplink UMTS RAB to be termed as HSUPA (or Enhanced uplink DCH). If
those criterion are not met, then the uplink UMTS RAB would be termed as 'non-HSUPA' by this AT
command.
NOTE 3: The terms "non-HSDPA", "non-HSUPA" indicates R99 to pre- HSDPA or pre-HSUPA UMTS bearers.
They do not imply GPRS or EGPRS bearers.
NOTE 4: See 3GPP TS 25.308 [72] for HSDPA and 3GPP TS 25.319 [73] for HSUPA.
Implementation
Optional.
7.30 Informative examples
This subclause includes all the GSM/UMTS supplementary service related commands, additional commands to lock
MT and SIM/UICC capabilities, and commands to check the network registration status.
An example where MSISDNs of a MT are queried, calls are forwarded to different numbers when mobile is busy (CFB)
or when it does not answer (CFNRy). The status of CFNRy is read:
AT+CNUM

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 75 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
+CNUM: ,"+358501234567",145,,4 (voice number)
OK
AT+CCFC=1,1,"931123456" (enable CFB)
OK
AT+CCFC=2,1,"921654321" (enable CFNRy)
OK
AT+CCFC=1,2 (query CFNRy)
+CCFC: 1,7,"+35821654321",145,,,20 (forward after 20 seconds)
OK

An example of Call Waiting (+CCWA), Call Related Supplementary Services (+CHLD), and Connected Line
Identification Presentation (+COLP) usage:
AT+CCWA=1,1;+COLP=1 (enable call waiting and COLP result codes)
OK
ATD9311234567; (originate a voice call)
+COLP: "+358311234567",145
OK
...conversation...
+CCWA: "+358317654321",145 (another call is waiting)
AT+CHLD=2 (put first call on hold and answer the second one)
OK
...conversation...
AT+CHLD=1 (release the second (active) call and recover the first (held) call)
OK
ATH (release the first call)
OK

Call barring supplementary services are combined in one command, Facility Lock (+CLCK), which is also used to
restrict MT and SIM/UICC functionality Some of the facilities require a password when enabled or disabled. An
additional command, Change Password (+CPWD), is defined for changing the password of different barring and
restriction facilities. An example where locking status of outgoing international calls is interrogated and then barred,
and the password of the SIM/UICC card lock (Personal Identity Number, PIN) is changed:
AT+CLCK="OI",2
+CLCK: 0,7
OK
AT+CLCK="OI",1,"1234"
OK
AT+CPWD="SC","4321","1234"
OK

Operator Selection (+COPS) command is used for querying the status of all GSM/UMTS operators detected in the area,
and switching between operators.
Following example illustrates a network selection sequence in Finland. Two operators are found, the status of Tele is
unknown and Radiolinja is currently selected. Read command shows that automatic selection mode is on and that
Radiolinja is selected. Then an attempt is made to access Tele, but it is denied (shown by +CME ERROR).
AT+COPS=?
+COPS: (2,"RADIOLINJA","RL","24405"),(0,"TELE","TELE","24491")
OK
AT+COPS?
+COPS: 0,0,"RADIOLINJA"
OK
AT+COPS=1,0,"TELE"
+CME ERROR: 3

When a terminal wanders between countries (i.e. networks), an application may follow this e.g. with the following
scenario:
AT+CREG=1 (enable +CREG: <stat> unsolicited result code)
OK
AT+CREG?
+CREG: 1,1 (MT is registered in home PLMN)
OK
AT+COPS=3,2;+COPS?;+COPS=3,0;+COPS?
+COPS: 0,2,"24405" (get the country...
+COPS: 0,0,"RADIOLINJA" ...and operator name)
OK
...user wanders to another PLMN...
+CREG: 2 (deregistered, roaming ongoing)

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 76 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
+CREG: 5 (registered again, not home PLMN)
AT+COPS=3,2;+COPS?;+COPS=3,0;+COPS?
+COPS: 0,2,"24001" (get the country...
+COPS: 0,0,"TELIA MOBITEL" ...and operator name)
OK
...user loses connection, no other PLMNs around...
+CREG: 0

An example of eMLPP Supplementary Service usage for a ptp voice call:
ATD*752#+436644101453; (originate a voice call with the priority level 2, see for priority level definitions GSM 02.30)
OK (call setup was successful)
8 Mobile Termination control and status commands
This clause includes commands for MT power, keypad, display and indicator handling. Also commands for selecting,
reading and writing of phonebooks, and setting real-time clock facilities are specified. Two commands are specified for
accessing SIM/UICC database records in a general way.
Figure 7 illustrates the effect of these commands. Command Phone Activity Status +CPAS indicates the current general
activity status of the MT. Command Set Phone Functionality +CFUN is used to set the MT to different power
consumption states. Command Enter PIN +CPIN is used to enter MT passwords which are needed before any other
functionality of the MT can be used (e.g. SIM PIN, PUK). Commands Generic SIM Access +CSIM and Restricted SIM
Access +CRSM can be used to access all data in SIM/UICC. Commands Battery Charge +CBC and Signal Quality +CSQ
are same as in TIA IS-135 [16] and they are used to query the battery charge of the MT and the current RSSI of the MT.
Command Mobile Termination Control Mode +CMEC is used to select the controlling unit of MT keypad, display and
indicators. Controlling commands for the TE are Keypad Emulation +CKPD, Display Control +CDIS and Indicator
Control +CIND. If corresponding event reporting is enabled with command Mobile Termination Event Reporting
+CMER, +CKEV is the result code of a keypad event, +CDEV is the result code of a display event, and +CIEV is the
result code of an indicator event. Phonebook commands are Select Phonebook Memory Storage +CPBS, Read
Phonebook Entries +CPBR, Find Phonebook Entries +CPBF and Write Phonebook Entry +CPBW. Additional command
Clock +CCLK can be used to control the real-time clock of the MT if available. Command Alarm +CALA sets possible
alarm clock facilities of the MT.


ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 77 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
KEYPAD
MT TA
+CKPD
+CMER
+CKEV
+CIEV
+CDIS
+CIND
DISPLAY
INDICATORS
+CDEV
+CMEC
PHONE-
BOOKS
+CPBS
+CPBW
+CPBR, +CPBF
TE
+CFUN
+CPAS
+CCLK, +CALA
+CBC
+CSQ
+CPIN, +CSIM, +CRSM
SIM IF,
PASSWORD
FACILITIES

Figure 7: Mobile termination control and status commands
8.1 Phone activity status +CPAS
Table 60: +CPAS action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CPAS +CPAS: <pas>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CPAS=?
+CPAS: (list of supported <pas>s)
+CME ERROR: <err>

Description
Execution command returns the activity status <pas> of the MT. It can be used to interrogate the MT before requesting
action from the phone. Refer subclause 9.2 for possible <err> values.
Test command returns values supported by the MT as a compound value.
Defined values
<pas>:
0 ready (MT allows commands from TA/TE)
1 unavailable (MT does not allow commands from TA/TE)

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 78 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
2 unknown (MT is not guaranteed to respond to instructions)
3 ringing (MT is ready for commands from TA/TE, but the ringer is active)
4 call in progress (MT is ready for commands from TA/TE, but a call is in progress)
5 asleep (MT is unable to process commands from TA/TE because it is in a low functionality state)
also all other values below 128 are reserved by the present document.
Implementation
Mandatory when MT can be operated from TE (refer subclause "Mobile Termination control mode +CMEC").
8.2 Set phone functionality +CFUN
Table 61: +CFUN parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CFUN=[<fun>[,<rst>]] +CME ERROR: <err>
+CFUN? +CFUN: <fun>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CFUN=?
+CFUN: (list of supported <fun>s), (list of supported <rst>s)
+CME ERROR: <err>

Description
Set command selects the level of functionality <fun> in the MT. Level "full functionality" is where the highest level of
power is drawn. "Minimum functionality" is where minimum power is drawn. Level of functionality between these may
also be specified by manufacturers. When supported by manufacturers, MT resetting with <rst> parameter may be
utilized. Refer subclause 9.2 for possible <err> values.
NOTE: It is manufacturer specific does this command affect network registration. Command Operator Selection
+COPS is used to force registration/deregistration.
Test command returns values supported by the MT as a compound value.
Defined values
<fun>:
0 minimum functionality
1 full functionality
2 disable phone transmit RF circuits only
3 disable phone receive RF circuits only
4 disable phone both transmit and receive RF circuits
5...127 reserved for manufacturers as intermediate states between full and minimum functionality
<rst>:
0 do not reset the MT before setting it to <fun> power level
NOTE: This shall be always default when <rst> is not given.
1 reset the MT before setting it to <fun> power level

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 79 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Implementation
Optional.
8.3 Enter PIN +CPIN
Table 62: +CPIN parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CPIN=<pin>[,<newpin>] +CME ERROR: <err>
+CPIN? +CPIN: <code>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CPIN=?

Description
Set command sends to the MT a password which is necessary before it can be operated (SIM PIN, SIM PUK, PH-SIM
PIN, etc.). If the PIN is to be entered twice, the TA shall automatically repeat the PIN. If no PIN request is pending, no
action is taken towards MT and an error message, +CME ERROR, is returned to TE. Refer subclause 9.2 for possible
<err> values.
NOTE: SIM PIN, SIM PUK, PH-SIM PIN, PH-FSIM PIN, PH-FSIM PUK, SIM PIN2 and SIM
PUK2 refer to the PIN of the selected application on the UICC. For example, in an UTRAN context, the
selected application on a UICC should be a USIM and the SIM PIN then represents the PIN of the
selected USIM. See TS 31.101 [65] for further details on application selection on the UICC.
If the PIN required is SIM PUK or SIM PUK2, the second pin is required. This second pin, <newpin>, is used to
replace the old pin in the SIM.
NOTE: Commands which interact with MT that are accepted when MT is pending SIM PIN, SIM PUK, or
PH-SIM are: +CGMI, +CGMM, +CGMR, +CGSN, D112; (emergency call), +CPAS, +CFUN, +CPIN,
+CDIS (read and test command only), and +CIND (read and test command only).
Read command returns an alphanumeric string indicating whether some password is required or not.
Defined values
<pin>, <newpin>: string type values
<code> values reserved by the present document:
READY MT is not pending for any password
SIM PIN MT is waiting SIM PIN to be given
SIM PUK MT is waiting SIM PUK to be given
PH-SIM PIN MT is waiting phone-to-SIM card password to be given
PH-FSIM PIN MT is waiting phone-to-very first SIM card password to be given
PH-FSIM PUK MT is waiting phone-to-very first SIM card unblocking password to be given
SIM PIN2 MT is waiting SIM PIN2 to be given (this <code> is recommended to be returned only when the
last executed command resulted in PIN2 authentication failure (i.e. +CME ERROR: 17); if PIN2
is not entered right after the failure, it is recommended that MT does not block its operation)
SIM PUK2 MT is waiting SIM PUK2 to be given (this <code> is recommended to be returned only when the
last executed command resulted in PUK2 authentication failure (i.e. +CME ERROR: 18); if
PUK2 and new PIN2 are not entered right after the failure, it is recommended that MT does not
block its operation)

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 80 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
PH-NET PIN MT is waiting network personalization password to be given
PH-NET PUK MT is waiting network personalization unblocking password to be given
PH-NETSUB PIN MT is waiting network subset personalization password to be given
PH-NETSUB PUK MT is waiting network subset personalization unblocking password to be given
PH-SP PIN MT is waiting service provider personalization password to be given
PH-SP PUK MT is waiting service provider personalization unblocking password to be given
PH-CORP PIN MT is waiting corporate personalization password to be given
PH-CORP PUK MT is waiting corporate personalization unblocking password to be given
Implementation
Mandatory for MT not supporting the +CKPD command and supporting AT commands only.
8.4 Battery charge +CBC
Table 63: +CBC action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CBC +CBC: <bcs>,<bcl>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CBC=?
+CBC: (list of supported <bcs>s),(list of supported <bcl>s)

Description
Execution command returns battery connection status <bcs> and battery charge level <bcl> of the MT. Refer
subclause 9.2 for possible <err> values.
Test command returns values supported as compound values.
Defined values
<bcs>:
0 MT is powered by the battery
1 MT has a battery connected, but is not powered by it
2 MT does not have a battery connected
3 Recognized power fault, calls inhibited
<bcl>:
0 battery is exhausted, or MT does not have a battery connected
1...100 battery has 1-100 percent of capacity remaining
Implementation
Optional.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 81 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
8.5 Signal quality +CSQ
Table 64: +CSQ action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CSQ +CSQ: <rssi>,<ber>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CSQ=?
+CSQ: (list of supported <rssi>s),(list of supported <ber>s)

Description
Execution command returns received signal strength indication <rssi> and channel bit error rate <ber> from the
MT. Refer subclause 9.2 for possible <err> values.
Test command returns values supported as compound values.
Defined values
<rssi>:
0 -113 dBm or less
1 -111 dBm
2...30 -109... -53 dBm
31 -51 dBm or greater
99 not known or not detectable
<ber> (in percent):
0...7 as RXQUAL values in the table in TS 45.008 [20] subclause 8.2.4
99 not known or not detectable
Implementation
Optional.
8.6 Mobile Termination control mode +CMEC
Table 65: +CMEC parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CMEC=[<keyp>[,<disp>[,<ind>]]] +CME ERROR: <err>
+CMEC? +CMEC: <keyp>,<disp>,<ind>
+CMEC=? +CMEC: (list of supported <keyp>s),(list of
supported <disp>s),(list of supported <ind>s)

Description
Set command selects the equipment, which operates MT keypad, writes to MT display and sets MT indicators. If
operation mode is not allowed by the MT, +CME ERROR: <err> is returned. Refer subclause 9.2 for <err> values.
Test command returns the modes supported as compound values.
Defined values
<keyp>:

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 82 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
0 MT can be operated only through its keypad (execute command of +CKPD cannot be used)
1 MT can be operated only from TE (with command +CKPD)
2 MT can be operated from both MT keypad and TE
<disp>:
0 only MT can write to its display (command +CDIS can only be used to read the display)
1 only TE can write to MT display (with command +CDIS)
2 MT display can be written by both MT and TE
<ind>:
0 only MT can set the status of its indicators (command +CIND can only be used to read the indicators)
1 only TE can set the status of MT indicators (with command +CIND)
2 MT indicators can be set by both MT and TE
Implementation
Mandatory when any of keypad, display or indicator commands is implemented.
8.7 Keypad control +CKPD
Table 66: +CKPD action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CKPD=<keys>[,<time>[,<pause>]] +CME ERROR: <err>
+CKPD=?

Description
Execution command emulates MT keypad by giving each keystroke as a character in a string <keys>. <time>*0.1
seconds is the time to stroke each key and <pause>*0.1 seconds is the length of pause between two strokes. If
emulating fails in an MT error, +CME ERROR: <err> is returned. Refer subclause 9.2 for <err> values. This
command should be accepted (OK returned) before actually starting to press the keys. Thus unsolicited result codes of
key pressings and display events can be returned (refer subclause "Mobile Termination event reporting +CMER").
Defined values
<keys>: string of characters representing keys as listed in the following table (based on PCCA STD-101 Annex
table I-3). Colon character (IRA 58) followed by one character can be used to indicate a manufacturer specific
key not listed here. All characters from a semicolon character (IRA 59) to the next single semicolon character are
treated as alpha entries and are not converted to key equivalents. All semicolon characters inside alpha entries
should be duplicated in the TE and stripped to one before entering to the MT. Pause character (IRA 87 or 119)
can be used to pause between key pressings for a time specified by <pause>. All IRA values not listed here are
reserved.
Table 67: Character codes
Char IRA (dec) Comment (+ some known key symbols)
# 35 hash (number sign)
% 37 percent sign (P)
* 42 star (*)
0... 9 48... 57 number keys
: 58 escape character for manufacturer specific keys
; 59 escape character for string entering

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 83 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Char IRA (dec) Comment (+ some known key symbols)
< 60 left arrow
> 62 right arrow
@ 64 alpha key (/ABC)
A/a 65/97 channel A (A)
B/b 66/98 channel B (B)
C/c 67/99 clear display (C/CLR)
D/d 68/100 volume down
E/e 69/101 connection end (END)
F/f 70/102 function (FCN)
L/l 76/108 phone lock (LOCK)
M/m 77/109 menu (MENU)
P/p 80/112 power (PWR)
Q/q 81/113 quiet/mute (MUTE)
R/r 82/114 recall last number (R/RCL/MR)
S/s 83/115 connection start (SEND)
T/t 84/116 store/ memory (STO/M/M+)
U/u 85/117 volume up
V/v 86/118 down arrow
W/w 87/119 pause character
X/x 88/120 auxiliary (AUX)
Y/y 89/121 delete last character (C)
[ 91 soft key 1
] 93 soft key 2
^ 94 up arrow
<time>, <pause>:
0...255 0... 25.5 seconds (default values are manufacturer specific, but should be so long that a normal MT can
handle keystrokes correctly)
Implementation
Mandatory for MT not supporting the +CPIN command and supporting AT commands only.
8.8 Display control +CDIS
Table 68: +CDIS parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CDIS=[<text>[,<text>[,...]]] +CME ERROR: <err>
+CDIS? +CDIS: <text>[,<text>[,...]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CDIS=? +CDIS: <length>[,<length>[,...]]
+CME ERROR: <err>

Description
Set command is used to write the contents of MT text type display elements. An element can consist of one character or
several characters. The order of element parameters <text> should follow the rule: first is the element in upper left
corner, second is the next element to the right and so on. The last element is the element in lower right corner. The
number of elements is MT specific. If MT does not allow writing to its display or MT is not currently reachable, +CME
ERROR: <err> is returned. Refer subclause 9.2 for <err> values. If certain element is not writable, setting of it
should be ignored. If element parameter is empty field, element shall remain in the previous value.
NOTE 1: This command cannot be used to write to a display which sum of element lengths exceed the length of the
command line buffer of the TA.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 84 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Read command returns the contents of MT display elements. If <text> field is empty (not empty string), MT does not
allow the reading of corresponding element. If MT is not currently reachable, +CME ERROR: <err> is returned.
Refer subclause 9.2 for <err> values.
Test command returns maximum length of each display element. If MT does not offer the length of elements,
<length> fields should be empty. If MT is not currently reachable, +CME ERROR: <err> is returned. Refer
subclause 9.2 for <err> values.
NOTE 2: MT manufacturer should offer the order and maximum length of elements.
Defined values
<text>: string type parameter using character set specified by command Select TE Character Set +CSCS
<length>: integer type parameter giving the maximum length of corresponding <text> parameter
Implementation
Optional.
8.9 Indicator control +CIND
Table 69: +CIND parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CIND=[<ind>[,<ind>[,...]]] +CME ERROR: <err>
+CIND? +CIND: <ind>[,<ind>[,...]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CIND=? +CIND: (<descr>,(list of supported
<ind>s)) [,(<descr>,(list of supported
<ind>s))[,...]]
+CME ERROR: <err>

Description
Set command is used to set the values of MT indicators. <ind> value 0 means that the indicator is off (or in state
which can be identified as "off"-state), 1 means that indicator is on (or in a state which is more substantial than
"off"-state), 2 is more substantial than 1, and so on. If the indicator is a simple on/off style element, it has values 0 and
1. The number of elements is MT specific. If MT does not allow setting of indicators or MT is not currently reachable,
+CME ERROR: <err> is returned. Refer subclause 9.2 for <err> values. If certain indicator is not writable, setting
of it should be ignored. If parameter is empty field, indicator shall remain in the previous value.
Read command returns the status of MT indicators. If MT is not currently reachable, +CME ERROR: <err> is
returned. Refer subclause 9.2 for <err> values.
Test command returns pairs, where string value <descr> is a maximum 16 character description of the indicator and
compound value is the allowed values for the indicator. If MT is not currently reachable, +CME ERROR: <err> is
returned. Refer subclause 9.2 for <err> values.
NOTE: MT manufacturer should offer the description of supported indicators not listed here and their value
ranges and default values.
Defined values
<ind>: integer type value, which shall be in range of corresponding <descr>
<descr> values reserved by the present document and their <ind> ranges:
"battchg" battery charge level (0-5)
"signal" signal quality (0-5)

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 85 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
"service" service availability (0-1)
"sounder" sounder activity (0-1)
"message" message received (0-1)
"call" call in progress (0-1)
"vox" transmit activated by voice activity (0-1)
"roam" roaming indicator (0-1)
"smsfull" a short message memory storage in the MT has become full and a short message has been rejected (2),
has become full (1), or memory locations are available (0); i.e. the range is (0-2)

Implementation
Optional.
8.10 Mobile Termination event reporting +CMER
Table 70: +CMER parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CMER=[<mode>[,<keyp>[,<disp>
[,<ind>[,<bfr>]]]]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CMER? +CMER: <mode>,<keyp>,<disp>,<ind>,<bfr>
+CMER=? +CMER: (list of supported <mode>s),(list of supported
<keyp>s),(list of supported <disp>s),(list of supported
<ind>s),(list of supported <bfr>s)

Description
Set command enables or disables sending of unsolicited result codes from TA to TE in the case of key pressings,
display changes, and indicator state changes. <mode> controls the processing of unsolicited result codes specified
within this command. <bfr> controls the effect on buffered codes when <mode> 1, 2 or 3 is entered. If setting is not
supported by the MT, +CME ERROR: <err> is returned. Refer subclause 9.2 for <err> values.
Test command returns the modes supported as compound values.
Defined values
<mode>:
0 buffer unsolicited result codes in the TA; if TA result code buffer is full, codes can be buffered in some other
place or the oldest ones can be discarded
1 discard unsolicited result codes when TA-TE link is reserved (e.g. in on-line data mode); otherwise forward
them directly to the TE
2 buffer unsolicited result codes in the TA when TA-TE link is reserved (e.g. in on-line data mode) and flush them
to the TE after reservation; otherwise forward them directly to the TE
3 forward unsolicited result codes directly to the TE; TA-TE link specific inband technique used to embed result
codes and data when TA is in on-line data mode
<keyp>:
0 no keypad event reporting

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 86 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
1 keypad event reporting using result code +CKEV: <key>,<press>. <key> indicates the key (refer IRA
values defined in table in subclause "Keypad control +CKPD") and <press> if the key is pressed or released (1
for pressing and 0 for releasing). Only those key pressings, which are not caused by +CKPD shall be indicated by
the TA to the TE.
NOTE 1: When this mode is enabled, corresponding result codes of all keys currently pressed should be flushed to
the TA regardless of <bfr> setting.
2 keypad event reporting using result code +CKEV: <key>,<press>. All key pressings shall be directed from
TA to TE.
NOTE 2: When this mode is enabled, corresponding result codes of all keys currently pressed should be flushed to
the TA regardless of <bfr> setting.
<disp>:
0 no display event reporting
1 display event reporting using result code +CDEV: <elem>,<text>. <elem> indicates the element order
number (as specified for +CDIS) and <text> is the new value of text element. Only those display events,
which are not caused by +CDIS shall be indicated by the TA to the TE. Character set used in <text> is as
specified by command Select TE Character Set +CSCS
2 display event reporting using result code +CDEV: <elem>,<text>. All display events shall be directed from
TA to TE. Character set used in <text> is as specified by command Select TE Character Set +CSCS
<ind>:
0 no indicator event reporting
1 indicator event reporting using result code +CIEV: <ind>,<value>. <ind> indicates the indicator order
number (as specified for +CIND) and <value> is the new value of indicator. Only those indicator events,
which are not caused by +CIND shall be indicated by the TA to the TE
2 indicator event reporting using result code +CIEV: <ind>,<value>. All indicator events shall be directed
from TA to TE
<bfr>:
0 TA buffer of unsolicited result codes defined within this command is cleared when <mode> 1...3 is entered
1 TA buffer of unsolicited result codes defined within this command is flushed to the TE when <mode> 1...3 is
entered (OK response shall be given before flushing the codes)
Implementation
Mandatory when any of the keypad, display, or indicator result codes is implemented.
8.11 Select phonebook memory storage +CPBS
Table 71: +CPBS parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CPBS=<storage>
[,<password>]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CPBS? +CPBS: <storage>[,<used>,<total>]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CPBS=?
+CPBS: (list of supported <storage>s)

Description

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 87 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Set command selects phonebook memory storage <storage>, which is used by other phonebook commands. If
setting fails in an MT error, +CME ERROR: <err> is returned. Refer subclause 9.2 for <err> values.
Read command returns currently selected memory, and when supported by manufacturer, number of used locations and
total number of locations in the memory.
Test command returns supported storages as compound value.
Defined values
<storage> values reserved by the present document:
"DC" MT dialled calls list (+CPBW may not be applicable for this storage)
"EN" SIM/USIM (or MT) emergency number (+CPBW is not be applicable for this storage)
"FD" SIM/USIM fixdialling-phonebook. If a SIM card is present or if a UICC with an active GSM application
is present, the information in EF
FDN
under DF
Telecom
is selected. If a UICC with an active USIM
application is present, the information in EF
FDN
under ADF
USIM
is selected.
"LD" SIM/UICC last-dialling-phonebook
"MC" MT missed (unanswered received) calls list (+CPBW may not be applicable for this storage)
"ME" MT phonebook
"MT" combined MT and SIM/USIM phonebook
"ON" SIM (or MT) own numbers (MSISDNs) list (reading of this storage may be available through +CNUM
also). When storing information in the SIM/UICC, if a SIM card is present or if a UICC with an active
GSM application is present, the information in EF
MSISDN
under DF
Telecom
is selected. If a UICC with an
active USIM application is present, the information in EF
MSISDN
under ADF
USIM
is selected.
"RC" MT received calls list (+CPBW may not be applicable for this storage)
"SM" SIM/UICC phonebook. If a SIM card is present or if a UICC with an active GSM application is present,
the EF
ADN
under DF
Telecom
is selected. If a UICC with an active USIM application is present, the global
phonebook, DF
PHONEBOOK
under DF
Telecom
is selected.
"TA" TA phonebook
"AP" Selected application phonebook. If a UICC with an active USIM application is present, the application
phonebook, DF
PHONEBOOK
under ADF
USIM
is selected.
<password>: string type value representing the PIN2-code required when selecting PIN2-code locked
<storage>s above, e.g. "FD" or the hidden key to be verified in order to access to the hidden phonebook
entries in the UICC/USIM or any other phonebook with hidden entries.
If the combined phonebook is selected, "MT", the <password> will correspond to the hidden key of the USIM
phonebook.
<used>: integer type value indicating the number of used locations in selected memory
<total>: integer type value indicating the total number of locations in selected memory
Implementation
Mandatory when phonebook read, find or write command, or direct dialling (refer subclause "Direct dialling from
phonebooks") is implemented.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 88 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
8.12 Read phonebook entries +CPBR
Table 72: +CPBR action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CPBR=<index1>
[,<index2>]
[+CPBR: <index1>,<number>,<type>,<text>
[,<hidden>][,<group>][,<adnumber>][,<adtype>][,<secondte
xt>][,<email>][,<sip_uri>][,<tel_uri>]] [[...]
<CR><LF>+CPBR: <index2>,<number>,<type>,<text>
[,<hidden>][,<group>][,<adnumber>][,<adtype>][,<secondte
xt>][,<email>][,<sip_uri>][,<tel_uri>]]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CPBR=? +CPBR: (list of supported
<index>s),[<nlength>],[<tlength>],[<glength>],[<slength>
],[<elength>],[<siplength>],[<tellength>]
+CME ERROR: <err>

Description
Execution command returns phonebook entries in location number range <index1>... <index2> from the current
phonebook memory storage selected with +CPBS. If <index2> is left out, only location <index1> is returned. Entry
fields returned are location number <indexn>, phone number stored there <number> (of format <type>), text
<text> associated with the number, if the selected phonebook supports hidden entries, <hidden> indicating if the
entry is hidden, <group> indicating a group the entry may belong to, <adnumber> an additional number (of
format <adtype>), <secondtext> a second text field associated with the number, <email> an email field,
<sip_uri> SIP number and <tel_uri> TEL number. If all queried locations are empty (but available), no
information text lines may be returned. If listing fails in an MT error, +CME ERROR: <err> is returned. Refer
subclause 9.2 for <err> values.
Test command returns location range supported by the current storage as a compound value and the maximum lengths
of <number>, <text>, <group>, <secondtext>, <email>, <sip_uri> and <tel_uri> fields. In case of
(U)SIM storage, the lengths may not be available. If MT is not currently reachable, +CME ERROR: <err> is
returned. Refer subclause 9.2 for <err> values.
Defined values
<index1>, <index2>, <index>: integer type values in the range of location numbers of phonebook memory
<number>: string type phone number of format <type>
<type>: type of address octet in integer format (refer TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.4.7)
<text>: string type field of maximum length <tlength>; character set as specified by command Select TE
Character Set +CSCS
<group>: string type field of maximum length <glength>; character set as specified by command Select TE
Character Set +CSCS
<adnumber>: string type phone number of format <adtype>
<adtype>: type of address octet in integer format (refer TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.4.7)
<secondtext>: string type field of maximum length <slength>; character set as specified by command Select
TE Character Set +CSCS
<email>: string type field of maximum length <elength>; character set as specified by command Select TE
Character Set +CSCS
<sip_uri>: string type field of maximum length <siplength>; character set as specified by command Select
TE Character Set +CSCS

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 89 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
<tel_uri>: string type phone number of maximum length <tellength>; character set as specified by
command Select TE Character Set +CSCS
<nlength>: integer type value indicating the maximum length of field <number>
<tlength>: integer type value indicating the maximum length of field <text>
<glength>: integer type value indicating the maximum length of field <group>
<slength>: integer type value indicating the maximum length of field <secondtext>
<elength>: integer type value indicating the maximum length of field <email>
<siplength>: integer type value indicating the maximum length of field <sip_uri>
<tellength>: integer type value indicating the maximum length of field <tel_uri>
<hidden>: indicates if the entry is hidden or not
0: phonebook entry not hidden
1: phonebook entry hidden
Implementation
Optional.
8.13 Find phonebook entries +CPBF
Table 73: +CPBF action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CPBF=<findtext> [+CPBF: <index1>,<number>,<type>,<text>
[,<hidden>][,<group>][,<adnumber>][,<adtype>][,<se
condtext>][,<email>][,<sip_uri>][,<tel_uri>][[...]
<CR><LF>+CBPF: <index2>,<number>,<type>,<text>
[,<hidden>][,<group>][,<adnumber>][,<adtype>][,<se
condtext>][,<email>]]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CPBF=? +CPBF:
[<nlength>],[<tlength>],[<glength>],[<slength>],[<
elength>],[<siplength>],[<tellength>]
+CME ERROR: <err>

Description
Execution command returns phonebook entries (from the current phonebook memory storage selected with +CPBS)
which alphanumeric field start with string <findtext>. Entry fields returned are location number <indexn>, phone
number stored there <number> (of format <type>), text <text> associated with the number, if the selected
phonebook supports hidden entries, <hidden> indicating if the entry is hidden, <group> indicating a group the entry
may belong to, <adnumber> an additional number (of format <adtype>), <secondtext> a second text field
associated with the number, <email> an email field, <sip_uri> SIP number and <tel_uri> TEL number. If
listing fails in an MT error, +CME ERROR: <err> is returned. Refer subclause 9.2 for <err> values.
Test command returns the maximum lengths of <number>, <text>, <group>, <secondtext>, <email>,
<sip_uri> and <tel_uri> fields. In case of (U)SIM storage, the lengths may not be available. If MT is not
currently reachable, +CME ERROR: <err> is returned. Refer subclause 9.2 for <err> values.

Defined values

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 90 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
<index1>, <index2>: integer type values in the range of location numbers of phonebook memory
<number>: string type phone number of format <type>
<type>: type of address octet in integer format (refer TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.4.7)
<group>: string type field of maximum length <glength>; character set as specified by command Select TE
Character Set +CSCS
<adnumber>: string type phone number of format <adtype>
<adtype>: type of address octet in integer format (refer TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.4.7)
<secondtext>: string type field of maximum length <slength>; character set as specified by command Select
TE Character Set +CSCS
<email>: string type field of maximum length <elength>; character set as specified by command Select TE
Character Set +CSCS
<findtext>, <text>: string type field of maximum length <tlength>; character set as specified by command
Select TE Character Set +CSCS
<sip_uri>: string type field of maximum length <siplength>; character set as specified by command Select
TE Character Set +CSCS
<tel_uri>: string type phone number of maximum length <tellength>; character set as specified by
command Select TE Character Set +CSCS
<nlength>: integer type value indicating the maximum length of field <number>
<tlength>: integer type value indicating the maximum length of field <text>
<glength>: integer type value indicating the maximum length of field <group>
<slength>: integer type value indicating the maximum length of field <secondtext>
<elength>: integer type value indicating the maximum length of field <email>
<siplength>: integer type value indicating the maximum length of field <sip_uri>
<tellength>: integer type value indicating the maximum length of field <tel_uri>
<hidden>: indicates if the entry is hidden or not
0: phonebook entry not hidden
1: phonebook entry hidden
Implementation
Optional.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 91 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
8.14 Write phonebook entry +CPBW
Table 74: +CPBW action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CPBW=[<index>][,<number>
[,<type>[,<text>[,<group>[,<a
dnumber>[,<adtype>[,<secondte
xt>[,<email>[,<sip_uri>[,<tel
_uri>[,<hidden>]]]]]]]]]]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CPBW=?
+CPBW: (list of supported <index>s),[<nlength>],
(list of supported
<type>s),[<tlength>],[<glength>],[<slength>],[
<elength>],[<siplength>],[<tellength>]
+CME ERROR: <err>

Description
Execution command writes phonebook entry in location number <index> in the current phonebook memory storage
selected with +CPBS. Entry fields written are phone number <number> (in the format <type>), text <text>
associated with the number, if the selected phonebook supports hidden entries, <hidden> parameter, which indicates if
the entry is hidden or not, <group> indicating a group the entry may belong to, <adnumber> an additional
number (of format <adtype>), <secondtext> a second text field associated with the number, <email> an
email field, <sip_uri> SIP number and <tel_uri> TEL number. If those fields are omitted, phonebook entry is
deleted. If <index> is left out, but <number> is given, entry is written to the first free location in the phonebook (the
implementation of this feature is manufacturer specific). If writing fails in an MT error, +CME ERROR: <err> is
returned. Refer subclause 9.2 for <err> values.
Test command returns location range supported by the current storage as a compound value, the maximum length of
<number> field, supported number formats of the storage, the maximum length of <text> field, the maximum
length of <group>, the maximum length of <secondtext>, the maximum length of <email>, the maximum
length of <sip_uri> and the maximum length of <tel_uri>. In case of SIM storage, the lengths may not be
available. If MT is not currently reachable, +CME ERROR: <err> is returned. Refer subclause 9.2 for <err> values.
If storage does not offer format information, the format list should be empty parenthesis
Defined values
<index>: integer type values in the range of location numbers of phonebook memory
<number>: string type phone number of format <type>
<type>: type of address octet in integer format (refer TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.4.7) ; default 145 when dialling
string includes international access code character "+", otherwise 129
<text>: string type field of maximum length <tlength>; character set as specified by command Select TE
Character Set +CSCS
<group>: string type field of maximum length <glength>; character set as specified by command Select TE
Character Set +CSCS
<adnumber>: string type phone number of format <adtype>
<adtype>: type of address octet in integer format (refer TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.4.7)
<secondtext>: string type field of maximum length <slength>; character set as specified by command Select
TE Character Set +CSCS
<email>: string type field of maximum length <elength>; character set as specified by command Select TE
Character Set +CSCS

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 92 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
<sip_uri>: string type field of maximum length <siplength>; character set as specified by command Select
TE Character Set +CSCS
<tel_uri>: string type phone number of maximum length <tellength>; character set as specified by
command Select TE Character Set +CSCS
<nlength>: integer type value indicating the maximum length of field <number>
<tlength>: integer type value indicating the maximum length of field <text>
<glength>: integer type value indicating the maximum length of field <group>
<slength>: integer type value indicating the maximum length of field <secondtext>
<elength>: integer type value indicating the maximum length of field <email>
<siplength>: integer type value indicating the maximum length of field <sip_uri>
<tellength>: integer type value indicating the maximum length of field <tel_uri>
<hidden>: indicates if the entry is hidden or not
0: phonebook entry not hidden
1: phonebook entry hidden
Implementation
Optional.
8.15 Clock +CCLK
Table 75: +CCLK parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CCLK=<time> +CME ERROR: <err>
+CCLK? +CCLK: <time>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CCLK=?

Description
Set command sets the real-time clock of the MT. If setting fails in an MT error, +CME ERROR: <err> is returned.
Refer subclause 9.2 for <err> values.
Read command returns the current setting of the clock.
Defined values
<time>: string type value; format is "yy/MM/dd,hh:mm:sszz", where characters indicate year (two last digits),
month, day, hour, minutes, seconds and time zone (indicates the difference, expressed in quarters of an hour,
between the local time and GMT; range -96...+96). E.g. 6th of May 1994, 22:10:00 GMT+2 hours equals to
"94/05/06,22:10:00+08"
NOTE: If MT does not support time zone information then the three last characters of <time> are not returned by
+CCLK?. The format of <time> is specified by use of the +CSDF command.
Implementation
Optional.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 93 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
8.16 Alarm +CALA
Table 76: +CALA parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CALA=<time>[,<n>[,<type>
[,<text>[,<recurr>[,<silent
>]]]]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CALA? [+CALA:
<time>,<n1>,<type>,[<text>],[<recurr>],<silent
>
[<CR><LF>+CALA:
<time>,<n2>,<type>,[<text>],[<recurr>],<silent
>
[...]]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CALA=? +CALA: (list of supported <n>s),(list of supported
<type>s),<tlength>,<rlength>,(list of supported
<silent>s)
+CME ERROR: <err>

Description
Set command sets an alarm time in the MT. There can be an array of different types of alarms, and each alarm may
cause different text to be displayed in the MT display. If setting fails in an MT error, +CME ERROR: <err> is
returned. Refer subclause 9.2 for <err> values.
To set up a recurrent alarm for one or more days in the week, the <recurr>-parameter may be used.
When an alarm is timed out and executed, the unsolicited result code +CALV: <n> is always returned, even if the
alarm is set up to be silent.
Read command returns the list of current active alarm settings in the MT.
Test command returns supported array index values, alarm types, and maximum length of the text to be displayed.
Defined values
<time>: refer +CCLK,+CSDF
NOTE: If the <recurr>-parameter is used, the <time>-parameter must not contain a date.
<n>, <n1>, <n2>: integer type value indicating the index of the alarm; default is manufacturer specific
<type>: integer type value indicating the type of the alarm (e.g. sound, volume, LED); values and default are
manufacturer specific
<text>: string type value indicating the text to be displayed when alarm time is reached; maximum length
<tlength>
<tlength>: integer type value indicating the maximum length of <text>
<recurr>: string type value indicating day of week for the alarm in one of the following formats:

"<1..7>[,<1..7>[]]" Sets a recurrent alarm for one or more days in the week. The digits 1 to 7 corresponds to
the days in the week, Monday (1), , Sunday (7).
Example: The string "1,2,3,4,5" may be used to set an alarm for all weekdays.

"0" Sets a recurrent alarm for all days in the week.
<rlength>: integer type value indicating the maximum length of <recurr>

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 94 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
<silent>: Integer type value indicating if the alarm is silent or not. If set to 1 the alarm will be silent and the only
result from the alarm is the unsolicited result code +CALV. If set to 0 the alarm will not be silent.
Implementation
Optional.
8.17 Generic SIM access +CSIM
Table 77: +CSIM action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CSIM=<length>,<command> +CSIM: <length>,<response>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CSIM=?

Description
Set command transmits to the MT the <command> it then shall send as it is to the SIM. In the same manner the SIM
<response> shall be sent back by the MT to the TA as it is. Refer subclause 9.2 for <err> values.
This command allows a direct control of the SIM by an distant application on the TE. The TE shall then take care of
processing SIM information within the frame specified by GSM/UMTS.
NOTE: Compared to Restricted SIM Access command +CRSM, the definition of +CSIM allows TE to take more
control over the SIM-MT interface. The locking and unlocking of the interface may be done by a special
<command> value or automatically by TA/MT (by interpreting <command> parameter). In case that TE
application does not use the unlock command (or does not send a <command> causing automatic
unlock) in a certain timeout value, MT may release the locking.
Defined values
<length> : integer type; length of the characters that are sent to TE in <command> or <response> (two times
the actual length of the command or response)
<command> : command passed on by the MT to the SIM in the format as described in GSM 51.011 [28]
(hexadecimal character format; refer +CSCS)
<response> : response to the command passed on by the SIM to the MT in the format as described in
GSM 51.011 [28] (hexadecimal character format; refer +CSCS)
Implementation
Optional.
8.18 Restricted SIM access +CRSM
Table 78: +CRSM action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CRSM=<command>[,<fileid>
[,<P1>,<P2>,<P3>
[,<data>[,<pathid>]]]]
+CRSM: <sw1>,<sw2>[,<response>]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CRSM=?


ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 95 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Description
By using this command instead of Generic SIM Access +CSIM TE application has easier but more limited access to the
SIM database. Set command transmits to the MT the SIM <command> and its required parameters. MT handles
internally all SIM-MT interface locking and file selection routines. As response to the command, MT sends the actual
SIM information parameters and response data. MT error result code +CME ERROR may be returned when the
command cannot be passed to the SIM, but failure in the execution of the command in the SIM is reported in <sw1>
and <sw2> parameters. Refer to subclause 9.2 for <err> values.
Coordination of command requests to SIM and the ones issued by GSM/UMTS application inside the MT is
implementation dependent. However the TE should be aware of the precedence of the GSM/UMTS application
commands to the TE commands.
Defined values
<command> (command passed on by the MT to the SIM; refer GSM 51.011 [28]):
176 READ BINARY
178 READ RECORD
192 GET RESPONSE
214 UPDATE BINARY
220 UPDATE RECORD
242 STATUS
203 RETRIEVE DATA
219 SET DATA
all other values are reserved
NOTE 1: The MT internally executes all commands necessary for selecting the desired file, before performing the
actual command.
<fileid>: integer type; this is the identifier of a elementary datafile on SIM. Mandatory for every command
except STATUS
NOTE 2: The range of valid file identifiers depends on the actual SIM and is defined in GSM 51.011 [28]. Optional
files may not be present at all.
<P1>, <P2>, <P3>: integer type; parameters passed on by the MT to the SIM. These parameters are mandatory for
every command, except GET RESPONSE and STATUS. The values are described in GSM 51.011 [28]
<data>: information which shall be written to the SIM (hexadecimal character format; refer +CSCS)
<pathid>: string type; contains the path of an elementary file on the SIM/UICC in hexadecimal format as
defined in ETSI TS 102 221 [60] (e.g. "7F205F70" in SIM and UICC case). The <pathid> shall only be used
in the mode "select by path from MF" as defined in ETSI TS 102 221 [60].
NOTE 3: Since valid elementary file identifiers may not be unique over all valid dedicated file identifiers the
<pathid> indicates the targeted UICC/SIM directory path in case of ambiguous file identifiers. For
earlier versions of this specification or if <pathid> is omitted, it could be implementation specific
which one will be selected.
<sw1>, <sw2>: integer type; information from the SIM about the execution of the actual command. These
parameters are delivered to the TE in both cases, on successful or failed execution of the command
<response>: response of a successful completion of the command previously issued (hexadecimal character
format; refer +CSCS). STATUS and GET RESPONSE return data, which gives information about the current
elementary datafield. This information includes the type of file and its size (refer GSM 51.011 [28]). After
READ BINARY, READ RECORD or RETRIEVE DATA command the requested data will be returned.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 96 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
<response> is not returned after a successful UPDATE BINARY, UPDATE RECORD or SET DATA
command
Implementation
Optional.
8.19 Secure control command +CSCC
Table 79: +CSCC parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CSCC=<mode>[,<cmd_set>[,
<token>]]
+CSCC: <challenge>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CSCC? +CSCC: <mode>,<cmd_set1>
[<CR><LF>+CSCC: <mode>,<cmd_set2>
[...]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CSCC=? +CSCC: (list of supported <mode>s),(list of supported
<cmd_set>s)

Description
This command is used to enable/disable access to commands protected by security mechanism. This enables/disables
access to command sets designated as "secure" such as programming of MT. Refer subclause 9.2 for possible <err>
values.
The TE asks for a <challenge> with <mode>=1 and one specific command set (<cmd_set>), the MT replies with
the <challenge>, which should be inserted into the identification algorithm in both entities (TE and MT). The
algorithm output <token> is sent to the MT with <mode>=2 to enable the specified command set. <mode>=3 is used
to disable the command set.
The read command returns the status (<mode> 2 or 3) of each supported command set.
Defined values
<mode>:
1 request challenge token to enable access to specified command set
2 enable access to specified command set (<token> required)
3 disable access to specified command set
<cmd_set>, <cmd_set1>, <cmd_set2>:
0 MT/TA code re-programming command set.
other values below 128 are reserved by the present document
<token>: string type; a variable length bit string represented with IRA characters 0 - 9 and A - F, each character
representing a nibble; e.g. bit string "0110 1100 1001 1010" is represented by the IRA string "6C9A". The length of the
required bit string varies depending on the value of <cmd_set>.
<challenge>: same format as token
Implementation
Optional.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 97 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
8.20 Alert sound mode +CALM
Table 80: +CALM parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CALM=<mode> +CME ERROR: <err>
+CALM? +CALM: <mode>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CALM=?
+CALM: (list of supported <mode>s)
+CME ERROR: <err>

Description
This command is used to select the general alert sound mode of the MT. Refer subclause 9.2 for possible <err>
values.
Test command returns supported values as compound value.
Defined values
<mode>:
0 normal mode
1 silent mode (all sounds from MT are prevented)
2 manufacturer specific
Implementation
Optional.
8.21 Ringer sound level +CRSL
Table 81: +CRSL parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CRSL=<level> +CME ERROR: <err>
+CRSL? +CRSL: <level>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CRSL=?
+CRSL: (list of supported <level>s)
+CME ERROR: <err>

Description
This command is used to select the incoming call ringer sound level of the MT. Refer subclause 9.2 for possible
<err> values.
Test command returns supported values as compound value.
Defined values
<level>: integer type value with manufacturer specific range (smallest value represents the lowest sound level)
Implementation
Optional.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 98 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
8.22 Vibrator mode +CVIB
Table 82: +CVIB parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CVIB=<mode> +CME ERROR: <err>
+CVIB? +CVIB: <mode>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CVIB=?
+CVIB: (list of supported <mode>s)
+CME ERROR: <err>

Description
This command is used to enable and disable the vibrator alert feature of the MT. It is manufacturer specific how this
interacts with +CALM command. Refer subclause 9.2 for possible <err> values.
Test command returns supported values as compound value.
Defined values
<mode>:
0 disable
1 enable
...15 reserved by the present document
16 manufacturer specific
Implementation
Optional.
8.23 Loudspeaker volume level +CLVL
Table 83: +CLVL parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CLVL=<level> +CME ERROR: <err>
+CLVL? +CLVL: <level>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CLVL=?
+CLVL: (list of supported <level>s)
+CME ERROR: <err>

Description
This command is used to select the volume of the internal loudspeaker of the MT. Refer subclause 9.2 for possible
<err> values.
Test command returns supported values as compound value.
Defined values
<level>: integer type value with manufacturer specific range (smallest value represents the lowest sound level)
Implementation
Optional.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 99 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
8.24 Mute control +CMUT
Table 84: +CMUT parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CMUT=<n> +CME ERROR: <err>
+CMUT? +CMUT: <n>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CMUT=?
+CMUT: (list of supported <n>s)

Description
This command is used to enable and disable the uplink voice muting during a voice call. Refer subclause 9.2 for
possible <err> values.
Test command returns supported values as compound value.
Defined values
<n>:
0 mute off
1 mute on
Implementation
Optional.
8.25 Accumulated call meter +CACM
Table 85: +CACM parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CACM=[<passwd>] +CME ERROR: <err>
+CACM? +CACM: <acm>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CACM=?

Description
Set command resets the Advice of Charge related accumulated call meter value in SIM card or in the active application
in the UICC (GSM or USIM) file EF
ACM
. ACM contains the total number of home units for both the current and
preceding calls. SIM PIN2 is usually required to reset the value. If setting fails in an MT error, +CME ERROR:
<err> is returned. Refer subclause 9.2 for <err> values.
Read command returns the current value of ACM.
Defined values
<passwd>: string type; SIM PIN2
<acm>: string type; accumulated call meter value similarly coded as <ccm> under +CAOC
Implementation
Optional.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 100 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
8.26 Accumulated call meter maximum +CAMM
Table 86: +CAMM parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CAMM=[<acmmax>[,<passwd>]] +CME ERROR: <err>
+CAMM? +CAMM: <acmmax>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CAMM=?

Description
Set command sets the Advice of Charge related accumulated call meter maximum value in SIM card or in the active
application in the UICC (GSM or USIM) file EF
ACMmax
. ACMmax contains the maximum number of home units
allowed to be consumed by the subscriber. When ACM (refer +CACM) reaches ACMmax calls are prohibited (see also
3GPP TS 22.024 [26]). SIM PIN2 is usually required to set the value. If setting fails in an MT error, +CME ERROR:
<err> is returned. Refer subclause 9.2 for <err> values.
Read command returns the current value of ACMmax.
Defined values
<acmmax>: string type; accumulated call meter maximum value similarly coded as <ccm> under +CAOC; value
zero disables ACMmax feature
<passwd>: string type; SIM PIN2
Implementation
Optional.
8.27 Price per unit and currency table +CPUC
Table 87: +CPUC parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CPUC=<currency>,<ppu>[,<passwd>] +CME ERROR: <err>
+CPUC? +CPUC: <currency>,<ppu>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CPUC=?

Description
Set command sets the parameters of Advice of Charge related price per unit and currency table in SIM card or in the
active application in the UICC (GSM or USIM) file EF
PUCT
. PUCT information can be used to convert the home units
(as used in +CAOC, +CACM and +CAMM) into currency units. SIM PIN2 is usually required to set the parameters. If
setting fails in an MT error, +CME ERROR: <err> is returned. Refer subclause 9.2 for <err> values.
Read command returns the current parameters of PUCT.
Defined values
<currency>: string type; three-character currency code (e.g. "GBP", "DEM"); character set as specified by
command Select TE Character Set +CSCS
<ppu>: string type; price per unit; dot is used as a decimal separator (e.g. "2.66")
<passwd>: string type; SIM PIN2

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 101 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Implementation
Optional.
8.28 Call Meter maximum event +CCWE
Table 88: +CCWE parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CCWE=<mode> +CME ERROR: <err>
+CCWE? +CCWE: <mode>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CCWE=? +CCWE: (list of supported <mode>s)
+CME ERROR: <err>

Description
Shortly before the ACM (Accumulated Call Meter) maximum value is reached, an unsolicited result code +CCWV will
be sent, if enabled by this command. The warning is issued approximately when 30 seconds call time remains. It is also
issued when starting a call if less than 30 s call time remains. If setting fails in an MT error, +CME ERROR: <err>
is returned. Refer subclause 9.2 for <err> values.
Read command returns the current setting.
Test command returns supported settings.
Defined values
<mode>:
0 Disable the call meter warning event
1 Enable the call meter warning event
Implementation
Optional.
8.29 Power class +CPWC
Table 89: +CPWC parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CPWC=[<class>[,<band>]] +CME ERROR: <err>
+CPWC? +CPWC:
<curr_class1>,<def_class1>,<band1>
[,<curr_class2>,<def_class2>,<band
2>[...]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CPWC=? +CPWC: list of supported (<band>,(list of
<class>s)) pairs
+CME ERROR: <err>

Description
This command is used to set the preferred MT power class for each GSM frequency band supported. The interaction of
this setting with the selected bearer service (+CBST and HSCSD commands) is manufacturer specific (for example,
selecting a multislot operation might reduce the power class automatically). If setting fails in an MT error, +CME
ERROR: <err> is returned. Refer subclause 9.2 for <err> values.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 102 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Read command returns the currently selected output power class and default output power class for each supported
frequency band (as defined by MT manufacturer). Parameter <band1> and its associated power class parameters refer
to the currently used frequency band. For example, +CPWC: 2,1,1,5,4,0 in case of a dual-band MT currently
using band GSM1800, for which the power class is currently set to 2, the default being class 1, and for which the
currently set power class value for GSM900 is class 5 the default being class 4.
Test command returns supported bands and their power classes. For example,
+CPWC: (0,(0,4,5)),(1,(0-2)) in case of a dual-band handheld MT.
Defined values
<class>, <curr_classn>s, <def_classn>s:
0 default (not applicable to <curr_class>s or <def_classn>s)
1 MT output power class as in GSM 45.005 [38]
<band>, <bandn>s:
0 GSM900
1 GSM1800
2 reserved for GSM1900
3 GSM 400
Implementation
Optional.
8.30 Set Language +CLAN
Table 90: +CLAN parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CLAN=<code> +CME ERROR: <err>
+CLAN? +CLAN: <code>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CLAN=? +CLAN:(list of supported <code>s)
+CME ERROR: <err>

Description
This command sets the language in the MT. The set-command must confirm the selected language with the MMI-
module in the MT. If setting fails, a MT error, +CME ERROR: <err> is returned. Refer subclause 9.2 for <err> values.
The <code>-parameter is a two-letter abbreviation of the language. The language codes, as defined in ISO 639, consists
of two characters, e.g. "sv", "en" etc.
The complete set of language codes to be used are manufacturer specific and should all be possible to use with the
command. Some examples are described under <code>. For a complete list see ISO 639.
The read command gives the current language as output. If the language has been set to "AUTO", the read command
returns the current language set from the SIM-card /UICC. Hence, the "AUTO"-code is never returned by the read-
command.
Test command returns supported <code>s.
Defined values
<code>: (not all language codes are present in this list)

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 103 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
"AUTO" Read language from SIM-card /UICC. "Auto" is not returned by the read-command.
"sw" Swedish
"fi" Finnish
"da" Danish
"no" Norwegian
"de" German
"fr" French
"es" Spanish
"it" Italian
"en" English
Implementation
Optional.
8.31 Language Event +CLAE
Table 91: +CLAE parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CLAE=<mode> +CME ERROR: <err>
+CLAE? +CLAE: <mode>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CLAE=? +CLAE: (list of supported <mode>s)
+CME ERROR: <err>

Description
This command is used to enable/disable unsolicited result code +CLAV: <code>. If <mode>=1, +CLAV: <code > is
sent from the MT when the language in the MT is changed. If setting fails, a MT error, +CME ERROR: <err> is
returned. Refer subclause 9.2 for <err> values.
Read command returns the current status for <mode>.
Test command returns supported <mode>s.
Defined values
<mode>:
0 Disable unsolicited result code +CLAE
1 Enable unsolicited result code +CLAE
<code>: For description see +CLAN.
Implementation
Optional.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 104 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
8.32 Set Greeting Text +CSGT
Table 92: +CSGT parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CSGT=<mode>[,<text>] +CME ERROR: <err>
+CSGT? +CSGT: <text>, <mode>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CSGT=? +CSGT:(list of supported <mode>s),
<ltext>
+CME ERROR: <err>

Description
This command sets and activates the greeting text in the MT. The greeting text is shown in the MT display when the
MT is turned on. The command can also be used to deactivate a text. If setting fails in an MT error, +CME ERROR:
<err> is returned. Refer subclause 9.2 for <err> values.
The read command queries the current <text> and the status of the <mode> parameter
Test command returns supported <mode>s and the maximum number of characters in <text>. For example,
+CSGT: (0-1),20
Defined values
<text>: string type; A free text that shall be displayed. The text can not include <CR>
<mode>:
0 Turn off greeting text.
1 Turn on greeting text
Implementation
Optional.
8.33 Set Voice Mail Number +CSVM
Table 93: +CSVM parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CSVM=<mode>[,<number>[,<
type>]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CSVM? +CSVM:<mode>,<number>,<type>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CSVM=? +CSVM: (list of supported
<mode>s), (list of supported
<type>s)
+CME ERROR: <err>

Description
The number to the voice mail server is set with this command. The parameters <number> and <type> can be left out if
the parameter <mode> is set to 0. If setting fails, an MT error, +CME ERROR: <err> is returned. Refer subclause 9.2
for <err> values.
Read command returns the currently selected voice mail number and the status (i.e. enabled/disabled).

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 105 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Test command returns supported <mode>s and <type>s.
Defined values
<mode>:
0 Disable the voice mail number.
1 Enable the voice mail number.
<number>: string type; Character string <0..9,+>
<type>: integer type; Type of address octet. (refer TS 24.008 subclause 10.5.4.7)
129 ISDN / telephony numbering plan, national / international unknown
145 ISDN / telephony numbering plan, international number
161 ISDN / telephony numbering plan, national number
128 - 255 Other values refer TS 24.008 section 10.5.4.7
<type>: type of address octet in integer format (refer TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.4.7); default 145 when dialling
string includes international access code character "+", otherwise 129
Implementation
Optional.
8.34 Ring Melody Control +CRMC
Table 94: +CRMC action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CRMC=<index>,<volume>[,[<call
type>][,<profile>]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CRMC? +CRMC: <index>,<volume>[,[<call
type1>][,<profile1>]][<CR><LF>
+CRMC: <index>,<volume>[,[<call
type2>][,<profile1>]] [...]][<CR><LF>
+CRMC: <index>,<volume>[,[<call
type1>][,<profile2>]]][<CR><LF>
+CRMC: <index>,<volume>[,[<call
type2>][,<profile2>]] [...]]

+CME ERROR: <err>
+CRMC=? +CRMC: (list of supported
<index>s),(list of supported
<volume>s)[,[(list of supported <call
type>s)][,(list of supported
<profile>s)]]

+CME ERROR: <err>

Description
Write command causes the MT to set a specific ring melody and volume for the selected call type and profile. The
default values for the optional parameters are defined by the manufacturer.
Read command queries the settings for the ring melody. If call types and profiles are available the corresponding ring
melodies are listed. Starting with call type1 and profile1 the ring melody settings for each available profile and call type
is issued.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 106 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Test command returns the list of available ring melodies, volumes, call types and profiles.
Defined values:
<index>: integer type; manufacturer specific number to identify a certain ring melody
<volume>: integer type value with manufacturer specific range (smallest value represents the lowest sound level)
<call typex>: integer type; manufacturer specific number for a call type
<profilex>: integer type; manufacturer specific number for a profile
Implementation
Optional.
8.35 Ring Melody Playback +CRMP
Table 95: +CRMP action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CRMP=<call type>[,<volume>
[,<type>,<index>]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CRMP=? +CRMP: (list of supported <call
type>s),(list of supported
<volume>s),(<type0>),(list of
supported <index>s)[<CR><LF>
+CRMP: (list of supported <call
type>s),(list of supported
<volume>s),(<type1>),(list of
supported <index>s)

+CME ERROR: <err>

Description
Execution command causes the MT to playback a specific ring type. The default values for the optional parameters are
the current selected in the MT.
Test command returns the available ring melodies.
Defined values:
<call type>: integer type; manufacturer specific
<volume>: integer type value with manufacturer specific range (smallest value represents the lowest sound level)
<type>:
0 Manufacturer defined
1 User defined
<index>: integer type;
Implementation
Optional.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 107 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
8.36 Master Reset +CMAR
Table 96: +CMAR action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CMAR=<phone lock code> +CME ERROR: <err>
+CMAR=? +CME ERROR: <err>

Description
This command requests the MT to reset user data. The user data in the phone will be reset to default values. If setting
fails, a MT error, +CME ERROR: <err>, is returned. Refer subclause 9.2 for <err> values.
If the MT is locked and this command is used, then the MT will be unlocked after the master reset.
Test command returns OK
Defined values
<phone lock code > string type; Security code (Phone Lock code) must be verified before performing the
master reset.
Implementation
Optional.
8.37 List all available AT commands +CLAC
Table 97: +C action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CLAC <AT Command1> [<CR> <LF> <AT
Command2>[]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CLAC=? +CME ERROR: <err>

Description
Execution command causes the MT to return one or more lines of AT Commands.
Note: This command only returns the AT commands that are available for the user.
Defined values
<AT Command >:
Defines the AT command including the prefix AT. Text shall not contain the sequence 0<CR> or OK<CR>
Implementation
Optional.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 108 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
8.38 Delete alarm +CALD
Table 98: +CALD action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CALD=<n> +CME ERROR: <err>
+CALD=?
+CALD: (list of supported <n>s)
+CME ERROR: <err>

Description
Action command deletes an alarm in the MT. If the command fails in an MT error, +CME ERROR: <err> is
returned. Refer subclause 9.2 for <err> values.
Test command returns supported array index values.
Defined values
<n>: integer type value indicating the index of the alarm; default is manufacturer specific
Implementation
Optional.
8.39 Postpone or dismiss an alarm +CAPD
Table 99: +CAPD action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CAPD=[<sec>] +CME ERROR: <err>
+CAPD=?
+CAPD: (list of supported <sec>s)
+CME ERROR: <err>

Description
Set command postpones or dismisses a currently active alarm. If the command fails in an MT error, +CME ERROR:
<err> is returned. Refer subclause 9.2 for <err> values.
Test command returns supported <sec>-parameter values.
Defined values
<sec>: integer type value indicating the number of seconds to postpone the alarm. If <sec> is set to 0 (default),
the alarm is dismissed.
Implementation
Optional.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 109 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
8.40 Automatic Time Zone Update +CTZU
Table 100: +CTZU parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CTZU=<onoff> +CME ERROR: <err>
+CTZU? +CTZU: <onoff>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CTZU=?
+CTZU: (list of supported <onoff>s)
+CME ERROR: <err>

Description
Set command enables and disables automatic time zone update via NITZ. If setting fails in an MT error, +CME
ERROR: <err> is returned. Refer subclause 9.2 for <err> values.
Read command returns the current settings in the MT.
Test command returns supported on- and off-values.
Defined values
<onoff>: integer type value indicating:
0 Disable automatic time zone update via NITZ (default).
1 Enable automatic time zone update via NITZ.
Implementation
Optional.
8.41 Time Zone Reporting +CTZR
Table 101: +CTZR parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CTZR=<onoff> +CME ERROR: <err>
+CTZR? +CTZR: <onoff>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CTZR=?
+CTZR: (list of supported <onoff>s)
+CME ERROR: <err>

Description
This set command enables and disables the time zone change event reporting. If the reporting is enabled the MT returns
the unsolicited result code +CTZV: <tz> whenever the time zone is changed. If setting fails in an MT error, +CME
ERROR: <err> is returned. Refer subclause 9.2 for <err> values.
Read command returns the current reporting settings in the MT.
Test command returns supported <onoff>-values.
NOTE: The Time Zone reporting is not affected by the Automatic Time Zone setting command, +CTZU.
Defined values
<onoff>: integer type value indicating:
0 disable time zone change event reporting (default).

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 110 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
1 Enable time zone change event reporting.
Implementation
Optional.
8.42 Enter protocol mode+CPROT
Table 102: +CPROT parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CPROT=<proto>[,<version>
[,<lsap1>[,...[<lsapN>]]]
]
CONNECT
NO CARRIER
OK
ERROR
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CPROT=? +CPROT: <proto1>[,(list of supported
<version>s)[,(list of supported
<lsap1>s)[,...[,(list of supported
<lsapN>s)]]]]
[<CR><LF>
+CPROT : <proto2>[,(list of supported
<version>s)[,(list of supported
<lsap1>s)[,...[,(list of supported
<lsapN>s)]]]]]
[...]]]]]

Description
Set command informs TA that TE wants to establish a peer-to-peer protocol <proto> or upper layer connection
(indicating by the <lsap>s setting) with the MT on the link from which the command was received.
This command can be used in case the link between TE and MT does not provide itself such a mechanism.
If MT has succeeded in establishing a logical link between application protocols and external interface, it will send
CONNECT message to the TE. Otherwise, the NO CARRIER response will be returned.
If the CONNECT response is received, TE can start sending <proto> or upper layer frames.
The connection shall always return for <proto> mode when the protocol session is ended. When the MT receives a
disconnect request from its peer entity, it will process it and send OK response to the TE indicating its capability for
receiving new AT commands. Since <proto> or upper layers can be accessed in other ways, TA must have pre-
knowledge of the fact that connection is initiated with AT+CPROT command. This means that switch to <proto>
mode must include some sort of notification to the protocol entity.
This command can be aborted by sending a <proto> or upper layer disconnection frame. In that case, MT will return
in command mode by sending the OK response.
Refer subclause 9.2 for possible <err> values.
Test command returns values supported as a compound value.
Defined values
<proto>
0 OBEX (refer.[44])
15 reserved by the present document
16... manufacturer specific
<version>: version number of <proto>: string type

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 111 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
<lsap1>: defines a level of service or application protocol on the top of <proto> layer. It may refer to services
or protocols defined in other standards development organizations (SDOs).
1 IrMC level 1 (Minimum Level) Only .(refer [43] subclause 2.9.4)
2 IrMC level 1 and 2 (Minimum and Access Levels) Only. .(refer [43] subclause 2.9.4)
4 IrMC level 1, 2 and 3 (Minimum, Access, Index Levels) Only- implies static index support. .(refer
[43] subclause 2.9.4)
8 IrMC level 1, 2 and 4 (Minimum, Access and Sync Levels) Only-implies unique index support. .(refer
[43] subclause 2.9.4)
10 IrMC level 1, 2, 3 and 4 (Minimum, Access, Index and Sync Levels)-implies support of static and
unique index. .(refer [43] subclause 2.9.4)
15 reserved by the present document
16... manufacturer specific
<lsap2>...<lsapN>
In case <lsapN>,<lsapN+1> received in the +CPROT command identifies protocol layers, the protocol identified by
N+1 shall be on the top of the protocol identified by N on a framework point of view.
015 reserved by the present document
16... manufacturer specific
Implementation
Optional.
8.43 Generic UICC Logical Channel access +CGLA
Table 103: +CGLA action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CGLA=<sessionid>,<length>
,<command>
+CGLA: <length>,<response>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CGLA=?

Description
Set command transmits to the MT the <command> it then shall send as it is to the UICC. In the same manner the UICC
<response> shall be sent back by the MT to the TA as it is. Refer subclause 9.2 for <err> values.
This command allows a direct control of the UICC by a distant application on the TE. The TE shall then take care of
processing UICC information within the frame specified by GSM/UMTS.
Although Generic UICC Logical Channel Access command +CGLA allows TE to take control over the UICC-MT
interface, there are some functions of the UICC-MT interface that logically do not need to be accessed from outside the
TA/MT. Moreover, for security reason the GSM network authentication should not be handled outside the TA/MT.
Therefore it shall not be allowed to execute a Run GSM Algorithm command or an Authenticate command in GSM
context from the TE using +CGLA at all time whether the +CGLA is locked or unlocked. This shall not forbid the TE to
send Authenticate commands in other security contexts (e.g. EAP security context).
For example, the TA/MT shall forbid the transfer of the Authenticate command to a USIM application when parameters
P2 = 0 (GSM security context). See TS 31.102 [59] for USIM authenticate command definition.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 112 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
NOTE: Compared to Restricted UICC Access command +CRLA, the definition of +CGLA allows TE to take more
control over the UICC-MT interface. The locking and unlocking of the interface may be done by a special
<command> value or automatically by TA/MT (by interpreting <command> parameter). In case that TE
application does not use the unlock command (or does not send a <command> causing automatic
unlock) in a certain timeout value, MT may release the locking.
Defined values
<sessionid>: integer type; this is the identifier of the session to be used in order to send the APDU commands
to the UICC. It is manadatory in order to send commands to the UICC when targeting applications on the smart
card using a logical channel other than the default channel (channel "0").
<length> : integer type; length of the characters that are sent to TE in <command> or <response> (two times
the actual length of the command or response)
<command> : command passed on by the MT to the UICC in the format as described in 3GPP TS 31.101 [65]
(hexadecimal character format; refer +CSCS)
<response> : response to the command passed on by the UICC to the MT in the format as described in 3GPP TS
31.101 [65] (hexadecimal character format; refer +CSCS)
Implementation
Optional.
8.44 Restricted UICC Logical Channel access +CRLA
Table 104: +CRLA action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CRLA=<sessionid>,<command>[,
<fileid>
[,<P1>,<P2>,<P3>[,<data>[,<pa
thid>]]]]
+CRLA: <sw1>,<sw2>[,<response>]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CRLA=?

Description
By using this command instead of Generic UICC Access +CGLA TE application has easier but more limited access to
the UICC database. Set command transmits to the MT the UICC <command> and its required parameters. MT handles
internally all UICC-MT interface locking and file selection routines. As response to the command, MT sends the actual
UICC information parameters and response data. MT error result code +CME ERROR may be returned when the
command cannot be passed to the UICC, but failure in the execution of the command in the UICC is reported in <sw1>
and <sw2> parameters. Refer to subclause 9.2 for <err> values.
Coordination of command requests to UICC and the ones issued by GSM/UMTS application inside the MT is
implementation dependent. However the TE should be aware of the precedence of the GSM/UMTS application
commands to the TE commands.
Defined values
<sessionid>: integer type; this is the identifier of the session to be used in order to send the APDU commands
to the UICC. It is mandatory in order to send commands to the UICC when targeting applications on the smart
card using a logical channel other than the default channel (channel "0").
<command> (command passed on by the MT to the UICC; refer 3GPP TS 31.101 [65]):
176 READ BINARY
178 READ RECORD
192 GET RESPONSE

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 113 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
214 UPDATE BINARY
220 UPDATE RECORD
242 STATUS
203 RETRIEVE DATA
219 SET DATA
all other values are reserved

NOTE 1: The MT internally executes all commands necessary for selecting the desired file, before performing the
actual command.<fileid>: integer type; this is the identifier of a elementary datafile on UICC. Mandatory for
every command except STATUS.
NOTE 2: The range of valid file identifiers depends on the actual UICC and is defined in 3GPP TS 31.101 [65].
Optional files may not be present at all.<P1>, <P2>, <P3>: integer type; parameters passed on by the MT to the
UICC. These parameters are mandatory for every command, except GET RESPONSE and STATUS. The values
are described in 3GPP TS 31.101 [65]
<data>: information which shall be written to the SIM (hexadecimal character format; refer +CSCS)
<pathid>: string type; contains the path of an elementary file on the UICC in hexadecimal format (e.g.
"5F704F30" for DF
SoLSA
/EF
SAI
). The <pathid> shall only be used in the mode "select by path from current
DF" as defined in ETSI TS 102 221 [60].
<sw1>, <sw2>: integer type; information from the UICC about the execution of the actual command. These
parameters are delivered to the TE in both cases, on successful or failed execution of the command
<response>: response of a successful completion of the command previously issued (hexadecimal character
format; refer +CSCS). STATUS and GET RESPONSE return data, which gives information about the current
elementary datafield. This information includes the type of file and its size (refer 3GPP TS 31.101 [65]). After
READ BINARY, READ RECORD or RETRIEVE DATA command the requested data will be returned.
<response> is not returned after a successful UPDATE BINARY, UPDATE RECORD or SET DATA
command
Implementation
Optional.
8.45 Open Logical Channel +CCHO
Table 105: +CCHO action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CCHO=<dfname> <sessionid>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CCHO=?

Description
Execution of the command causes the MT to return <sessionid> to allow the TE to identify a channel that is being
allocated by the UICC, which is attached to ME. The UICC will open a new logical channel; select the application
identified by the <dfname> received with this command and return a session Id as the response. The ME shall restrict
the communication between the TE and the UICC to this logical channel.
This <sessionid> is to be used when sending commands with Restricted UICC Logical Channel access +CRLA or
Generic UICC Logical Channel access +CGLA commands.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 114 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Note that the logical channel number is contained in the CLASS byte of an APDU command, thus implicitly contained
in all APDU commands sent to a UICC. In this case it will be up to the MT to manage the logical channel part of the
APDU CLASS byte and to ensure that the chosen logical channel is relevant to the <sessionid> indicated in the
AT command. See 3GPP TS 31.101 [65] for further information on logical channels in APDU commands protocol.
Refer subclause 9.2 for possible <err> values.
Defined values
<dfname>: all selectable applications in the UICC are referenced by a DF name coded on 1 to 16 bytes
<sessionid>:A session Id to be used in order to target a specific application on the smart card (e.g. (U)SIM,
WIM, ISIM) using logical channels mechanism (string without double quotes that represents a decimal value)
See 3GPP TS 31.101 [65] for more information about defined values.
Implementation
Optional.

8.46 Close Logical Channel +CCHC
Table 106: +CCHC parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CCHC=<sessionid> +CCHC ERROR: <err>
+CCHC=?

Description
This command asks the ME to close a communication session with the UICC. The ME shall close the previously
opened logical channel. The TE will no longer be able to send commands on this logical channel. The UICC will close
the logical channel when receiving this command. Refer subclause 9.2 for possible <err> values.
Defined values
<sessionid>:A session Id to be used in order to target a specific application on the smart card (e.g. (U)SIM,
WIM, ISIM) using logical channels mechanism (string without double quotes that represents a decimal value)
Implementation
Optional.
8.47 EAP authentication +CEAP
Table 107: +CEAP parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CEAP=<dfname>,
<EAPMethod>,
<EAP packet data>
[,<DFeap>]
+CEAP: <EAPsessionid>,
<EAP packet response>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CEAP=?

Description
This command allows a TE to exchange EAP packets with the UICC or the ME.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 115 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Prior to the execution of this command, the TE shall retrieve the available AIDs using the +CUAD command. The TE
shall select one appropriate AID to be addressed. Selection may include asking the user, and considering EAP methods
supported by the AIDs. The TE shall set the <dfname> value using the selected AID and shall set the
<EAPMethod> value to the requested EAP method. The TE may set the <DFeap> value to the directory file
identifier that is applicable to the <EAPMethod>; which is derived from the discretionary data returned by +CUAD.
The parameter is mandatory for EAP terminated in UICC.
If the targeted application on the UICC does support the requested EAP method, the MT shall use the value provided in
<DFeap>, and it shall transmit the <EAP packet data> to the UICC application using the Authenticate APDU
command as defined in ETSI TS 102 310 [66]. The appropriate DF
EAP
in the ADF must be selected prior to the
submission of an EAP Authenticate command with the <EAP packet data>. Then the EAP Response data sent by
the UICC application in its response to the Authenticate command shall be provided to the TE in <EAP packet
response>.
If the targeted application on the UICC does not support the requested EAP method and if the MT does support this
method then the <EAP packet data> shall be handled by the MT. During the handling of the EAP method, the MT
shall run the authentication algorithm on the SIM or USIM, respectively.
Also the MT has to allocate an <EAPsessionid> in order to identify an EAP session and its corresponding keys and
parameters.
If neither the MT nor the appropriate UICC application support the requested EAP method, the MT shall respond with
CME ERROR: 49 (EAP method not supported).
Refer subclause 9.2 for possible <err> values.
Defined values
<dfname>: string type in hexadecimal character format. All selectable applications are represented in the UICC
by an AID coded on 1 to 16 bytes.
<EAPMethod>: string type in hexadecimal character format. This is the EAP Method Type as defined in
RFC 3748 [68] in 1 byte format or 8 bytes expanded format. The v alue range for 1 byte format and for 8 bytes
expanded format is defined in RFC 3748 [68].
<EAP packet data>: string type in hexadecimal character format. This is the EAP packet data in hexadecimal
character as defined in ETSI TS 102 310 [66].
<DFeap>: string type in hexadecimal character format. Contains the DF(EAP) associated with the specified
<EAPMethod> on the SIM/UICC as defined in ETSI TS 102 310 [66] (e.g. "6D34").
<EAPsessionid>: integer type. This is the identifier of the EAP session to be used in order to retrieve the EAP
parameters with EAP Retreive Parameters +CERP command. Value range is from 1 to 4294967295.
<EAP packet response>: string type in hexadecimal character format. Defined in ETSI TS 102 310 [66].
Implementation
Optional.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 116 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
8.48 EAP Retrieve Parameters +CERP
Table 108: +CERP parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CERP=<EAPsessionid>,<
EAPparameter>
+CERP: <EAP parameter
response>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CERP=?

Description
This command allows a TE to retrieve EAP session parameters / derived keys after a run of the +CEAP command. If
the EAP session is handled by the UICC then the MT shall return the content of the elementary file corresponding to the
indicated <EAPparameter>. Those EFs are defined in ETSI TS 102 310 [66].
If the MT handles the EAP session then the MT shall return the corresponding parameter encoded as defined for EAP
files, see ETSI TS 102 310 [66].
For example, the keys shall be retrieved in the TLV format described in ETSI TS 102 310 [66].
If neither the MT nor the appropriate UICC application can provide the requested information (e.g. because the
requested EAP session ID does not exist), the MT shall respond with CME ERROR: 50 (Incorrect parameters).
Refer subclause 9.2 for possible <err> values.
Defined values
<EAPparameter>: integer type.
1 Keys
2 Status
3 Identity
4 Pseudonym
<EAPsessionid>: integer type; this is the identifier of the EAP session to be used in order to retrieve the EAP
parameters corresponding to an active EAP session. Value range is from 1 to 4294967295.
<EAP parameter response>: string type in hexadecimal character format. The format of the parameter is
defined in ETSI TS 102 310 [66]. The <EAP parameter response> depends on the value of the
<EAPparameter>.
Implementation
Optional.
8.49 UICC Application Discovery +CUAD
Table 109: +CUAD parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CUAD +CUAD: <response>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CUAD=?

Description

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 117 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
This command asks the MT to discover what applications are available for selection on the UICC. According to TS
102.221 [60], the ME shall access and read the EF
DIR
file in the UICC and return the values that are stored in its records.
Each record contains the AID and optionally application parameters of one of the applications available on the UICC.
Refer subclause 9.2 for possible <err> values.
Defined values
<response>: string type in hexadecimal character format. The response is the content of the EF
DIR
.
Implementation
Optional.
8.50 Mobile Originated GPS Location Request +CMOLRG
Table 109a: CMOLRG action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CMOLRG=<enable>[,<method>[,<hor-acc-
set>[,<hor-acc>[,<ver-req>[,<ver-acc-
set>[,<ver-acc>[,<vel-req>[,<rep-
mode>[,<timeout>[,<interval>[,<shape-
rep>]]]]]]]]]]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CMOLRG? +CMOLRG: <enable>,<method>,<hor-acc-
set>,[<hor-acc>],<ver-req>,[<ver-acc-
set>],[<ver-acc>],<vel-req>,<rep-
mode>,<timeout>,[<interval>],<shape-
rep>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CMOLRG=? +CMOLRG: (list of supported <enable>s), (list of
supported <method>s), (list of supported <hor-acc-
set>s), (list of supported <hor-acc>s), (list of
supported <ver-req>s), (list of supported <ver-
acc-set>s), (list of supported <ver-acc>s), (list of
supported <vel-req>s), (list of supported <rep-
mode>s), (list of supported <timeout>s), (list of
supported <interval>s), (list of supported <shape-
rep>s)

Description

Set command initiates a mobile originated location request for GPS. The parameter <enable> enables or disables
positioning and reporting by unsolicited result codes. Reporting can be performed in the format of GAD shapes
<location_parameters> or in the format of NMEA strings <NMEA-string> or both. Unassisted or assisted
GPS is decided by the parameter <method>. The parameters <hor-acc-set>, <hor-acc>, <ver-req>, <ver-
acc-set>, <ver-acc> and <vel-req> indicate accuracy for the GPS location request. The parameter
<timeout> indicates how long the MS will wait for a response before an unsolicited result code is provided. A single
report or periodic reports can be requested by the parameter <rep-mode>. If periodic reports are requested, the time
interval between the reports is specified by the parameter <interval>. If GAD shapes are requested, the GAD
shapes that will be accepted in the unsolicited result code <location_parameters> are defined by the parameter
<shape-rep>. Additional information about positioning can be found in 3GPP TS 25.305 [78]. If positioning -data
cannot be provided at a timeout, the unsolicited result +CMOLRGE is provided. Refer to subclause 9.2 for possible
<err> values.
Read command returns the current settings of the parameters <enable>, <method>, <hor-acc-set>, <hor-
acc>, <ver-req>, <ver-acc-set>, <ver-acc>, <vel-req>, <rep-mode>, <timeout>, , <interval>,

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 118 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
and <shape-rep>. The parameters <hor-acc>, <ver-acc-set> and <ver-acc> are only applicable in certain
configurations. The parameter <interval> is only applicable if periodic reporting is specified.
Test command returns the supported values and ranges.
Defined values

<enable>: integer type. Enables and disables a mobile originated location request for GPS. Only one <method>
can be enabled at any given time.
0 Disables reporting and positioning.
1 Enables reporting of NMEA strings by unsolicited result code +CMOLRGN: <NMEA-string>.
Lack of data at each timeout is indicated by an unsolicited result code +CMOLRGE.
2 Enables reporting of GAD shapes by unsolicited result code +CMOLRGG: <location_parameters>.
Lack of data at each timeout is indicated by an unsolicited result code +CMOLRGE.
3 Enables reporting of NMEA strings and GAD shapes by unsolicited result codes
+CMOLRGG: <location_parameters> and +CMOLRGN: <NMEA-string>.
Lack of data at each timeout is indicated by an unsolicited result code +CMOLRGE.
<method>: integer type. Method for mobile originated location requests for GPS. The default value is
implementation specific.
0 Unassisted GPS. Autonomous GPS -only, no use of assistance data.
1 Assisted GPS (see NOTE).
2 Assisted GANSS (see NOTE).
3 Assisted GPS and GANSS (see NOTE).
NOTE: For the methods that require assistance data, the assistance data obtained from the network is used for a
UE-based GPS location procedure.
<hor-acc-set>: integer type. The default value is implementation specific.
0 Horisontal accuracy not set/specified.
1 Horizontal accuracy set in parameter <hor-acc>.
<hor-acc>: integer type. Requested accuracy as horizontal uncertainty exponent (refer to 3GPP TS 23.032 [76]
subclause 6.2). The value range is 0-127. The default value is implementation specific.
<ver-req>: integer type. The default value is implementation specific.
0 Vertical coordinate (altitude) is not requested, 2D location fix is acceptable. The parameters <ver-acc-set>
and <ver-acc> do not apply.
1 Vertical coordinate (altitude) is requested, 3D location fix is required.
<ver-acc-set>: integer type. The default value is implementation specific.
0 Vertical accuracy not set/specified.
1 Vertical accuracy set/specified in parameter <ver-acc>.
<ver-acc>: integer type. Requested accuracy as vertical uncertainty exponent (refer to 3GPP TS 23.032 [76]
subclause 6.4). The value range is 0-127. The default value is implementation specific.
<vel-req>: integer type. Requested velocity type (refer to 3GPP TS 23.032 [76] subclause 8.6). The default value
is implementation specific.
0 Velocity not requested.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 119 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
1 Horizontal velocity requested.
2 Horizontal velocity and vertical velocity requested.
3 Horizontal velocity with uncertainty requested.
4 Horizontal velocity with uncertainty and vertical velocity with uncertainty requested.
<rep-mode>: integer type. Reporting mode. The default value is implementation specific.
0 Single report, the timeout for the GPS request is specified by <timeout>.
1 Periodic reporting, the timeout for each GPS request is specified by <timeout> and the interval between each
GPS request is specified by <interval>.
<timeout>: integer type. Indicates how long the MS will wait for a response after a GPS request. The value range
is in seconds from 1 to 65535. The default value is implementation specific.
<interval>: integer type. The parameter is applicable to periodic reporting only. Determines the interval
between periodic GPS requests. The value range is in seconds from 1 to 65535, and must be greater than or equal
to timeout. The default value is implementation specific.
<shape-rep>: integer type. This parameter is a sum of integers each representing a certain GAD shape that will
be accepted in the unsolicited result code <location_parameters>. Note that only one GAD shape is
present per unsolicited result code. The default value is implementation specific.
1 Ellipsoid point.
2 Ellipsoid point with uncertainty circle.
4 Ellipsoid point with uncertainty ellipse.
8 Polygon.
16 Ellipsoid point with altitude.
32 Ellipsoid point with altitude and uncertainty ellipsoid.
64 Ellipsoid arc.
<location_parameters>: string type in UTF-8. This parameter provides an XML-formatted string of GAD-
shape positioning data as defined in Table 109b. This parameter shall not be subject to conventional character
conversion as per +CSCS.
Table 109b: XML Schema for <location_parameters>
<?xml version="1.0" ?>
<!DOCTYPE location_parameters [
<!ELEMENT location_parameters (time?,direction?,shape,shape_data,velocity?)>
<!ELEMENT time (#PCDATA)>
<!ELEMENT direction (#PCDATA)>
<!ELEMENT shape (#PCDATA)>
<!ELEMENT shape_data
(ellipsoid_point|ellipsoid_point_uncert_circle|ellipsoid_point_uncert_ellips
e|polygon|ellipsoid_point_alt|ellipsoid_point_alt_uncertellipse|ellips_arc)>
<!ELEMENT ellipsoid_point (coordinate)>
<!ELEMENT coordinate (latitude,longitude)>
<!ELEMENT latitude (north,degrees)>
<!ELEMENT north (#PCDATA)>
<!ELEMENT degrees (#PCDATA)>
<!ELEMENT longitude (#PCDATA)>
<!ELEMENT ellipsoid_point_uncert_circle (coordinate,uncert_circle)>
<!ELEMENT uncert_circle (#PCDATA)>
<!ELEMENT ellipsoid_point_uncert_ellipse (coordinate,uncert_ellipse)>

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 120 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
<!ELEMENT uncert_ellipse (uncert_semi_major,uncert_semi_minor,
orient_major,confidence)>
<!ELEMENT uncert_semi_major (#PCDATA)>
<!ELEMENT uncert_semi_minor (#PCDATA)>
<!ELEMENT orient_major (#PCDATA)>
<!ELEMENT confidence (#PCDATA)>
<!ELEMENT polygon (coordinate,polygon_points)>
<!ELEMENT polygon_points (#PCDATA)>
<!ELEMENT ellipsoid_point_alt (coordinate,altitude)>
<!ELEMENT altitude (height_above_surface,height)>
<!ELEMENT ellipsoid_point_alt_uncertellipse
(coordinate,altitude,uncert_semi_major,uncert_semi_minor,orient_major,con
fidence,uncert_alt)>
<!ELEMENT uncert_alt (#PCDATA)>
<!ELEMENT ellips_arc
(coordinate,inner_rad,uncert_rad,offset_angle,included_angle,confidence)>
<!ELEMENT inner_rad (#PCDATA)>
<!ELEMENT uncert_rad (#PCDATA)>
<!ELEMENT offset_angle (#PCDATA)>
<!ELEMENT included_angle (#PCDATA)>
<!ELEMENT confidence (#PCDATA)>
]>

<NMEA-string>: string type in UTF-8. This parameter provides NMEA-strings as defined in IEC 61162 [78].
This parameter shall not be subject to conventional character conversion as per +CSCS.
Example: +CMOLRGN: '$GPRMC,235947.000,V,0000.0000,N,00000.0000,E,,,041299,,*1D<CR><LF>&'
Implementation
Optional.
8.51 Informative examples
Phone Activity Status (+CPAS) is a general command used to detect the presence of the MT, if there is an incoming
call, or if there is a call in progress. This command should be used before trying to operate the MT from the TE. Note
that the activity status may change at any time after the execution of +CPAS, and hence the returned value may be
obsolete. Detachment of the MT from the TA is indicated with a special final result code that indicates all errors related
to the operation of the MT. Result code is +CME ERROR: <err>, where <err> is an integer or verbose value giving
useful information about the reason for the command failure (refer subclause "Mobile Termination error result code
+CME ERROR").
Set Phone Functionality (+CFUN) can be used to reset the MT or set the power consumption level of the MT by
disabling certain parts of the MT (e.g. the transmit and receive RF circuits). Mobile Termination Control Mode
(+CMEC) is a command which manages access sharing between the MT and the TE to operate the user interface of the
MT. It has three subparameters which describe the access to keypad, display and indicators. Each subparameter has
values for restricting the operation of the corresponding user interface part only to the MT or only to the TE, or to give
the access for both of them.
Keypad Control command (+CKPD) is used to operate the keypad of the MT. Here lies the problem of different keypad
types between manufacturers, and also between their MT models. The keypresses are sent to the MT as a string type
subparameter of this command. Each character in that string represents a key which will be logically pressed. A special
character (colon) followed by any character can be used by manufacturers (or TE application programmers) to represent
a key which is not defined in this profile. An escape character (semicolon) for direct string entering is also defined. All
text between single semicolon characters is treated as an alphanumeric entry and is not converted to keypressings. All
semicolon characters inside the text shall be duplicated in the TE and stripped back to one before entering them to the
MT. Command has also optional second and third parameters which can be used to alter the time to strike each key, and
the pause to wait between keystrokes (in tenths of a second). A special pause character (W or w) may be added in the
string type subparameter for an extra pause of the same length as given by the third subparameter. In the following
example alphanumeric mode is entered and a person predefined in the MT phonebook, "Ilkka", is called; each key is
struck for half a second and pauses between strokes are a tenth of a second:

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 121 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
AT+CKPD="@:Ilkka:S",5,1
OK

Display Control command (+CDIS) is used both for writing to the display text fields and for reading the current status
of the fields. Mobile termination usually have a character set of their own, so the TA shall be able to do a conversion
between the TE and the MT character sets. TE can have several character sets and the TA must be informed of the
character set in use before starting to write or read the display. Character set is set with general command Select TE
Character Set +CSCS. The +CDIS=? query command is a way to get information about the length of the fields. In the
following example an MT is first queried about the supported conversions and the lengths of the fields. The response
shows there are three ten character long and two six character long fields. Then the TE character set is set to be IRA and
the current status of the display is read. The last command writes the text "Hello, I'm writing to display" in the three
fields, and keeps the contents of the two other fields same (the last two commas could also be left out).
AT+CSCS=?;+CDIS=?
+CSCS: ("IRA","PCCP850","8859-1")
+CDIS: 10,10,10,6,6
OK
AT+CSCS="IRA"
OK
AT+CDIS?
+CDIS: "RADIOLINJA","","","Menu","Memory"
OK
AT+CDIS="IRA","Hello, I'm","writing to","display",,
OK

The writing is possible only when it is permitted by the Mobile Termination Control Mode command (and by the
manufacturer). If a certain field is not writable (but is readable), writing to it should be ignored. The order of the text
fields should be determined by manufacturers and follow the rule: first field is in the upper left corner, second in the
next field to the right, and so on, until to the last field in the lower right corner.
Indicators can be handled with Indicator Control command (+CIND). Its query command returns a short description
(abbreviation) of the purpose of the indicators and the supported values for each indicator. The setting and reading is
done similarly as with Display Control command. In the following example the indicators of a phone are queried, their
current value is read, and the value of message indicator is tried to set (but it is forbidden):.
AT+CIND=?
+CIND: ("memory",(0-2)),("call",(0,1)),("data",(0,1)),("roam",(0,1)),
("alpha",(0,1)),("message",(0,1)),("index1",(0-11)),("index2",(0-11)),
("index3",(0-11)),("signal",(0-5)),("service",(0,1)),("sel1",(0,1)),
("sel2",(0,1)),("sel3",(0,1)),("battchg",(0-5))
OK
AT+CIND?
+CIND: 1,0,0,0,0,1,0,0,0,3,1,0,0,0,5
OK
AT+CIND=,,,,,0
+CME ERROR: 10

The subparameter order in the command is defined by the query command order, not by the actual display order. The
zero value of an indicator means that it is off (or in state which can be identified as "off"-state), value one means that
the indicator is on (or in a state which is more substantial than "off"-state), value two is more substantial than one, and
so on.
To this point, only operating through the TE is covered. But when MT can be operated also through its keypad, or there
are changes in the status of the display elements, the information about these actions shall be given to the TE also. This
can be solved only with unsolicited result codes which return keypad, display text and indicator events. Each event
group has a result code of its own: +CKEV returns the key code and if the key pressed (1) or released (0), +CDEV
returns the display text field running number (as specified by command +CDIS) and the new status of the field, and
+CIEV returns the running number of the indicator (refer +CIND) and the new value of it. In the following example
number key 1 is pressed, updated on the display, released, and signal strength changes its state to five:
+CKEV: 49,1
+CDEV: 1,"1"
+CKEV: 49,0
+CIND: 10,5


ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 122 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Mobile Termination Event Reporting command (+CMER) has been specified for the purpose of controlling the sending
of these unsolicited result codes to the TE. Four ways are provided to handle the buffering of the result codes (see
figure 8). The first is to buffer them always. The second possibility is to discard them when in on-line data mode and
otherwise forward them directly to the TE. The third possibility is to buffer them in data mode and otherwise forward
them to the TE. The last possibility is to send them always to the TE (some inband technique - e.g. V.80 - shall be used
in data mode to send the result codes within the data). This is the first subparameter of +CMER command. Next three
subparameters are used to enable or disable each of the keypad, text field and indicator result codes. Sending codes can
be enabled either so that only events generated from the MT user interface are returned, or so that also events caused by
Keypad, Display and Indicator Control commands are returned. The fifth subparameter controls the flushing of the
buffer when the value of the first subparameter is changed to a value from one to three.
COMMAND
MODE
DATA MODE
Buffer
TE
MT
TA
MT events (inband)
0
1
2
3
+CMER first
subparameter

Figure 8: Mobile termination event reporting
An example of complete setup of the TA where TE takes the control of keypad, but does not want to write to display
nor control the indicators (in the start MT is powered off):
AT+CMEE=2;+CREG=1 (use verbose <err> values; report registration)
OK
AT+CPAS (query MT status)
+CPAS: 5 (MT is asleep)
OK
AT+CFUN=1 (set MT to full functionality state)
+CME ERROR: SIM PIN required (SIM requests PIN)
AT+CPIN="1234"
+CME ERROR: incorrect password (user entered wrong PIN)
AT+CPIN="4321"
OK (correct PIN)
AT+COPS=0,0 (ask for automatic operator selection and registration)
OK
+CREG: 1 (registered in the network)
AT+COPS?
+COPS: 0,0,"RADIOLINJA" (get the operator name)
OK
AT+CMEC=1,0,0 (take over the keypad, leave display to MT)
OK
AT+CDIS=?;+CIND=? (query display text and indicator formats)
+CDIS: 10,10,10,6,6
+CIND: ("memory",(0-2)),("call",(0,1)),("data",(0,1)),("roam",(0,1)),
("alpha",(0,1)),("message",(0,1)),("index1",(0-11)),("index2",(0-11)),
("index3",(0-11)),("signal",(0-5)),("service",(0,1)),("sel1",(0,1)),
("sel2",(0,1)),("sel3",(0,1)),("battchg",(0-5))
OK
AT+CSCS="IRA" (set TE character set for display text results)
OK
AT+CMER=1,0,2,2,0 (return display text and indicator result codes when
OK in command state, in data mode discard them)
AT+CDIS?;+CIND? (read current state of display texts and indicators)
+CDIS: "",""," 12345","Menu","Memory" (user had pressed number buttons before

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 123 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
+CIND: 1,0,0,0,0,1,0,0,0,3,1,0,0,0,5 TE took control with +CMEC)
OK
AT+CKPD="C",20 (clear main display text '12345' by holding the
OK 'clear' button down two seconds)
+CDEV: 3,"1234" (first only one character deleted)
+CDEV: 3,"" (while holding continues, whole display is cleared)
+CDEV: 1,"RADIOLINJA" (operator name comes to the display)

The start of the previous example could go as follows when MT has already been powered on but is waiting for the
PIN:
AT+CMEE=2;+CREG=1 (use verbose <err> values; report registration)
OK
AT+CPAS (query MT status)
+CPAS: 0 (MT is ready to receive commands)
OK
AT+CPIN? (is MT asking passwords?)
+CPIN: SIM PIN (yes, SIM PIN required)
AT+CPIN="4321"
OK (correct PIN)

One of the most regular operations done through the MT user interface is phonebook control. To lessen the workload of
the TE, some direct commands for phonebook reading and writing are practical. Command Select Phonebook Memory
Storage +CPBS query version returns supported phonebook memories, read version returns current settings, and set
version selects the memory. For GSM, the normal storages are SIM, MT and TA.
Read Phonebook Entries (+CPBR) can be used to read either one or many phonebook locations at the same time. A
regular phonebook entry consists of three elements: memory index number, the phone number and its alphanumeric
equivalent given by the user. Query version of this returns supported index values of the selected memory, and the
maximum lengths of the number and alphanumeric elements. The query version of the Write Phonebook Entry
command (+CPBW) is similar, but the action version sets or clears an entry in the phonebook. Find Phonebook Entries
(+CPBF) may be used to search alphanumeric entries starting with specific string. An example where the whole
phonebook of the MT is read, index number four is cleared, and number three is written:
AT+CPBS=?
+CPBS: ("ME","SM") (MT and SIM have phonebooks)
OK
AT+CPBS="ME" (select MT memory)
OK
AT+CPBR=? (read index range and element lengths)
+CPBR: (1-99),30,30
OK
AT+CPBR=1,99 (read all entries but only the ones set are returned)
+CPBR: 1,"931123456",129,"Ilkka"
+CPBR: 2,"9501234567",129,""
+CPBR: 4,"901234567",129,"Hesari"
OK
AT+CPBW=4;+CPBW=3,"921123456",,"TS" (clear index 4 and write index 3)
OK
9 Mobile Termination errors
9.1 Report Mobile Termination error +CMEE
Table 110: +CMEE parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CMEE=[<n>]
+CMEE? +CMEE: <n>
+CMEE=?
+CMEE: (list of supported <n>s)


ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 124 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Description
Set command disables or enables the use of result code +CME ERROR: <err> as an indication of an error relating to
the functionality of the MT. When enabled, MT related errors cause +CME ERROR: <err> final result code instead
of the regular ERROR final result code. ERROR is returned normally when error is related to syntax, invalid parameters,
or TA functionality.
Test command returns values supported as a compound value.
Defined values
<n>:
0 disable +CME ERROR: <err> result code and use ERROR instead
1 enable +CME ERROR: <err> result code and use numeric <err> values (refer next subclause)
2 enable +CME ERROR: <err> result code and use verbose <err> values (refer next subclause)
Implementation
Mandatory for <n> values 0 and 1.
9.2 Mobile Termination error result code +CME ERROR
The operation of +CME ERROR: <err> result code is similar to the regular ERROR result code: if +CME ERROR:
<err> is the result code for any of the commands in a command line, none of the following commands in the same
command line is executed (neither ERROR nor OK result code shall be returned as a result of a completed command line
execution). The format of <err> can be either numeric or verbose. This is set with command +CMEE (refer previous
subclause).
NOTE: ITU-T V.250 [14] command V does not affect the format of this result code.
<err> values (numeric format followed by verbose format):
9.2.1 General errors
0 phone failure
1 no connection to phone
2 phone-adaptor link reserved
3 operation not allowed
4 operation not supported
5 PH-SIM PIN required
6 PH-FSIM PIN required
7 PH-FSIM PUK required
10 SIM not inserted (Note)
11 SIM PIN required
12 SIM PUK required
13 SIM failure (Note)
14 SIM busy (Note)
15 SIM wrong (Note)

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 125 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
16 incorrect password
17 SIM PIN2 required
18 SIM PUK2 required
20 memory full
21 invalid index
22 not found
23 memory failure
24 text string too long
25 invalid characters in text string
26 dial string too long
27 invalid characters in dial string
30 no network service
31 network timeout
32 network not allowed - emergency calls only
40 network personalization PIN required
41 network personalization PUK required
42 network subset personalization PIN required
43 network subset personalization PUK required
44 service provider personalization PIN required
45 service provider personalization PUK required
46 corporate personalization PIN required
47 corporate personalization PUK required
48 hidden key required (NOTE: This key is required when accessing hidden phonebook entries.)
49 EAP method not supported
50 Incorrect parameters
100 unknown
NOTE: This error code is also applicable to UICC.

9.2.2 GPRS-related errors
9.2.2.1 Errors related to a failure to perform an Attach
Numeric Text
103 Illegal MS (#3)
106 Illegal ME (#6)
107 GPRS services not allowed (#7)
111 PLMN not allowed (#11)

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 126 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
112 Location area not allowed (#12)
113 Roaming not allowed in this location area (#13)
(Values in parentheses are TS 24.008 cause codes.)
9.2.2.2 Errors related to a failure to Activate a Context
Numeric Text
132 service option not supported (#32)
133 requested service option not subscribed (#33)
134 service option temporarily out of order (#34)
149 PDP authentication failure
(Values in parentheses are TS 24.008 cause codes.)
9.2.2.3 Other GPRS errors
Numeric Text
150 invalid mobile class
148 unspecified GPRS error
Other values in the range 101 - 150 are reserved for use by GPRS
9.2.3 VBS / VGCS and eMLPP -related errors
Numeric Text
151 VBS/VGCS not supported by the network
152 No service subscription on SIM
153 No subscription for group ID
154 Group Id not activated on SIM
155 No matching notification
156 VBS/VGCS call already present
157 Congestion
158 Network failure
159 Uplink busy
160 No access rights for SIM file
161 No subscription for priority
162 operation not applicable or not possible

Other values in the range 151 - 170 are reserved for use by VBS/VGCS and eMLPP
Also all other values below 256 are reserved
Implementation
Mandatory for numeric format codes applicable to implemented command set.

9.3 Informative examples
An example of TA responses with all three +CMEE values when MT manufacturer identification is requested but MT is
not connected to the TA:
AT+CMEE=0 (+CME ERROR shall not be used)
OK
AT+CGMI
ERROR
AT+CMEE=1 (use numeric <err>)

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 127 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
OK
AT+CGMI
+CME ERROR: 1
AT+CMEE=2 (use verbose <err>)
OK
AT+CGMI
+CME ERROR: no connection to phone

10 Commands for Packet Domain
This clause defines commands that a TE may use to control a MT supporting packet switched services. Other aspects of
a Packet Domain MT are described in 3GPP TS 27.060 [34].
It is anticipated that Packet Domain MTs will vary widely in functionality. At one extreme, a MT supporting CS/PS or
class-A mode of operation might support multiple PDP types as well as circuit switched data, and use multiple external
networks and QoS profiles. At the other extreme a MT supporting only PS or class-C mode of operation might support
only a single PDP type using a single external network, and rely on the HLR to contain the PDP context definition.
A comprehensive set of Packet Domain-specifc commands is defined in clause 10.1 to provide the flexibility needed by
the more complex MT. The commands are designed to be expandable to accommodate new PDP types and interface
protocols, merely by defining new values for many of the parameters. Multiple contexts may be activated if the
interface link-layer protocol is able to support them. The commands use the extended information and error message
capabilities described in this specification.
For MTs of intermediate complexity, most commands have simplified forms where certain parameters may be omitted.
For the simplest MTs, and for backwards compatibility with existing communications software, it is possible to control
access to the Packet Domain using existing modem-compatible commands. A special dial-string syntax is defined for
use with the D command. This "modem compatible" mode of operation is described in subclause 10.2.
A discussion on the interaction of the AT commands, Packet Domain Management and Packet Data Protocols, together
with examples of command sequences for a number of applications may be found in 3GPP TS 27.060 [34].
10.1 Commands specific to MTs supporting the Packet Domain
10.1.1 Define PDP Context +CGDCONT
Table 111: +CGDCONT parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CGDCONT=[<cid> [,<PDP_type> [,<APN>
[,<PDP_addr> [,<d_comp> [,<h_comp>
[,<pd1> [,[,pdN]]]]]]]]]
OK
ERROR
+CGDCONT? +CGDCONT: <cid>, <PDP_type>,
<APN>,<PDP_addr>, <d_comp>,
<h_comp>[,<pd1>[,[,pdN]]]
[<CR><LF>+CGDCONT: <cid>, <PDP_type>,
<APN>,<PDP_addr>, <d_comp>,
<h_comp>[,<pd1>[,[,pdN]]]
[...]]
+CGDCONT=? +CGDCONT: (range of supported <cid>s),
<PDP_type>,,,(list of supported <d_comp>s),
(list of supported <h_comp>s)[,(list of supported
<pd1>s)[,[,(list of supported <pdN>s)]]]
[<CR><LF>+CGDCONT: (range of supported <cid>s),
<PDP_type>,,,(list of supported <d_comp>s),
(list of supported <h_comp>s)[,(list of supported
<pd1>s)[,[,(list of supported <pdN>s)]]]
[...]]

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 128 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8

Description
The set command specifies PDP context parameter values for a PDP context identified by the (local) context
identification parameter, <cid>. The number of PDP contexts that may be in a defined state at the same time is given
by the range returned by the test command.
A special form of the set command, +CGDCONT= <cid> causes the values for context number <cid> to become
undefined.
The read command returns the current settings for each defined context.
The test command returns values supported as a compound value. If the MT supports several PDP types,
<PDP_type>, the parameter value ranges for each <PDP_type> are returned on a separate line.
Defined values
<cid>: (PDP Context Identifier) a numeric parameter which specifies a particular PDP context definition. The
parameter is local to the TE-MT interface and is used in other PDP context-related commands. The range of
permitted values (minimum value = 1) is returned by the test form of the command.
<PDP_type>: (Packet Data Protocol type) a string parameter which specifies the type of packet data protocol
X.25 ITU-T/CCITT X.25 layer 3 (Obsolete)
IP Internet Protocol (IETF STD 5)
IPV6 Internet Protocol, version 6 (IETF RFC 2460)
OSPIH Internet Hosted Octect Stream Protocol (Obsolete)
PPP Point to Point Protocol (IETF STD 51)
<APN>: (Access Point Name) a string parameter which is a logical name that is used to select the GGSN or the
external packet data network.
If the value is null or omitted, then the subscription value will be requested.
<PDP_address>: a string parameter that identifies the MT in the address space applicable to the PDP.
If the value is null or omitted, then a value may be provided by the TE during the PDP startup procedure or,
failing that, a dynamic address will be requested.
The read form of the command will continue to return the null string even if an address has been allocated during
the PDP startup procedure. The allocated address may be read using the +CGPADDR command.
<d_comp>: a numeric parameter that controls PDP data compression (applicable for SNDCP only) (refer 3GPP TS
44.065 [61])
0 - off (default if value is omitted)
1 - on (manufacturer preferred compression)
2 - V.42bis
3 - V.44
Other values are reserved.
<h_comp>: a numeric parameter that controls PDP header compression (refer 3GPP TS 44.065 [61] and 3GPP TS
25.323 [62])
0 - off (default if value is omitted)
1 - on (manufacturer preferred compression)
2 - RFC1144 (applicable for SNDCP only)
3 - RFC2507
4 - RFC3095 (applicable for PDCP only)
Other values are reserved.
<pd1>, <pdN>: zero to N string parameters whose meanings are specific to the <PDP_type>
Implementation
Mandatory unless only a single subscribed context is supported.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 129 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
10.1.2 Define Secondary PDP Context +CGDSCONT
Table 112: +CGDSCONT parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CGDSCONT=[<cid> ,<p_cid> [,<d_comp>
[,<h_comp>]]]
OK
ERROR
+CGDSCONT? +CGDSCONT: <cid>, <p_cid>, <d_comp>,
<h_comp>
[<CR><LF>+CGDSCONT: <cid>, <p_cid>,
<d_comp>, <h_comp>
[...]]
+CGDSCONT=? +CGDSCONT: (range of supported <cid>s),
(list of <cid>s for active primary
contexts), (list of supported
<d_comp>s),
(list of supported <h_comp>s)


Description
The set command specifies PDP context parameter values for a Secondary PDP context identified by the (local) context
identification parameter, <cid>. The number of PDP contexts that may be in a defined state at the same time is given
by the range returned by the test command.
A special form of the set command, +CGDSCONT= <cid> causes the values for context number <cid> to become
undefined.
The read command returns the current settings for each defined context.
Defined values
<cid>: (PDP Context Identifier) a numeric parameter which specifies a particular PDP context definition. The
parameter is local to the TE-MT interface and is used in other PDP context-related commands. The range of
permitted values (minimum value = 1) is returned by the test form of the command.
<p_cid>: (Primary PDP Context Identifier) a numeric parameter which specifies a particular PDP context
definition which has been specified by use of the +CGDCONT command. The parameter is local to the TE-MT
interface. The list of permitted values is returned by the test form of the command.
<d_comp>: a numeric parameter that controls PDP data compression (applicable for SNDCPonly) (refer 3GPP TS
44.065 [61])
0 - off (default if value is omitted)
1 - on (manufacturer preferred compression)
2 - V.42bis
3 - V.44
Other values are reserved.
<h_comp>: a numeric parameter that controls PDP header compression (refer 3GPP TS 44.065 [61] and 3GPP TS
25.323 [62])
0 - off (default if value is omitted)
1 - on (manufacturer preferred compression)
2 - RFC1144 (applicable for SNDCP only)
3 - RFC2507
4 - RFC3095 (applicable for PDCP only)
Other values are reserved.
Implementation
Optional.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 130 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
10.1.3 Traffic Flow Template +CGTFT
Table 113: +CGTFT parameter command syntax
Command Possible Response(s)
+CGTFT=[<cid>, [<packet filter
identifier>, <evaluation precedence
index> [,<source address and subnet
mask> [,<protocol number (ipv4) / next
header (ipv6)> [,<destination port
range> [,<source port range> [,<ipsec
security parameter index (spi)> [,<type
of service (tos) (ipv4) and mask /
traffic class (ipv6) and mask> [,<flow
label (ipv6)> ]]]]]]]]]
OK
ERROR
+CGTFT? +CGTFT: <cid>, <packet filter
identifier>, <evaluation precedence
index>, <source address and subnet
mask>, <protocol number (ipv4) / next
header (ipv6)>, <destination port
range>, <source port range>, <ipsec
security parameter index (spi)>, <type
of service (tos) (ipv4) and mask /
traffic class (ipv6) and mask>, <flow
label (ipv6)>
[<CR><LF>+CGTFT: <cid>, <packet filter
identifier>, <evaluation precedence
index>, <source address and subnet
mask>, <protocol number (ipv4) / next
header (ipv6)>, <destination port
range>, <source port range>, <ipsec
security parameter index (spi)>, <type
of service (tos) (ipv4) and mask /
traffic class (ipv6) and mask>, <flow
label (ipv6)>
[]]

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 131 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Command Possible Response(s)
+CGTFT=? +CGTFT: <PDP_type>, (list of supported
<packet filter identifier>s), (list of
supported <evaluation precedence
index>s), (list of supported <source
address and subnet mask>s), (list of
supported <protocol number (ipv4) /
next header (ipv6)>s), (list of
supported <destination port range>s),
(list of supported <source port
range>s), (list of supported <ipsec
security parameter index (spi)>s),
(list of supported <type of service
(tos) (ipv4) and mask / traffic class
(ipv6) and mask>s), (list of supported
<flow label (ipv6)>s)
[<CR><LF>+CGTFT: <PDP_type>, (list of
supported <packet filter identifier>s),
(list of supported <evaluation
precedence index>s), (list of supported
<source address and subnet mask>s),
(list of supported <protocol number
(ipv4) / next header (ipv6)>s), (list
of supported <destination port
range>s), (list of supported <source
port range>s), (list of supported
<ipsec security parameter index
(spi)>s), (list of supported <type of
service (tos) (ipv4) and mask / traffic
class (ipv6) and mask>s), (list of
supported <flow label (ipv6)>s)
[]]

Description
This command allows the TE to specify a Packet Filter - PF for a Traffic Flow Template - TFT that is used in the
GGSN for routing of down-link packets onto different QoS flows towards the TE. The concept is further described in
the 3GPP TS 23.060[47]. A TFT consists of from one and up to eight Packet Filters, each identified by a unique
<packet filter identifier>. A Packet Filter also has an <evaluation precedence index> that is
unique within all TFTs associated with all PDP contexts that are associated with the same PDP address.
The set command specifies a Packet Filters that is to be added to the TFT stored in the MT and used for the context
identified by the (local) context identification parameter, <cid>. The specified TFT will be stored in the GGSN only at
activation or MS-initiated modification of the related context. Since this is the same parameter that is used in the
+CGDCONT and +CGDSCONT commands, the +CGTFT command is effectively an extension to these commands.
The Packet Filters consist of a number of parameters, each of which may be set to a separate value.
A special form of the set command, +CGTFT= <cid> causes all of the Packet Filters in the TFT for context number
<cid> to become undefined. At any time there may exist only one PDP context with no associated TFT amongst all
PDP contexts associated to one PDP address. At an attempt to delete a TFT, which would violate this rule, an ERROR
or +CME ERROR response is returned. Extended error responses are enabled by the +CMEE command.
The read command returns the current settings for all Packet Filters for each defined context.
The test command returns values supported as a compound value. If the MT supports several PDP types, the parameter
value ranges for each PDP type are returned on a separate line. TFTs shall be used for PDP-type IP and PPP only. For
PDP-type PPP a TFT is applicable only when IP traffic is carried over PPP. If PPP carries header-compressed IP
packets, then a TFT cannot be used.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 132 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Defined values
<cid>: a numeric parameter which specifies a particular PDP context definition (see the +CGDCONT and
+CGDSCONT commands).
The following parameters are defined in 3GPP TS 23.060[47] -
<packet filter identifier>: Numeric parameter, value range from 1 to 8.
<source address and subnet mask>: Consists of dot-separated numeric (0-255) parameters on the form
'a1.a2.a3.a4.m1.m2.m3.m4', for IPv4 and
'a1.a2.a3.a4.a5.a6.a7.a8.a9.a10.a11.a12.a13.a14.a15.a16.
m1.m2.m3.m4.m5.m6.m7.m8.m9.m10.m11.m12.m13.m14.m15.m16', for IPv6.
<protocol number (ipv4) / next header (ipv6)>: Numeric parameter, value range from 0 to 255.
<destination port range>: Consists of dot-separated numeric (0-65535) parameters on the form 'f.t'.
<source port range>:Consists of dot-separated numeric (0-65535) parameters on the form 'f.t'.
<ipsec security parameter index (spi)>: Hexadecimal parameter,
value range from 00000000 to FFFFFFFF.
<type of service (tos) (ipv4) and mask / traffic class (ipv6) and mask>:
Dot-separated numeric (0-255) parameters on the form 't.m'.
<flow label (ipv6)>: Hexadecimal parameter, value range from 00000 to FFFFF. Valid for IPv6 only.
<evaluation precedence index>: Numeric parameter, value range from 0 to 255.
Some of the above listed attributes may coexist in a Packet Filter while others mutually exclude each other, the possible
combinations are shown in 3GPP TS 23.060[47].
Implementation
Optional.
10.1.4 Quality of Service Profile (Requested) +CGQREQ
Table 114: +CGQREQ parameter command syntax
Command Possible Response(s)
+CGQREQ=[<cid> [,<precedence > [,<delay>
[,<reliability.> [,<peak> [,<mean>]]]]]]
OK
ERROR
+CGQREQ? +CGQREQ: <cid>, <precedence >, <delay>,
<reliability>, <peak>, <mean>
[<CR><LF>+CGQREQ: <cid>, <precedence >,
<delay>, <reliability.>, <peak>, <mean>
[]]
+CGQREQ=? +CGQREQ: <PDP_type>, (list of supported
<precedence>s), (list of supported
<delay>s), (list of supported
<reliability>s) , (list of supported
<peak>s), (list of supported <mean>s)
[<CR><LF>+CGQREQ: <PDP_type>, (list of
supported <precedence>s), (list of
supported <delay>s), (list of supported
<reliability>s) , (list of supported
<peak>s), (list of supported <mean>s)
[]]


ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 133 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Description
This command allows the TE to specify a Quality of Service Profile that is used when the MT sends an Activate PDP
Context Request message to the network.
The set command specifies a profile for the context identified by the (local) context identification parameter, <cid>.
Since this is the same parameter that is used in the +CGDCONT and +CGDSCONT commands, the +CGQREQ
command is effectively an extension to these commands. The QoS profile consists of a number of parameters, each of
which may be set to a separate value.
A special form of the set command, +CGQREQ= <cid> causes the requested profile for context number <cid> to
become undefined.
The read command returns the current settings for each defined context.
The test command returns values supported as a compound value. If the MT supports several PDP types, the parameter
value ranges for each PDP type are returned on a separate line.
Defined values
<cid>: a numeric parameter which specifies a particular PDP context definition (see the +CGDCONT and
+CGDSCONT commands).
The following parameters are defined in 3GPP TS 23.107 [46]:
<precedence>: a numeric parameter which specifies the precedence class
<delay>: a numeric parameter which specifies the delay class
<reliability>: a numeric parameter which specifies the reliability class
<peak>: a numeric parameter which specifies the peak throughput class
<mean>: a numeric parameter which specifies the mean throughput class
If a value is omitted for a particular class then the value is considered to be unspecified.
Implementation
Optional. If the command is not implemented then all the values are considered to be unspecified.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 134 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
10.1.5 Quality of Service Profile (Minimum acceptable) +CGQMIN
Table 115: +CGQMIN parameter command syntax
Command Possible Response(s)
+CGQMIN=[<cid> [,<precedence > [,<delay>
[,<reliability.> [,<peak> [,<mean>]]]]]]
OK
ERROR
+CGQMIN? +CGQMIN: <cid>, <precedence >, <delay>,
<reliability>, <peak>, <mean>
[<CR><LF>+CGQMIN: <cid>, <precedence >,
<delay>, <reliability.>, <peak>, <mean>
[]]
+CGQMIN=? +CGQMIN: <PDP_type>, (list of supported
<precedence>s), (list of supported
<delay>s), (list of supported
<reliability>s) , (list of supported
<peak>s), (list of supported <mean>s)
[<CR><LF>+CGQMIN: <PDP_type>, (list of
supported <precedence>s), (list of
supported <delay>s), (list of supported
<reliability>s) , (list of supported
<peak>s), (list of supported <mean>s)
[]]

Description
This command allows the TE to specify a minimum acceptable profile which is checked by the MT against the
negotiated profile returned in the Activate PDP Context Accept message.
The set command specifies a profile for the context identified by the (local) context identification parameter, <cid>.
Since this is the same parameter that is used in the +CGDCONT and +CGDSCONT commands, the +CGQMIN
command is effectively an extension to these commands. The QoS profile consists of a number of parameters, each of
which may be set to a separate value.
A special form of the set command, +CGQMIN= <cid> causes the minimum acceptable profile for context number
<cid> to become undefined. In this case no check is made against the negotiated profile.
The read command returns the current settings for each defined context.
The test command returns values supported as a compound value. If the MT supports several PDP types, the parameter
value ranges for each PDP type are returned on a separate line.
Defined values
<cid>: a numeric parameter which specifies a particular PDP context definition (see the +CGDCONT and
+CGDSCONT commands).
The following parameters are defined in -3GPP TS 23.107 [46]:
<precedence>: a numeric parameter which specifies the precedence class
<delay>: a numeric parameter which specifies the delay class
<reliability>: a numeric parameter which specifies the reliability class
<peak>: a numeric parameter which specifies the peak throughput class
<mean>: a numeric parameter which specifies the mean throughput class
If a value is omitted for a particular class then this class is not checked.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 135 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Implementation
Optional. If the command is not implemented then no check is made against the negotiated profile.
10.1.6 3G Quality of Service Profile (Requested) +CGEQREQ
Table 116: +CGEQREQ parameter command syntax
Command Possible Response(s)
+CGEQREQ=[<cid> [,<Traffic class>
[,<Maximum bitrate UL> [,<Maximum
bitrate DL> [,<Guaranteed bitrate UL>
[,<Guaranteed bitrate DL> [,<Delivery
order> [,<Maximum SDU size> [,<SDU
error ratio> [,<Residual bit error
ratio> [,<Delivery of erroneous SDUs>
[,<Transfer delay> [,<Traffic handling
priority> [,<Source statistics
descriptor> [,<Signalling
indication>]]]]]]]]]]]]]]]
OK
ERROR
+CGEQREQ? +CGEQREQ: <cid>, <Traffic class>
,<Maximum bitrate UL> ,<Maximum bitrate
DL> ,<Guaranteed bitrate UL>
,<Guaranteed bitrate DL> ,<Delivery
order> ,<Maximum SDU size> ,<SDU error
ratio> ,<Residual bit error ratio>
,<Delivery of erroneous SDUs>
,<Transfer delay> ,<Traffic handling
priority> ,<Source statistics
descriptor> ,<Signalling indication>
[<CR><LF>+CGEQREQ: <cid>, <Traffic
class> ,<Maximum bitrate UL> ,<Maximum
bitrate DL> ,<Guaranteed bitrate UL>
,<Guaranteed bitrate DL> ,<Delivery
order> ,<Maximum SDU size> ,<SDU error
ratio> ,<Residual bit error ratio>
,<Delivery of erroneous SDUs>
,<Transfer delay> ,<Traffic handling
priority> ,<Source Statistics
Descriptor> ,<Signalling Indication>
[]]
+CGEQREQ=? +CGEQREQ: <PDP_type>, (list of
supported <Traffic class>s) ,(list of
supported <Maximum bitrate UL>s), (list
of supported <Maximum bitrate DL>s),
(list of supported <Guaranteed bitrate
UL>s), (list of supported <Guaranteed
bitrate DL>s),(list of supported
<Delivery order>s) ,(list of supported
<Maximum SDU size>s) ,(list of
supported <SDU error ratio>s) ,(list of
supported <Residual bit error ratio>s)
,(list of supported <Delivery of
erroneous SDUs>s) ,(list of supported
<Transfer delay>s) ,(list of supported
<Traffic handling priority>s) ,(list of
supported <Source statistics
descriptor>s) ,(list of supported
<Signalling indication>s)

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 136 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Command Possible Response(s)
[<CR><LF>+CGEQREQ: <PDP_type>, (list of
supported <Traffic class>s) ,(list of
supported <Maximum bitrate UL>s), (list
of supported <Maximum bitrate DL>s),
(list of supported <Guaranteed bitrate
UL>s), (list of supported <Guaranteed
bitrate DL>s),(list of supported
<Delivery order>s) ,(list of supported
<Maximum SDU size>s) ,(list of
supported <SDU error ratio>s) ,(list of
supported <Residual bit error ratio>s)
,(list of supported <Delivery of
erroneous SDUs>s) ,(list of supported
<Transfer delay>s) ,(list of supported
<Traffic handling priority>s) ) ,(list
of supported <Source statistics
descriptor>s) ,(list of supported
<Signalling indication>s)
[]]

Description
This command allows the TE to specify a UMTS Quality of Service Profile that is used when the MT sends an Activate
PDP Context Request message to the network.
The set command specifies a profile for the context identified by the (local) context identification parameter, <cid>.
The specified profile will be stored in the MT and sent to the network only at activation or MS-initiated modification of
the related context. Since this is the same parameter that is used in the +CGDCONT and +CGDSCONT commands, the
+CGEQREQ command is effectively an extension to these commands. The QoS profile consists of a number of
parameters, each of which may be set to a separate value.
A special form of the set command, +CGEQREQ= <cid> causes the requested profile for context number <cid> to
become undefined.
The read command returns the current settings for each defined context.
The test command returns values supported as a compound value. If the MT supports several PDP types, the parameter
value ranges for each PDP type are returned on a separate line.
Defined values
<cid>: a numeric parameter which specifies a particular PDP context definition (see +CGDCONT and
+CGDSCONT commands).
The following parameters are defined in 3GPP TS 23.107 [46] -
<Traffic class>: a numeric parameter that indicates the type of application for which the UMTS bearer
service is optimised.
0 - conversational
1 - streaming
2 - interactive
3 - background
4 - subscribed value
If the Traffic class is specified as conversational or streaming, then the Guaranteed and Maximum bitrate
parameters should also be provided. Other values are reserved.
<Maximum bitrate UL>: a numeric parameter that indicates the maximum number of kbits/s delivered to
UMTS (up-link traffic) at a SAP. As an example a bitrate of 32kbit/s would be specified as '32' (e.g.
AT+CGEQREQ=,32, ). This parameter should be provided if the Traffic class is specified as conversational
or streaming (refer 3GPP TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.6.5).

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 137 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
<Maximum bitrate DL>: a numeric parameter that indicates the maximum number of kbits/s delivered by
UMTS (down-link traffic) at a SAP. As an example a bitrate of 32kbit/s would be specified as '32' (e.g.
AT+CGEQREQ=,32, ). If the parameter is set to '0' the subscribed value will be requested. This parameter
should be provided if the Traffic class is specified as conversational or streaming (refer 3GPP TS 24.008 [8]
subclause 10.5.6.5).
<Guaranteed bitrate UL>: a numeric parameter that indicates the guaranteed number of kbits/s delivered
to UMTS (up-link traffic) at a SAP (provided that there is data to deliver). As an example a bitrate of 32kbit/s
would be specified as '32' (e.g. AT+CGEQREQ=,32, ). If the parameter is set to '0' the subscribed value will
be requested. This parameter should be provided if the Traffic class is specified as conversational or streaming
(refer 3GPP TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.6.5).

<Guaranteed bitrate DL>: a numeric parameter that indicates the guaranteed number of kbits/s delivered
by UMTS (down-link traffic) at a SAP (provided that there is data to deliver). As an example a bitrate of
32kbit/s would be specified as '32' (e.g. AT+CGEQREQ=,32, ). If the parameter is set to '0' the subscribed
value will be requested. This parameter should be provided if the Traffic class is specified as conversational or
streaming (refer 3GPP TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.6.5).

<Delivery order>: a numeric parameter that indicates whether the UMTS bearer shall provide in-sequence
SDU delivery or not.
0 - no
1 - yes
2 - subscribed value.
Other values are reserved.
<Maximum SDU size>: a numeric parameter (1,2,3,) that indicates the maximum allowed SDU size in octets.
If the parameter is set to '0' the subscribed value will be requested (refer 3GPP TS 24.008 [8] subclause
10.5.6.5).
<SDU error ratio>: a string parameter that indicates the target value for the fraction of SDUs lost or detected
as erroneous. SDU error ratio is defined only for conforming traffic. The value is specified as 'mEe'. As an
example a target SDU error ratio of 510
-3
would be specified as '5E3' (e.g. AT+CGEQREQ=,'5E3',). '0E0'
means subscribed value (refer 3GPP TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.6.5).
<Residual bit error ratio>: a string parameter that indicates the target value for the undetected bit error
ratio in the delivered SDUs. If no error detection is requested, Residual bit error ratio indicates the bit error ratio
in the delivered SDUs. The value is specified as 'mEe'. As an example a target residual bit error ratio of 510
-3
would be specified as '5E3' (e.g. AT+CGEQREQ=,'5E3',). '0E0' means subscribed value (refer
3GPP TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.6.5).
<Delivery of erroneous SDUs>: a numeric parameter that indicates whether SDUs detected as erroneous
shall be delivered or not.
0 - no
1 - yes
2 - no detect
3 - subscribed value
Other values are reserved.
<Transfer delay>: a numeric parameter (0,1,2,) that indicates the targeted time between request to transfer
an SDU at one SAP to its delivery at the other SAP, in milliseconds. If the parameter is set to '0' the subscribed
value will be requested (refer 3GPP TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.6.5).
<Traffic handling priority>: a numeric parameter (1,2,3,) that specifies the relative importance for
handling of all SDUs belonging to the UMTS bearer compared to the SDUs of other bearers. If the parameter is
set to '0' the subscribed value will be requested (refer 3GPP TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.6.5).
<Source Statistics Descriptor>: a numeric parameter that specifies characteristics of the source of the
submitted SDUs for a PDP context. This parameter should be provided if the Traffic class is specified as

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 138 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
conversational or streaming (refer 3GPP TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.6.5).
0 - Characteristics of SDUs is unknown (default value)
1 - Characteristics of SDUs corresponds to a speech source
Other values are reserved.
<Signalling Indication>: a numeric parameter used to indicate signalling content of submitted SDUs for
a PDP context. This parameter should be provided if the Traffic class is specified as interactive (refer
3GPP TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.6.5).
0 - PDP context is not optimized for signalling (default value)
1 - PDP context is optimized for signalling<PDP_type>: (see +CGDCONT and +CGDSCONT commands).
If a value is omitted for a particular class then the value is considered to be unspecified.
Implementation
Optional. If the command is not implemented then all the values are considered to be unspecified.
10.1.7 3G Quality of Service Profile (Minimum acceptable) +CGEQMIN
Table 117: +CGEQMIN parameter command syntax
Command Possible Response(s)
+CGEQMIN=[<cid> [,<Traffic class>
[,<Maximum bitrate UL> [,<Maximum
bitrate DL> [,<Guaranteed bitrate UL>
[,<Guaranteed bitrate DL> [,<Delivery
order> [,<Maximum SDU size> [,<SDU
error ratio> [,<Residual bit error
ratio> [,<Delivery of erroneous SDUs>
[,<Transfer delay> [,<Traffic handling
priority> [,<Source statistics
descriptor> [,<Signalling
indication>]]]]]]]]]]]]]]]
OK
ERROR
+CGEQMIN? +CGEQMIN: <cid>, <Traffic class>
,<Maximum bitrate UL>, <Maximum bitrate
DL> ,<Guaranteed bitrate UL>
,<Guaranteed bitrate DL>, <Delivery
order> ,<Maximum SDU size> ,<SDU error
ratio> ,<Residual bit error ratio>
,<Delivery of erroneous SDUs>
,<Transfer delay> ,<Traffic handling
priority> ,<Source statistics
descriptor> ,<Signalling indication>
[<CR><LF>+CGEQMIN: <cid>, <Traffic
class> ,<Maximum bitrate UL> ,<Maximum
bitrate DL> ,<Guaranteed bitrate UL>
,<Guaranteed bitrate DL>, <Delivery
order> ,<Maximum SDU size> ,<SDU error
ratio> ,<Residual bit error ratio>
,<Delivery of erroneous SDUs>
,<Transfer delay> ,<Traffic handling
priority> ,<Source statistics
descriptor> ,<Signalling indication>
[]]
+CGEQMIN=? +CGEQMIN: <PDP_type>, (list of
supported <Traffic class>s) ,(list of
supported <Maximum bitrate UL>s) ,(list
of supported <Maximum bitrate DL>s),
(list of supported <Guaranteed bitrate
UL>s), (list of supported <Guaranteed

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 139 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Command Possible Response(s)
bitrate DL>s) ,(list of supported
<Delivery order>s) ,(list of supported
<Maximum SDU size>s) ,(list of
supported <SDU error ratio>s) ,(list of
supported <Residual bit error ratio>s)
,(list of supported <Delivery of
erroneous SDUs>s) ,(list of supported
<Transfer delay>s) ,(list of supported
<Traffic handling priority>s) ,(list of
supported <Source statistics
descriptor>s) ,(list of supported
<Signalling indication>s)
[<CR><LF>+CGEQMIN: <PDP_type>, (list of
supported <Traffic class>s) ,(list of
supported <Maximum bitrate UL>s), (list
of supported <Maximum bitrate DL>s)
,(list of supported <Guaranteed bitrate
UL >s), (list of supported <Guaranteed
bitrate DL >s) ,(list of supported
<Delivery order>s) ,(list of supported
<Maximum SDU size>s) ,(list of
supported <SDU error ratio>s) ,(list of
supported <Residual bit error ratio>s)
,(list of supported <Delivery of
erroneous SDUs>s) ,(list of supported
<Transfer delay>s) ,(list of supported
<Traffic handling priority>s) ,(list of
supported <Source statistics
descriptor>s) ,(list of supported
<Signalling indication>s)
[]]

Description
This command allows the TE to specify a minimum acceptable profile, which is checked by the MT against the
negotiated profile returned in the Activate/Modify PDP Context Accept message.
The set command specifies a profile for the context identified by the (local) context identification parameter, <cid>.
The specified profile will be stored in the MT and checked against the negotiated profile only at activation or MS-
initiated modification of the related context. Since this is the same parameter that is used in the +CGDCONT and
+CGDSCONT commands, the +CGEQMIN command is effectively an extension to these commands. The QoS profile
consists of a number of parameters, each of which may be set to a separate value.
A special form of the set command, +CGEQMIN= <cid> causes the minimum acceptable profile for context number
<cid> to become undefined. In this case no check is made against the negotiated profile.
The read command returns the current settings for each defined context.
The test command returns values supported as a compound value. If the MT supports several PDP types, the parameter
value ranges for each PDP type are returned on a separate line.
Defined values
<cid>: a numeric parameter which specifies a particular PDP context definition (see +CGDCONT and
+CGDSCONT commands).
The following parameters are defined in 3GPP TS 23.107 [46] -
<Traffic class>: a numeric parameter that indicates the type of application for which the UMTS bearer
service is optimised.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 140 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
0 - conversational
1 - streaming
2 - interactive
3 - background
Other values are reserved.
<Maximum bitrate UL>: a numeric parameter that indicates the maximum number of kbits/s delivered to
UMTS (up-link traffic) at a SAP. As an example a bitrate of 32kbit/s would be specified as '32' (e.g.
AT+CGEQMIN=,32, ) (refer 3GPP TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.6.5).
<Maximum bitrate DL>: a numeric parameter that indicates the maximum number of kbits/s delivered by
UMTS (down-link traffic) at a SAP. As an example a bitrate of 32kbit/s would be specified as '32' (e.g.
AT+CGEQMIN=,32, ) (refer 3GPP TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.6.5).
<Guaranteed bitrate UL>: a numeric parameter that indicates the guaranteed number of kbits/s delivered
to UMTS (up-link traffic) at a SAP (provided that there is data to deliver). As an example a bitrate of 32kbit/s
would be specified as '32' (e.g. AT+CGEQMIN=,32, ) (refer 3GPP TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.6.5).
<Guaranteed bitrate DL>: a numeric parameter that indicates the guaranteed number of kbits/s delivered
by UMTS (down-link traffic) at a SAP (provided that there is data to deliver). As an example a bitrate of 32kbit/s
would be specified as '32' (e.g. AT+CGEQMIN=,32, ) (refer 3GPP TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.6.5).
<Delivery order>: a numeric parameter that indicates whether the UMTS bearer shall provide in-sequence
SDU delivery or not.
0 - no
1 - yes
Other values are reserved.
<Maximum SDU size>: a numeric parameter (1,2,3,) that indicates the maximum allowed SDU size in octets
(refer 3GPP TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.6.5).
<SDU error ratio>: a string parameter that indicates the target value for the fraction of SDUs lost or detected
as erroneous. SDU error ratio is defined only for conforming traffic. The value is specified as 'mEe'. As an
example a target SDU error ratio of 510
-3
would be specified as '5E3' (e.g. AT+CGEQMIN=,'5E3',) (refer
3GPP TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.6.5).
<Residual bit error ratio>: a string parameter that indicates the target value for the undetected bit error
ratio in the delivered SDUs. If no error detection is requested, Residual bit error ratio indicates the bit error ratio
in the delivered SDUs. The value is specified as 'mEe'. As an example a target residual bit error ratio of 510
-3
would be specified as '5E3' (e.g. AT+CGEQMIN=,'5E3',) (refer 3GPP TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.6.5).
<Delivery of erroneous SDUs>: a numeric parameter that indicates whether SDUs detected as erroneous
shall be delivered or not.
0 - no
1 - yes
2 - no detect
Other values are reserved.
<Transfer delay>: a numeric parameter (0,1,2,) that indicates the targeted time between request to transfer
an SDU at one SAP to its delivery at the other SAP, in milliseconds (refer 3GPP TS 24.008 [8] subclause
10.5.6.5).
<Traffic handling priority>: a numeric parameter (1,2,3,) that specifies the relative importance for
handling of all SDUs belonging to the UMTS bearer compared to the SDUs of other bearers (refer
3GPP TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.6.5).
<Source Statistics Descriptor>: a numeric parameter that specifies characteristics of the source of the
submitted SDUs for a PDP context. This parameter should be provided if the Traffic class is specified as
conversational or streaming (refer 3GPP TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.6.5).
0 - Characteristics of SDUs is unknown (default value)
1 - Characteristics of SDUs corresponds to a speech source

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 141 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Other values are reserved.
<Signalling Indication>: a numeric parameter used to indicate signalling content of submitted SDUs for
a PDP context. This parameter should be provided if the Traffic class is specified as interactive (refer
3GPP TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.6.5).
0 - PDP context is not optimized for signalling (default value)
1 - PDP context is optimized for signalling
<PDP_type>: (see +CGDCONT and +CGDSCONT commands).
If a value is omitted for a particular class then the value is considered to be unspecified.
Implementation
Optional. If the command is not implemented then no check is made against the negotiated profile.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 142 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
10.1.8 3G Quality of Service Profile (Negotiated) +CGEQNEG
Table 118: +CGEQNEG action command syntax
Command Possible Response(s)
+CGEQNEG =[<cid>[,<cid>[,]]] +CGEQNEG: <cid>, <Traffic class>
,<Maximum bitrate UL>, <Maximum bitrate
DL> ,<Guaranteed bitrate UL>,
<Guaranteed bitrate DL> ,<Delivery
order> ,<Maximum SDU size> ,<SDU error
ratio> ,<Residual bit error ratio>
,<Delivery of erroneous SDUs>
,<Transfer delay> ,<Traffic handling
priority>
[<CR><LF>+CGEQNEG: <cid>, <Traffic
class> ,<Maximum bitrate UL>, <Maximum
bitrate DL> ,<Guaranteed bitrate UL>,
<Guaranteed bitrate DL> ,<Delivery
order> ,<Maximum SDU size> ,<SDU error
ratio> ,<Residual bit error ratio>
,<Delivery of erroneous SDUs>
,<Transfer delay> ,<Traffic handling
priority>
[]]
+CGEQNEG=? +CGEQNEG: (list of <cid>s associated
with active contexts)

Description
This command allows the TE to retrieve the negotiated QoS profiles returned in the Activate PDP Context Accept
message.
The execution command returns the negotiated QoS profile for the specified context identifiers, <cid>s. The QoS
profile consists of a number of parameters, each of which may have a separate value.
The test command returns a list of <cid>s associated with active contexts.
Defined values
<cid>: a numeric parameter which specifies a particular PDP context definition (see +CGDCONT and
+CGDSCONT commands).
The following parameters are defined in 3GPP TS 23.107 [46] -
<Traffic class>: a numeric parameter that indicates the type of application for which the UMTS bearer
service is optimised.
0 - conversational
1 - streaming
2 - interactive
3 - background
Other values are reserved.
<Maximum bitrate UL>: a numeric parameter that indicates the maximum number of kbits/s delivered to
UMTS (up-link traffic) at a SAP. As an example a bitrate of 32kbit/s would be specified as '32' (e.g.
+CGEQNEG:,32, ) (refer TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.6.5).
<Maximum bitrate DL>: a numeric parameter that indicates the maximum number of kbits/s delivered by
UMTS (down-link traffic) at a SAP As an example a bitrate of 32kbit/s would be specified as '32' (e.g.
+CGEQNEG:,32, ) (refer TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.6.5).

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 143 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
<Guaranteed bitrate UL>: a numeric parameter that indicates the guaranteed number of kbits/s delivered
to UMTS (up-link traffic) at a SAP (provided that there is data to deliver). As an example a bitrate of 32kbit/s
would be specified as '32' (e.g. +CGEQNEG:,32, ) (refer TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.6.5).
<Guaranteed bitrate DL>: a numeric parameter that indicates the guaranteed number of kbits/s delivered
by UMTS (down-link traffic) at a SAP (provided that there is data to deliver). As an example a bitrate of 32kbit/s
would be specified as '32' (e.g. +CGEQNEG:,32, ) (refer TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.6.5).
<Delivery order>: a numeric parameter that indicates whether the UMTS bearer shall provide in-sequence
SDU delivery or not.
0 - no
1 - yes
Other values are reserved.
<Maximum SDU size>: a numeric parameter that (1,2,3,) indicates the maximum allowed SDU size in octets
(refer TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.6.5).
<SDU error ratio>: a string parameter that indicates the target value for the fraction of SDUs lost or detected
as erroneous. SDU error ratio is defined only for conforming traffic. The value is specified as 'mEe'. As an
example a target SDU error ratio of 510
-3
would be specified as '5E3' (e.g. +CGEQNEG:,'5E3',) (refer TS
24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.6.5).
<Residual bit error ratio>: a string parameter that indicates the target value for the undetected bit error
ratio in the delivered SDUs. If no error detection is requested, Residual bit error ratio indicates the bit error ratio
in the delivered SDUs. The value is specified as 'mEe'. As an example a target residual bit error ratio of 510
-3
would be specified as '5E3' (e.g. +CGEQNEG:,'5E3',) (refer TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.6.5).
<Delivery of erroneous SDUs>: a numeric parameter that indicates whether SDUs detected as erroneous
shall be delivered or not.
0 - no
1 - yes
2 - no detect
Other values are reserved.
<Transfer delay>: a numeric parameter (0,1,2,) that indicates the targeted time between request to transfer
an SDU at one SAP to its delivery at the other SAP, in milliseconds (refer TS 24.008 [8] subclause 10.5.6.5).
<Traffic handling priority>: a numeric parameter (1,2,3,) that specifies the relative importance for
handling of all SDUs belonging to the UMTS bearer compared to the SDUs of other bearers (refer TS 24.008 [8]
subclause 10.5.6.5).
If a value is omitted for a particular class then the value is considered to be unspecified.
Implementation
Optional.
10.1.9 PS attach or detach +CGATT
Table 119: CGATT action command syntax
Command Possible Response(s)
+CGATT= [<state>] OK
ERROR
+CGATT? +CGATT: <state>
+CGATT=? +CGATT: (list of supported <state>s)

Description

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 144 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
The execution command is used to attach the MT to, or detach the MT from, the Packet Domain service. After the
command has completed, the MT remains in V.250 command state. If the MT is already in the requested state, the
command is ignored and the OK response is returned. If the requested state cannot be achieved, an ERROR or +CME
ERROR response is returned. Extended error responses are enabled by the +CMEE command.
Any active PDP contexts will be automatically deactivated when the attachment state changes to detached.
The read command returns the current Packet Domain service state.
The test command is used for requesting information on the supported Packet Domain service states.
NOTE: This command has the characteristics of both the V.250 action and parameter commands. Hence it has the
read form in addition to the execution/set and test forms.
Defined Values
<state>: indicates the state of PS attachment
0 - detached
1 - attached
Other values are reserved and will result in an ERROR response to the execution command.
Implementation
Optional.
10.1.10 PDP context activate or deactivate +CGACT
Table 120: CGACT action command syntax
Command Possible Response(s)
+CGACT=[<state> [,<cid>[,<cid>[,]]]] OK
ERROR
+CGACT? +CGACT: <cid>, <state>
[<CR><LF>+CGACT: <cid>, <state>
[...]]

+CGACT=? +CGACT: (list of supported <state>s)

Description
The execution command is used to activate or deactivate the specified PDP context (s). After the command has
completed, the MT remains in V.250 command state. If any PDP context is already in the requested state, the state for
that context remains unchanged. If the requested state for any specified context cannot be achieved, an ERROR or
+CME ERROR response is returned. Extended error responses are enabled by the +CMEE command. If the MT is not
PS attached when the activation form of the command is executed, the MT first performs a PS attach and them attempts
to activate the specified contexts. If the attach fails then the MT responds with ERROR or, if extended error responses
are enabled, with the appropriate failure-to-attach error message.
If no <cid>s are specified the activation form of the command activates all defined contexts.
If no <cid>s are specified the deactivation form of the command deactivates all active contexts.
The read command returns the current activation states for all the defined PDP contexts.
The test command is used for requesting information on the supported PDP context activation states.
NOTE. This command has the characteristics of both the V.250 action and parameter commands. Hence it has the
read form in addition to the execution/set and test forms.
Defined Values
<state>: indicates the state of PDP context activation
0 - deactivated

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 145 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
1 - activated
Other values are reserved and will result in an ERROR response to the execution command.
<cid>: a numeric parameter which specifies a particular PDP context definition (see the +CGDCONT and
+CGDSCONT commands).
Implementation
Optional.
10.1.11 PDP Context Modify +CGCMOD
Table 121: CGCMOD action command syntax
Command Possible Response(s)
+CGCMOD=[<cid>[,<cid>[,]]] OK
ERROR
+CGCMOD=? +CGCMOD: (list of <cid>s associated
with active contexts)

Description
The execution command is used to modify the specified PDP context (s) with repect to QoS profiles and TFTs. After
the command has completed, the MT returns to V.250 online data state. If the requested modification for any specified
context cannot be achieved, an ERROR or +CME ERROR response is returned. Extended error responses are enabled
by the +CMEE command.
If no <cid>s are specified the activation form of the command modifies all active contexts.
The test command returns a list of <cid>s associated with active contexts.
Defined Values
<cid>: a numeric parameter which specifies a particular PDP context definition (see the +CGDCONT and
+CGDSCONT commands).
Implementation
Optional.
10.1.12 Enter data state +CGDATA
Table 122: +CGDATA action command syntax
Command Possible Response(s)
+CGDATA=[<L2P> ,[<cid> [,<cid> [,]]]] CONNECT
ERROR
+CGDATA=? +CGDATA: (list of supported <L2P>s)

Description
The execution command causes the MT to perform whatever actions are necessary to establish communication between
the TE and the network using one or more Packet Domain PDP types. This may include performing a PS attach and one
or more PDP context activations. If the <L2P> parameter value is unacceptable to the MT, the MT shall return an
ERROR or +CME ERROR response. Otherwise, the MT issues the intermediate result code CONNECT and enters
V.250 online data state.
Commands following +CGDATA command in the AT command line shall not be processed by the MT.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 146 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
The detailed behaviour after the online data state has been entered is dependent on the PDP type. It is described briefly
in 3GPP TS 27.060[34] and in more detail in 3GPP TS 29.061[39] and the specifications for the relevant PDPs. PS
attachment and PDP context activation procedures may take place prior to or during the PDP startup if they have not
already been performed using the +CGATT and +CGACT commands.
If context activation takes place during the PDP startup, one or more <cid>s may be specified in order to provide the
information needed for the context activation request(s).
During each PDP startup procedure the MT may have access to some or all of the following information -
The MT may have a priori knowledge, for example, it may implement only one PDP type.
The command may have provided an <L2P> parameter value.
The TE may provide a PDP type and/or PDP address to the MT during in the PDP startup procedure.
If any of this information is in conflict, the command will fail.
Any PDP type and/or PDP address present in the above information shall be compared with the PDP type and/or PDP
address in any context definitions specified in the command in the order in which their <cid>s appear. For a context
definition to match -
The PDP type must match exactly.
The PDP addresses are considered to match if they are identical or if either or both addresses are unspecified.
For example, a PPP NCP request specifying PDP type = IP and no PDP address would cause the MT to search
through the specified context definitions for one with PDP type = IP and any PDP address.
The context shall be activated using the matched value for PDP type and a static PDP address if available, together with
the other information found in the PDP context definition. If a static PDP address is not available then a dynamic
address is requested.
If no <cid> is given or if there is no matching context definition, the MT shall attempt to activate the context with
whatever information is available to the MT. The other context parameters shall be set to their default values.
If the activation is successful, data transfer may proceed.
After data transfer is complete, and the layer 2 protocol termination procedure has completed successfully, the V.250
command state is re-entered and the MT returns the final result code OK.
In the event of an erroneous termination or a failure to start up, the V.250 command state is re-entered and the MT
returns the final result code NO CARRIER or, if enabled, +CME ERROR. Attach, activate and other errors may be
reported.
The test command is used for requesting information on the supported layer 2 protocols.
This command may be used in both normal and modem compatibility modes.
Defined Values
<L2P>: a string parameter that indicates the layer 2 protocol to be used between the TE and MT
NULL none, for PDP type OSP:IHOSS (Obsolete)
PPP Point-to-point protocol for a PDP such as IP
PAD character stream for X.25 character (triple X PAD) mode (Obsolete)
X25 X.25 L2 (LAPB) for X.25 packet mode (Obsolete)
M-xxxx manufacturer-specific protocol (xxxx is an alphanumeric string)
If the value is omitted, the layer 2 protocol is unspecified. Other values are reserved and will result in an ERROR
response.
<cid>: a numeric parameter which specifies a particular PDP context definition (see the +CGDCONT and
+CGDSCONT commands).
Implementation
Optional if the D (dial) command can be used to specify Packet Domain operation.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 147 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
10.1.13 Configure local Octet Stream PAD parameters +CGCLOSP
(Obsolete)
10.1.14 Show PDP address +CGPADDR
Table 123: +CGPADDR action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CGPADDR=[<c
id> [,<cid>
[,]]]
+CGPADDR: <cid>,<PDP_addr>
[<CR><LF>+CGPADDR: <cid>,<PDP_addr>
[...]]

+CGPADDR=? +CGPADDR: (list of defined <cid>s)

Description
The execution command returns a list of PDP addresses for the specified context identifiers.
The test command returns a list of defined <cid>s.
Defined values
<cid>: a numeric parameter which specifies a particular PDP context definition (see the +CGDCONT and
+CGDSCONT commands). If no <cid> is specified, the addresses for all defined contexts are returned.
<PDP_address>: a string that identifies the MT in the address space applicable to the PDP. The address may
be static or dynamic. For a static address, it will be the one set by the +CGDCONT and +CGDSCONT
commands when the context was defined. For a dynamic address it will be the one assigned during the last PDP
context activation that used the context definition referred to by <cid>. <PDP_address> is omitted if none is
available.
Implementation
Optional.
10.1.15 Automatic response to a network request for PDP context activation
+CGAUTO
Table 124: CGAUTO parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CGAUTO=[<n>] OK
ERROR
+CGAUTO? +CGAUTO: <n>
+CGAUTO=? +CGAUTO: (list of supported <n>s)

Description
The set command disables or enables an automatic positive response (auto-answer) to the receipt of a Request PDP
Context Activation message from the network. It also provides control over the use of the V.250 basic commands 'S0',
'A and 'H' for handling network requests for PDP context activation. The setting does not affect the issuing of the
unsolicited result code RING or +CRING.
The test command returns the values of <n> supported by the MT as a compound value.
When the +CGAUTO=0 command is received, the MT shall not perform a PS detach if it is attached. Subsequently,
when the MT announces a network request for PDP context activation by issuing the unsolicited result code RING or

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 148 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
+CRING, the TE may manually accept or reject the request by issuing the +CGANS command or may simply ignore
the network request.
When the +CGAUTO=1 command is received, the MT shall attempt to perform a PS attach if it is not already attached.
Failure will result in ERROR or, if enabled, +CME ERROR being returned to the TE. Subsequently, when the MT
announces a network request for PDP context activation by issuing the unsolicited result code RING or +CRING to the
TE, this is followed by the intermediate result code CONNECT. The MT then enters V.250 online data state and
follows the same procedure as it would after having received a +CGANS=1 with no <L2P> or <cid> values specified.
Defined values
<n>:
0 turn off automatic response for Packet Domain only
1 turn on automatic response for Packet Domain only
2 modem compatibility mode, Packet Domain only
3 modem compatibility mode, Packet Domain and circuit switched calls (default)
For <n> = 0 Packet DomainS network requests are manually accepted or rejected by the +CGANS command.
For <n> = 1 Packet Domain network requests are automatically accepted according to the description above.
For <n> = 2, automatic acceptance of Packet Domain network requests is controlled by the 'S0' command. Manual
control uses the 'A' and 'H' commands, respectively, to accept and reject Packet Domain requests. (+CGANS may also
be used.) Incoming circuit switched calls can be neither manually nor automatically answered.
For <n> = 3, automatic acceptance of both Packet Domain network requests and incoming circuit switched calls is
controlled by the 'S0' command. Manual control uses the 'A' and 'H' commands, respectively, to accept and reject Packet
Domain requests. (+CGANS may also be used.) Circuit switched calls are handled as described elsewhere in this
specification.
Implementation
Optional. If not implemented, the MT shall behave according to the case of <n> = 3.
10.1.16 Manual response to a network request for PDP context activation
+CGANS
Table 125: CGANS action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CGANS=[<response>,
[<L2P> ,[<cid>]]]
OK
ERROR
+CGANS=? +CGANS: (list of supported
<response>s), (list of supported
<L2P>s)

Description
The execution command requests the MT to respond to a network request for Packet Domain PDP context activation
which has been signalled to the TE by the RING or +CRING: unsolicited result code. The <response> parameter
allows the TE to accept or reject the request.
If <response> is 0, the request is rejected and the MT returns OK to the TE.
If <response> is 1, the following procedure is followed by the MT.
Commands following the +CGANS command in the AT command line shall not be processed by the MT.
If the <L2P> parameter value is unacceptable to the MT, the MT shall return an ERROR or +CME ERROR response.
Otherwise, the MT issues the intermediate result code CONNECT and enters V.250 online data state.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 149 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
The detailed behaviour after the online data state has been entered is dependent on the PDP type. It is described briefly
in 3GPP TS 27.060[34] and in more detail in 3GPP TS 29.061[39] and the specifications for the relevant PDPs. PDP
context activation procedures shall take place prior to or during the PDP startup.
One or more <cid>s may be specified in order to provide the values needed for the context activation request.
During the PDP startup procedure the MT has the PDP type and the PDP address provided by the network in the
Request PDP Context Activation message. The MT may also have some or all of the following information -
The MT may have a priori knowledge, for example, it may implement only one PDP type.
The command may have provided an <L2P> parameter value.
The TE may provide one or both of PDP type and PDP address to the MT in the PDP startup.
If any of this information is in conflict, the command will fail.
If one or more <cid> is given then an attempt shall be made to identify an appropriate context definition by matching
the PDP type and PDP address in the network request with the PDP type and PDP address in each of the specified
context definitions (in the order in which their <cid>s appear in the command) as follows -
The PDP type must match exactly.
The PDP addresses are considered to match if they are identical or if the address in the context definition is
unspecified.
The context shall be activated using the values for PDP type and PDP address provided by the network, together with
the other information found in the PDP context definition. An APN may or may not re required, depending on the
application.
If no <cid> is given or if there is no matching context definition, the MT will attempt to activate the context using the
values for PDP type and PDP address provided by the network, together with any other relevant information known to
the MT. The other context parameters will be set to their default values.
If the activation is successful, data transfer may proceed.
After data transfer is complete, and the layer 2 protocol termination procedure has completed successfully, the V.250
command state is re-entered and the MT returns the final result code OK
In the event of an erroneous termination or a failure to startup, the V.250 command state is re-entered and the MT
returns the final result code NO CARRIER or, if enabled, +CME ERROR. Attach, activate and other errors may be
reported. It is also an error to issue the +CGANS command when there is no outstanding network request.
NOTE: This is not the same as if the MT issues a +CGDATA (or +CGACT) command after receiving a +CRING
unsolicited result code. A +CGDATA (or +CGACT) does not command the MT to acknowledge the
network request but rather to make a new request for context activation. The network request would be
ignored.
The test command returns the values of <response> and <L2P> supported by the MT as compound values.
This command may be used in both normal and modem compatibility modes.
Defined values
<response>: is a numeric parameter which specifies how the request should be responded to.
0 reject the request
1 accept and request that the PDP context be activated
If <response> is omitted it is assumed to be 0. Other values are reserved and will result in the ERROR response.
<L2P>: a string parameter which indicates the layer 2 protocol to be used (see +CGDATA command).
<cid>: a numeric parameter which specifies a particular PDP context definition (see the +CGDCONT and
+CGDSCONT commands).

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 150 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Implementation
Optional.
10.1.17 GPRS mobile station class +CGCLASS
Table 126: CGCLASS parameter command syntax
Command Possible Response(s)
+CGCLASS= [<class>] OK
ERROR
+CGCLASS? +CGCLASS: <class>
+CGCLASS=? +CGCLASS: (list of supported <class>s)

Description
The set command is used to set the MT to operate according to the specified mode of operation, see TS 23.060 [47]. If
the requested mode of operation is not supported, an ERROR or +CME ERROR response is returned. Extended error
responses are enabled by the +CMEE command.
The read command returns the mode of operation set by the TE, independent of the current serving cell capability and
independent of the current serving cell Access Technology. If no value has been set by the TE previously, the return
value shall be the highest mode of operation that can be supported by the MT.
The test command is used for requesting information on the supported MT mode of operation.
Defined Values
<class>: a string parameter which indicates the mode of operation
A Class-A mode of operation (A/Gb mode), or CS/PS mode of operation (Iu mode) (highest mode of
operation)
B Class-B mode of operation (A/Gb mode), (not applicable in Iu mode)
CG Class-C mode of operation in PS only mode (A/Gb mode), or PS mode of operation (Iu mode)
CC Class-C mode of operation in CS only mode (A/Gb mode), or CS (Iu mode) (lowest mode of operation)
NOTE: <class> A means that the MT would operate simultaneous PS and CS service
<class> B means that the MT would operate PS and CS services but not simultaneously
<class> CG means that the MT would only operate PS services
<class> CC means that the MT would only operate CS services
Other values are reserved and will result in an ERROR response to the set command.
If the MT is attached to the PS domain when the set command is issued with a <class> = CC specified, a PS detach
shall be performed by the MT.
Implementation
Optional.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 151 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
10.1.12 Configure local triple-X PAD parameters +CGCLPAD (GPRS only)
(Obsolete)
10.1.18 Packet Domain event reporting +CGEREP
Table 127: CGEREP parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CGEREP=[<mode>[,<bfr>]] OK
ERROR
+CGEREP? +CGEREP: <mode>,<bfr>
+CGEREP=? +CGEREP: (list of supported <mode>s),(list of supported
<bfr>s)

Description
Set command enables or disables sending of unsolicited result codes, +CGEV: XXX from MT to TE in the case of
certain events occurring in the Packet Domain MT or the network. <mode> controls the processing of unsolicited result
codes specified within this command. <bfr> controls the effect on buffered codes when <mode> 1 or 2 is entered. If a
setting is not supported by the MT, ERROR or +CME ERROR: is returned.
Read command returns the current mode and buffer settings
Test command returns the modes and buffer settings supported by the MT as compound values.
Defined values
<mode>:
0 buffer unsolicited result codes in the MT; if MT result code buffer is full, the oldest ones can be discarded. No
codes are forwarded to the TE.
1 discard unsolicited result codes when MT-TE link is reserved (e.g. in on-line data mode); otherwise forward
them directly to the TE
2 buffer unsolicited result codes in the MT when MT-TE link is reserved (e.g. in on-line data mode) and flush
them to the TE when MT-TE link becomes available; otherwise forward them directly to the TE
<bfr>:
0 MT buffer of unsolicited result codes defined within this command is cleared when <mode> 1 or 2 is entered
1 MT buffer of unsolicited result codes defined within this command is flushed to the TE when <mode> 1 or 2 is
entered (OK response shall be given before flushing the codes)
Defined events
The following unsolicited result codes and the corresponding events are defined -
+CGEV: REJECT <PDP_type>, <PDP_addr>
A network request for PDP context activation occurred when the MT was unable to report it to the TE with a
+CRING unsolicited result code and was automatically rejected.
+CGEV: NW REACT <PDP_type>, <PDP_addr>, [<cid>]
The network has requested a context reactivation. The <cid> that was used to reactivate the context is provided
if known to the MT.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 152 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
+CGEV: NW DEACT <PDP_type>, <PDP_addr>, [<cid>]
The network has forced a context deactivation. The <cid> that was used to activate the context is provided if
known to the MT.
+CGEV: ME DEACT <PDP_type>, <PDP_addr>, [<cid>]
The mobile termination has forced a context deactivation. The <cid> that was used to activate the context is
provided if known to the MT.
+CGEV: NW DETACH
The network has forced a PS detach. This implies that all active contexts have been deactivated. These are not
reported separately.
+CGEV: ME DETACH
The mobile termination has forced a PS detach. This implies that all active contexts have been deactivated.
These are not reported separately.
+CGEV: NW CLASS <class>
The network has forced a change of MT class. The highest available class is reported (see +CGCLASS).
+CGEV: ME CLASS <class>
The mobile termination has forced a change of MT class. The highest available class is reported (see
+CGCLASS).
Implementation
Optional.
10.1.19 GPRS network registration status +CGREG
Table 128: CGREG parameter command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CGREG=[<n>]
+CGREG? +CGREG: <n>,<stat>[,<lac>,<ci>[,<AcT>]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CGREG=?
+CGREG: (list of supported <n>s)

Description
The set command controls the presentation of an unsolicited result code +CGREG: <stat> when <n>=1 and there is
a change in the MT's GPRS network registration status, or code +CGREG: <stat>[,<lac>,<ci>[,<AcT>]]
when <n>=2 and there is a change of the network cell.
NOTE. If the GPRS MT also supports circuit mode services, the +CREG command and +CREG: result codes
apply to the registration status and location information for those services.
The read command returns the status of result code presentation and an integer <stat> which shows whether the
network has currently indicated the registration of the MT. Location information elements <lac>, <ci> and
<AcT> are returned only when <n>=2 and MT is registered in the network.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 153 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Defined values
<n>:
0 disable network registration unsolicited result code
1 enable network registration unsolicited result code +CGREG: <stat>
2 enable network registration and location information unsolicited result code +CGREG:
<stat>[,<lac>,<ci>[,<AcT>]]
<stat>: registration status
0 not registered, MT is not currently searching an operator to register to
The UE is in GMM state GMM-NULL or GMM-DEREGISTERED-INITIATED.
The GPRS service is disabled, the UE is allowed to attach for GPRS if requested by the user.
1 registered, home network
The UE is in GMM state GMM-REGISTERED or GMM-ROUTING-AREA-UPDATING-INITIATED
INITIATED on the home PLMN.
2 not registered, but MT is currently trying to attach or searching an operator to register to
The UE is in GMM state GMM-DEREGISTERED or GMM-REGISTERED-INITIATED. The GPRS service is
enabled, but an allowable PLMN is currently not available. The UE will start a GPRS attach as soon as an
allowable PLMN is available.
3 registration denied
The UE is in GMM state GMM-NULL. The GPRS service is disabled, the UE is not allowed to attach for GPRS
if requested by the user.
4 unknown
5 registered, roaming
The UE is in GMM state GMM-REGISTERED or GMM-ROUTING-AREA-UPDATING-INITIATED on a
visited PLMN.
<lac>: string type; two byte location area code in hexadecimal format (e.g. "00C3" equals 195 in decimal)
<ci>: string type; four byte UTRAN/GERAN cell ID in hexadecimal format
<AcT>: access technology of the registered network
0 GSM
1 GSM Compact
2 UTRAN
3 GSM w/EGPRS (see NOTE 1)
4 UTRAN w/HSDPA (see NOTE 2)
5 UTRAN w/HSUPA (see NOTE 2)
6 UTRAN w/HSDPA and HSUPA (see NOTE 2)
NOTE 1: 3GPP TS 44.060 [71] specifies the System Information messages which give the information about
whether the serving cell supports EGPRS.
NOTE 2: 3GPP TS 25.331 [74] specifies the System Information blocks which give the information about whether
the serving cell supports HSDPA or HSUPA.
Implementation
Optional.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 154 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
10.1.20 Select service for MO SMS messages +CGSMS
Table 129: CGSMS parameter command syntax
Command Possible Response(s)
+CGSMS= [<service>] OK
ERROR
+CGSMS? +CGSMS: <service>
+CGSMS=? +CGSMS: (list of currently available <service>s)

Description
The set command is used to specify the service or service preference that the MT will use to send MO SMS messages.
The read command returns the currently selected service or service preference.
The test command is used for requesting information on the currently available services and service preferences.
Defined Values
<service>: a numeric parameter which indicates the service or service preference to be used
0 Packet Domain
1 circuit switched
2 Packet Domain preferred (use circuit switched if GPRS not available)
3 circuit switched preferred (use Packet Domain if circuit switched not available)

Other values are reserved and will result in an ERROR response to the set command.
Implementation
Optional.
10.2 Modem compatibility commands
This subclause describes how existing AT commands, designed for use with a modem, may be used to control a Packet
Domain MT. This is to provide backwards compatibility with existing communications software. For new applications
it is recommended that the Packet Domain-specific commands, described in previous subclauses, be used.
10.2.1 MT originated PDP context activation
In this mode of operation, the MT behaves like an originating modem and accepts the normal V.250 commands
associated with placing and clearing a call. If Packet Domain-specific configuration commands are required, they may
be sent to the MT as part of the modem initialization commands.
10.2.1.1 Request Packet Domain service 'D'
Table 130: D command syntax
Command Possible Response(s)
D*<GPRS_SC>[*[<called_address>]
[*[<L2P>][*[<cid>[,<cid>[,]]]]]]#
CONNECT
ERROR

Description
This command causes the MT to perform whatever actions are necessary to establish communication between the TE
and the external PDN.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 155 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
The V.250 'D' (Dial) command causes the MT to enter the V.250 online data state and, with the TE, to start the
specified layer 2 protocol. The MT shall return CONNECT to confirm acceptance of the command prior to entering the
V.250 online data state. No further commands may follow on the AT command line.
The detailed behaviour after the online data state has been entered is dependent on the PDP type. It is described briefly
in clauses 9 (for IP) of 3GPP TS 27.060[34]. PS attachment and PDP context activation procedures may take place prior
to or during the PDP startup if they have not already been performed using the +CGATT and +CGACT commands.
When the layer 2 protocol has terminated, either as a result of an orderly shut down of the PDP or an error, the MT shall
enter V.250 command state and return the NO CARRIER final result code.
If <called address> is supported and provided, the MT shall automatically set up a virtual call to the specified
address after the PDP context has been activated.
If <L2P> and <cid> are supported, their usage shall be the same as in the +CGDATA command. The +CGDCONT,
+CGQREQ, etc. commands may be used in the modem initialization AT command string to set values for for PDP type,
APN, QoS etc..
If <L2P> is not supported or is supported but omitted, the MT shall use a layer 2 protocol appropriate to the PDP type.
If <cid> is not supported or is supported but omitted, the MT shall attempt to activate the context using:
(a) any information provided by the TE during the PDP startup procedure, e.g. the TE may provide a PDP type
and/or PDP address to the MT,
or, (b) a priori knowledge, e.g. the MT may implement only one PDP type,
or, (c) using the 'Empty PDP type' (TS 24.008). (No PDP address or APN shall be sent in this case and only one
PDP context subscription record shall be present in the HLR for this subscriber.)
This command may be used in both normal and modem compatibility modes.
NOTE: The dial string conforms to the syntax specified in 3GPP TS 22.030 [19].
Defined Values
<GPRS_SC>: (GPRS Service Code) a digit string (value 99) which identifies a request to use the Packet Domain
service
<called_address>: a string that identifies the called party in the address space applicable to the PDP. For
communications software that does not support arbitrary characters in the dial string, a numeric equivalent may
be used. Also, the character comma ',' may be used as a substitute for the character period '.'.

<L2P>: a string which indicates the layer 2 protocol to be used (see +CGDATA command). For communications
software that does not support arbitrary characters in the dial string, the following numeric equivalents shall be
used:
0 NULL (Obsolete)
1 PPP
2 PAD (Obsolete)
3 X25 (Obsolete)
9yyyy M-xxxx
Other values are reserved and will result in an ERROR response
<cid>: a digit string which specifies a particular PDP context definition (see the +CGDCONT and +CGDSCONT
commands).
Implementation
Optional if the +CGDATA command is supported. If the D command is provided, then support for
<called_address>, <L2P> and <cid> are optional. If they are not supported but values are provided by the TE,
the values shall be ignored and this shall not constitute an error.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 156 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
10.2.1.2 Request Packet Domain IP service 'D'
Table 131: D command syntax
Command Possible Response(s)
D*<GPRS_SC_IP>[*<cid>[,<cid>[,]]]# CONNECT
ERROR

Description
This command causes the MT to perform whatever actions are necessary to establish communication between the TE
and the external PDN.
The V.250 'D' (Dial) command causes the MT to enter the V.250 online data state and, with the TE, to start the
specified layer 2 protocol. The MT shall return CONNECT to confirm acceptance of the command prior to entering the
V.250 online data state. No further commands may follow on the AT command line.
The detailed behaviour after the online data state has been entered is described briefly in clause 9, for IP, of 3GPP TS
27.060[34]. GPRS attachment and PDP context activation procedures may take place prior to or during the PDP startup
if they have not already been performed using the +CGATT and +CGACT commands.
When the layer 2 protocol has terminated, either as a result of an orderly shut down of the PDP or an error, the MT shall
enter V.250 command state and return the NO CARRIER final result code.
If <cid> is supported, its usage shall be the same as in the +CGDATA command. The +CGDCONT, +CGQREQ, etc.
commands may be used in the modem initialization AT command string to set values for for PDP type, APN, QoS etc.
If <cid> is not supported or is supported but omitted, the MT shall attempt to activate the context using:
(a) any information provided by the TE during the PDP startup procedure, e.g. the TE may provide a PDP type
and/or PDP address to the MT,
or, (b) a priori knowledge, e.g. the MT may implement only one PDP type,
or, (c) using the 'Empty PDP type' (TS 24.008). (No PDP address or APN shall be sent in this case and only one
PDP context subscription record shall be present in the HLR for this subscriber.)
This command may be used in both normal and modem compatibility modes.
NOTE. The dial string conforms to the syntax specified in 3GPP TS 22.030[19].
Defined Values
<GPRS_SC_IP>: (GPRS Service Code for IP) a digit string (value 98) which identifies a request to use the GPRS
with IP (PDP types IP and PPP)
<cid>: a digit string which specifies a particular PDP context definition (see +CGDCONT command).
Implementation
Optional if the +CGDATA command is supported. If the D command is provided, then support for <cid> is optional.
If it is not supported but a value is provided by the TE, the value shall be ignored and this shall not constitute an error.
10.2.2 Network requested PDP context activation
In this mode of operation, the MT behaves like an answering modem and accepts the normal V.250 commands
associated with answering a call. If Packet Domain-specific configuration commands are required, they may be sent to
the MT as part of the modem initialization commands.
The +CGAUTO command is used to select modem compatibility mode.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 157 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
10.2.2.1 Automatic response to a network request for PDP context activation 'S0'
The V.250 'S0=n' (Automatic answer) command may be used to turn off (n=0) and on (n>0) the automatic response to a
network request for a PDP context activation.
When the 'S0=n' (n>0) command is received, the MT shall attempt to perform a PS attach if it is not already attached.
Failure will result in ERROR being returned to the TE. Subsequently, the MT will announce a network request for PDP
context activation by issuing the unsolicited result code RING to the TE, followed by the intermediate result code
CONNECT. The MT then enters V.250 online data state and follows the same procedure as it would after having
received a +CGANS=1 with no <L2P> or <cid> values specified.
NOTE: The 'S0=n' (n=0) command does not perform an automatic PS detach.
Implementation
Optional.
10.2.2.2 Manual acceptance of a network request for PDP context activation 'A'
The V.250 'A' (Answer) command may be used to accept a network request for a PDP context activation announced by
the unsolicited result code RING. The MT responds with CONNECT, enters V.250 online data state and follows the
same procedure as it would after having received a +CGANS=1 with no <L2P> or <cid> values specified. It is an error
to issue the 'A' command when there is no outstanding network request.
Implementation
Optional.
10.2.2.3 Manual rejection of a network request for PDP context activation 'H'
The V.250 'H' or 'H0' (On-hook) command may be used to reject a network request for PDP context activation
announced by the unsolicited result code RING. The MT responds with OK. It is an error to issue the 'H' command
when there is no outstanding network request.
NOTE: This is an extension to the usage of the 'H' command that is described in ITU-T V.250.
Implementation
Optional.
11 Commands for VGCS and VBS
This clause defines commands that a TE may use to control a VGCS or VBS supporting MT. The requirements for the
VGCS and VBS are included in the following specifications:
- Voice Group Call service (VGCS): GSM 42.068 [55],GSM 43.068 [49],GSM 44.068 [52];
- Voice Broadcast Service (VBS): GSM 42.069 [56],GSM 43.069 [50],GSM 44.069 [53].
It is anticipated that VGCS or VBS supporting MTs will vary widely in functionality.
A comprehensive set of VGCS and VBS-specific commands is defined in clause 11.1 to provide the flexibility needed
by the more complex MT. The commands use the extended information and error message capabilities described in this
specification.
For the simplest MTs, and for backwards compatibility with existing communications software, it is possible to control
access to the VGCS and VBS using existing modem-compatible commands. A special dial-string syntax is defined for
use with the D command. This "modem compatible" mode of operation is described in subclause 11.2.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 158 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
11.1 Commands specific to MTs supporting the VGCS and VBS
11.1.1 Accept an incoming Voice Group or Voice Broadcast Call +CAJOIN
Table 132: CAJOIN parameter command syntax
Command Possible Response(s)
+CAJOIN=<service>, <GId> ,<GCA> +CME ERROR: <err>
CAJOIN=?

Description
The execute command accepts an incoming or ongoing voice group or voice broadcast call.
See command +CALCC to get a list of current voice group or voice broadcast calls.
Defined Values
<GId>: a digit string that specifies the group identification for the incoming voice group or voice broadcast call.
<GCA>: a digit string that specifies the group call area identification for the incoming voice group or voice
broadcast call.
<service> (tele-service):
17 voice group call
18 voice broadcast call
Implementation
Mandatory for a MT supporting AT commands only and VGCS or VBS is implemented.
11.1.2 Reject an incoming Voice Group or Voice Broadcast Call +CAREJ
Table 133: CAREJ parameter command syntax
Command Possible Response(s)
+CAREJ=<service>, <GId>, <GCA> +CME ERROR: <err>
+CAREJ=?

Description
The execute command rejects an incoming voice group or voice broadcast call indicated by RING or +CRING, the
command is applicable as long as the indication is pending.
If the call is once rejected the RING or +CRING indication is not repeated to TE although the call is still running and
notifications for the call are received.
See command +CALCC to get a list of current voice group or voice broadcast calls.
Defined Values
<GId>: a digit string that specifies the group identification for the incoming voice group or voice broadcast call.
<GCA>: a digit string that specifies the group call area identification for the incoming voice group or voice
broadcast call.
<service> (tele-service):

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 159 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
17 voice group call
18 voice broadcast call
Implementation
Mandatory for a MT supporting AT commands only and VGCS or VBS is implemented.
11.1.3 Leave an ongoing Voice Group or Voice Broadcast Call +CAHLD
Table 134: CAHLD parameter command syntax
Command Possible Response(s)
+CAHLD +CME ERROR: <err>
+CAHLD=?

Description
The execute command forces the MT to leave the active voice group or voice broadcast call without terminating it. The
command is only applicable if the MT is in group receive mode. The MT returns to idle mode.
Implementation
Mandatory for a MT supporting AT commands only and VGCS or VBS is implemented.
11.1.4 Talker Access for Voice Group Call +CAPTT
Table 135: CAPTT parameter command syntax
Command Possible Response(s)
+CAPTT=[<mode> [,<time>]] +CME ERROR: <err>
+CAPTT? +CAPTT: <mode>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CAPTT=? +CAPTT: (list of supported <mode>s), (list of
supported <time>s)

Description
The execute command emulates the Push To Talk function for VGCS talker access.
If the parameter <mode> is set to value "0" i.e. "RELEASED" the PTT key is assumed to be released immediately.
If the parameter <mode> is set to value "1" i.e. "PUSHED" the PTT key is assumed to be pushed immediately for the
period of <time> in seconds. If the command execution is repeated before the <time> expires the PTT timer will be
loaded with the new <time> value and the PTT key remains "PUSHED" for the period of new <time> in seconds.
If the parameter <mode> is set to value "2" i.e. "PUSHED" the PTT key is assumed to be pushed immediately for an
infinite period of time and can be released by <mode> value 0.
For <mode>=0 if the parameter <time> is issued it is ignored.
If the PTT timer expires after <time> seconds during <mode> "PUSHED" an unsolicited result code +CAPTT: 0 is issued
to the TE.
The read command returns the current <mode>.
The test command returns values supported as a compound value.
Defined Values
<mode>:
0 status of the PTT key is RELEASED (default value)

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 160 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
1 status of the PTT key is PUSHED for a limited time by <time> in seconds
2 status of the PTT key is PUSHED for an infinite time
<time>:
3..255 this gives the time in seconds to wait before the PTT key is released, default value 10
Implementation
Mandatory for a MT supporting AT commands only and VGCS is implemented.
11.1.5 Voice Group Call Uplink Status Presentation +CAULEV
Table 136: CAULEV parameter command syntax
Command Possible Response(s)
+CAULEV=[<mode>] +CME ERROR: <err>
+CAULEV? +CAULEV: <mode>,[<status>]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CAULEV=? +CAULEV: (list of supported <mode>s)

Description
The set command enables or disables the presentation of uplink access status for an active VGCS call. When enabled
the unsolicited response +CAULEV: <status> is returned from MT to TE whenever the call uplink status changes.
Read command returns the current uplink <status> and the selected <mode>.
The test command returns values supported as a compound value.
Defined Values
<mode>: status of unsolicited result response presentation
0 disabled (default)
1 enabled
<status>: network uplink access status
0 uplink free
1 uplink busy
Implementation
Mandatory for a MT supporting AT commands only and VGCS is implemented.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 161 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
11.1.6 List current Voice Group and Voice Broadcast Calls +CALCC
Table 137: +CALCC action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CALCC=<mode> +CALCC: <GId>,<GCA>,<service>,<stat>,<dir>,
<ack_flag>[,<priority>]
[<CR><LF>+CALCC: <GId>,<GCA>,<service>,
<stat>,<dir>,<ack_flag>[,<priority>]
[...]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CALCC=?
+CALCC: (list of supported <mode>s)

Description
The set command returns
for <mode>=1 the active voice group or voice broadcast call and
for <mode>=0 a list of all current running voice group and voice broadcast calls for which the user has a subscription
and the GId is activated on the SIM. If the command succeeds but no calls are available, OK response is returned.
Defined values
<GId>: a digit string that specifies the group identification of the voice group or voice broadcast call.
<GCA>: a digit string that specifies the group call area of the voice group or voice broadcast call.
<service> (tele-service):
17 voice group call
18 voice broadcast call
<stat> (state of the call):
0 active, i.e. user participating at the call as talker or listener
1 held, the call is running but put to background, notifications ignored
2 incoming (MT call), the user doesn't respond to notifications of this call yet
<dir>:
0 mobile originated (MO) call, the user is the originator of the call
1 mobile terminated (MT) call, the user is not the originator of the call
<ack_flag>: proposes that a predefined confirmation procedure is to be used after the call is ended
0 confirmation procedure is not required
1 confirmation procedure is required
<priority>: optional integer type parameter which identifies the priority level of the voice group or voice
broadcast call, values specified in 3GPP TS 22.067 [54].
Implementation
Optional. Recommended for a MT supporting AT commands only and VGCS or VBS is implemented.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 162 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
11.1.7 Voice Group or Voice Broadcast Call State Attribute Presentation
+CACSP
Table 138: CACCS parameter command syntax
Command Possible Response(s)
+CACSP=[<mode>] +CME ERROR: <err>
+CACSP? +CACSP: <mode>[,<da>,<ua>,<comm>,<oi>]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CACSP=? +CACSP: (list of supported <mode>s)

Description
The set command enables or disables the presentation of unsolicited result response +CACSP:
<da>,<ua>,<comm>,<oi> from MT to TE if the call control state attributes of the active voice group or voice
broadcast call changes.
Read command returns the current call control state attributes <da>,<ua>,<comm>,<oi> and selected <mode>.
The test command returns values supported as a compound value.
Defined Values
<mode>: status of unsolicited result response presentation
0 disabled (default)
1 enabled
<da>: User connection in the downlink
0 not attached
1 attached
<ua>: User connection in the uplink
0 not attached
1 attached
<comm>: The MT assumes that communication with its peer entity is
0 not enabled in both directions
1 enabled in both directions
<oi>: The MT assumes to be
0 not the originator of the call
1 the originator of the call
Implementation
Optional. Recommended for a MT supporting AT commands only and VGCS or VBS is implemented.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 163 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
11.1.8 NCH Support Indication +CANCHEV
Table 139: CAULEV parameter command syntax
Command Possible Response(s)
+CANCHEV=[<mode>] +CME ERROR: <err>
+CANCHEV? +CANCHEV: <status>,<mode>
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CANCHEV=? +CANCHEV: (list of supported <mode>s)

Description
The set command enables or disables the presentation of unsolicited result response +CANCHEV: <status> from
MT to TE if the status of the network NCH support information changes.
Read command returns in parameter <status> the network NCH support information in the selected cell and the selected
<mode>.
The test command returns values supported as a compound value.
Defined Values
<mode>: status of unsolicited result response presentation
0 disabled (default)
1 enabled
<status>: network NCH support information
0 NCH not available
1 NCH available
Implementation
Optional. Recommended for a MT supporting AT commands only and VGCS or VBS is implemented.
11.1.9 Originator to Dispatcher Information +COTDI
Table 140:+COTDI action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+ COTDI
=<message>[,<OTDIE>[,<message>[,<OTDIE>]
]]
+CME ERROR: <err>

+ COTDI? [+ COTDI: <message>,<OTDIE>
[,<message>,<OTDIE>]]
+ COTDI=? + COTDI: (list of supported
<message>s)

Description
This command allows control of the Originator-to-Dispatcher Information and Compressed Originator-to-Dispatcher
Information according to GSM 44.068[52] and GSM 44.069[53].

When <message> and <OTDIE> are both present the string specified in <OTDIE> is included in the corresponding
group or broadcast control <message> as the value part of the Originator-to-Dispatcher Information Element or
Compressed Originator-to-Dispatcher Information Element (as defined in GSM 44.068[52] and GSM 44.069[53]) into

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 164 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
all subsequent messages of type <message>. If parameter <message> is present but parameter <OTDIE> is not
present then the Originator-to-Dispatcher Information Element shall not be present in sub-sequent messages of type
<message>.

The read command returns the content of <message> and of <OTDIE>. If no <OTDIE> is available, no information
text shall be returned.

Test command returns values supported as a compound value.


Defined values

<message>
0 SETUP message containing the outgoing Originator-to-Dispatcher Information Element
1 IMMEDIATE SETUP 2 message containing the outgoing Compressed Originator-to-Dispatcher Information
Element
< OTDIE>: the Originator-to-Dispatcher Information Element or Compressed Originator-to-Dispatcher Information
Element (as defined in GSM 44.068 [52] and GSM 44.069 [53]) in hexadecimal character format (for
hexadecimal format, refer +CSCS).

Implementation
Optional.
11.2 Modem compatibility commands
This sub-clause describes how existing AT commands, designed for use with a modem, may be used to control a VGCS
or VBS supporting MT. This is to provide backwards compatibility with existing communications software.
11.2.1 Request VGCS or VBS service 'D'
Table 141: D command syntax
Command Possible Response(s)
D*<SC
1
>[*<SC
2
>]#<GId>; +CME ERROR: <err>


Description
This Dial command extension is a service request application according to 3GPP TS 22.030 [19]. No further commands
may follow on the AT command line.
Responses
When the call has terminated, either as a result of an orderly termination or an error, the MT shall return the NO
CARRIER final result code.
Possible error responses include +CME ERROR: <err> when error is related to MT functionality. The requested
service, GId and priority level are checked against the subscriptions of the user and the status of the GId stored on the
SIM. In case if no subscription is available for this service, GId or priority level or the GId is deactivated an ERROR or
+CMEE ERROR result code is returned. See +CMEE ERROR extensions for VGCS, VBS and eMLPP in subclause
9.2.
Detailed error report of an unsuccessful originated call can be obtained with command Extended Error Report +CEER
(if implemented).

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 165 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
NOTE. The dial string conforms to the syntax specified in 3GPP TS 22.030 [19].
Defined Values
<SC
1
>: Service Code is a digit string which identifies a request to use
value 17 Voice Group Call Service
value 18 Voice Broadcast Service
<SC
2
>: Service Code is a digit string which identifies a request to use eMLPP priority . Service Code values for
different priority levels are specified in 3GPP TS 22.030 [19]
<GId>: a digit string that specifies the group identification of a called party.
Implementation
Mandatory for a MT supporting AT commands only and VGCS or VBS is implemented.
11.2.2 Termination of an Voice Group or Voice Broadcast Call 'H'
The V.250 'H' or 'H0' (On-hook) command may be used to terminate an ongoing voice group or voice broadcast call.
The MT responds with OK. It is an error to issue the 'H' command when there is no outstanding network request.
It is an error to issue the 'H' command if the user is in group receive mode or the user is not the originator of the call and
a ERROR or +CME ERROR result code is returned to the TE.
NOTE: This is an extension to the usage of the 'H' command that is described in ITU-T V.250.
Implementation
Mandatory for a MT supporting AT commands only and VGCS or VBS is implemented.
11.3 SIM Commands supporting the VGCS and VBS
11.3.1 VGCS subscriptions and GId status +CGCS
Table 142: +CGCS action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CGCS=<GId>,<status> +CME ERROR: <err>
+CGCS? +CGCS: <GId>,<status><CR><LF>
[+CGCS: <GId>,<status><CR><LF>
[...]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CGCS=? +CGCS: (list of supported <GId>s), (list of
supported <status>s)
Description
This command works with SIM Card and when the GSM Application is selected in UICC. Function with USIM is for
further study. The set command is used to edit the status of the GId EF
VGCSS
on the SIM. The read command returns
all subscribed GIds in EF
VGCS
and their status in EF
VGCSS
from the SIM.

Defined values
<GId> integer type, group Id as specified in 3GPP TS 22.030 [19]
<status>: integer type, value
0 deactivated
1 activated

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 166 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Implementation
Mandatory for a MT supporting AT commands only and supporting VGCS.

11.3.2 VBS subscriptions and GId status +CBCS
Table 143: +CBCS action command syntax
Command Possible response(s)
+CBCS=<GId>,<status> +CME ERROR: <err>
+CBCS? +CBCS: <GId>,<status><CR><LF>
[+CBCS: <GId>,<status><CR><LF>
[...]]
+CME ERROR: <err>
+CBCS=? +CBCS: (list of supported <GId>s),(list of
supported <status>s)
Description
This command works with SIM Card and when the GSM Application is selected in UICC. Function with USIM is for
further study. The set command is used to edit the status of the GId EF
VBSS
on the SIM. The read command returns all
subscribed GIds in EF
VBS
and their status in EF
VBSS
from the SIM.

Defined values
<GId> integer type, group Id as specified in 3GPP TS 22.030 [19]
<status>: integer type, value
0 deactivated
1 activated
Implementation
Mandatory for a MT supporting AT commands only and supporting VBS.
11.4 Informative examples
As supplementary services may be invoked and controlled using dial command according to 3GPP TS 22.030 [19].
An example of voice group call service request usage:
ATD*17*753#500; (originate voice group call with the priority level 3)
OK (voice group call setup was successful)


ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 167 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Annex A (normative):
Summary of commands from other standards
Summary of ITU-T Recommendation V.250 [14] commands applicable to GSM/UMTS:
Table A.1: V.250 commands applicable to GSM/UMTS
Name V.250
subclause
Description Subclauses in the
present document
&C 6.2.8 Circuit 109 (Received line signal detector) Behaviour 4.3
&D 6.2.9 Circuit 108 (Data terminal ready) Behaviour 4.3
&F 6.1.2 Set to Factory-defined Configuration 5.8/ 3
+DR 6.6.2 Data Compression Reporting 6.20
+DS 6.6.1 Data Compression 6.20
+GCAP 6.1.9 Request Complete Capabilities List 5.8
+GCI 6.1.10 Country of Installation 5.8
+GMI 6.14 Request Manufacturer Identification 5.8/ 5.1
+GMM 6.1.5 Request Model Identification 5.8/ 5.2
+GMR 6.1.6 Request Revision Identification 5.8/ 5.3
+GOI 6.1.8 Request Global Object Identification 5.8
+GSN 6.1.7 Request Product Serial Number Identification 5.8/ 5.4
+ICF 6.2.11 DTE-DCE Character Framing 4.3
+IFC 6.2.12 DTE-DCE Local Flow Control 4.3
+ILRR 6.2.13 DTE-DCE Local Rate Reporting 4.3
+IPR 6.2.10 Fixed DTE Rate 4.3
A 6.3.5 Answer 6.19/ 6.6
D 6.3.1 Dial 6.1-6.4/ 6.6
E 6.2.4 Command Echo 4.3
H 6.3.6 Hook Control 6.19/ 6.5/ 6.6
I 6.1.3 Request Identification Information 5.8
L 6.3.13 Monitor Speaker Loudness 6.19
M 6.3.14 Monitor Speaker Mode 6.19
O 6.3.7 Return to Online Data State 6.19
P 6.3.3 Select Pulse Dialling 6.19
Q 6.2.5 Result Code Suppression 4.3
S0 6.3.8 Automatic Answer 6.19
S10 6.3.12 Automatic Disconnect Delay 6.19
S3 6.2.1 Command Line Termination Character 4.3
S4 6.2.2 Response Formatting Character 4.3
S5 6.2.3 Command Line Editing Character 4.3
S6 6.3.9 Pause Before Blind Dialling 6.19
S7 6.3.10 Connection Completion Timeout 6.19
S8 6.3.11 Comma Dial Modifier Time 6.19
T 6.3.2 Select Tone Dialling 6.19
V 6.2.6 DCE Response Format 4.3/ 3/ 4.1/ 4.2
X 6.2.7 Result Code Selection and Call Progress Monitoring Control 4.3
Z 6.1.1 Reset To Default Configuration 5.8

The use of ITU-T Recommendation V.42 error control protocol is not specified for GSM/UMTS, but if a manufacturer
chooses to implement it over transparent data service, +E prefixed commands of V.250 [14] shall be used.
ITU-T T.31 [11] and T.32 [12] may be used as facsimile TA-TE protocols without deletions or additions to the
command set.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 168 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
TIA IS-99 [15] commands referenced in the present document:
Table A.2: TIA IS-99 commands in the present document
Command IS-99
subclause
Description Subclause in
the present
document
+CBC 5.6.5 Battery Charge 8.4
+CGMI 5.6.10 Request Manufacturer Identification 5.1
+CGMM 5.6.10 Request Model Identification 5.2
+CGMR 5.6.10 Request Revision Identification 5.3
+CGSN 5.6.10 Request Product Serial Number Identification 5.4
+CRC 5.6.7 Cellular Result Codes 6.11

TIA IS-135 [16] commands referenced in the present document:
Table A.3: TIA IS-135 commands in the present document
Command IS-135
subclause
Description Subclause in
the present
document
+CBC 4.1.24 Battery Charge 8.4
+CRC 4.1.29 Cellular Result Codes 6.11
+CSQ 4.1.31 Signal Quality 8.5

PCCA STD-101[17] commands referenced in the present document:
Table A.4: PCCA STD-101 commands in the present document
Command STD-101
subclause
Description Subclause in
the present
document
+WS46 5.2.4.6 WDS-side Stack Selection 5.9


ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 169 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Annex B (normative):
Summary of result codes
V.250 [14] result codes which can be used in GSM/UMTS and codes defined in the present document:
Table B.1: Result codes
Verbose result code
(V.250 command V1 set)
Numeric
(V0 set)
Type Description
+CALV as verbose unsolicited refer subclause 8.16
+CCCM: <ccm> as verbose unsolicited refer subclause 7.16
+CCWA: <number>,<type>
,<class>[,<alpha>]
as verbose unsolicited refer subclause 7.12
+CCWV as verbose unsolicited refer subclause 8.28
+CDEV: <elem>,<text> as verbose unsolicited refer subclause 8.10
+CDIP:<number>,<type>[,<
subaddr>,<satype>]
as verbose unsolicited refer subclause 7.9
+CIEV: <ind>,<value> as verbose unsolicited refer subclause 8.10
+CKEV: <key>,<press> as verbose unsolicited refer subclause 8.10
+CLAV: <code> as verbose unsolicited refer subclause 8.
+CLIP: <number>
,<type>[,<subaddr>
,<satype>[,<alpha>]]
as verbose unsolicited refer subclause 7.6
+CME ERROR: <err> as verbose final refer subclause 9.2
+COLP: <number>
,<type>[,<subaddr>
,<satype>[,<alpha>]]
as verbose intermediate refer subclause 7.8
+CR: <type> as verbose intermediate refer subclause 6.9
+CREG: <stat>[,<lac>
,<ci>]
as verbose unsolicited refer subclause 7.2
+CRING: <type> as verbose unsolicited refer subclause 6.11
+CSSI: <code1>
[,<index>]
as verbose intermediate refer subclause 7.17
+CSSU: <code2>
[,<index>[,<number>,
<type>[,<subaddr>,
<satype>]]]
as verbose unsolicited refer subclause 7.17
+CTZV: <tz> as verbose unsolicited refer subclause 8.40
+CUSD: <m>[,<str>,<dcs>] as verbose unsolicited refer subclause 7.15
+CUUS1I: <messageI> as verbose intermediate refer subclause 7.25
+CUUS1U: <messageU> as verbose unsolicited refer subclause 7.25
+DR: <type> as verbose intermediate refer subclause 6.13
+ILRR: <rate> as verbose intermediate refer subclause 4.3
BUSY 7 final busy signal detected
CONNECT 1 intermediate connection has been established
CONNECT <text> manufacturer
specific
intermediate as CONNECT but manufacturer specific
<text> gives additional information (e.g.
connection data rate)
ERROR 4 final command not accepted
NO ANSWER 8 final connection completion timeout
NO CARRIER 3 final connection terminated
NO DIALTONE 6 final no dialtone detected
OK 0 final acknowledges execution of a command line
RING 2 unsolicited incoming call signal from network

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 170 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
NOTE: From v6.2.0 onwards, ATV0 numeric result codes 5, 6, 7 for NO DIALTONE, BUSY and NO ANSWER
respectively, have been replaced by numeric result codes 6, 7, 8 respectively, to be aligned with the
values listed in ITU-T V.250 (previously V.25ter).


ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 171 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Annex C (informative):
Commands from TIA IS-101
C.1 Introduction
The "Voice Control Interim Standard for Asynchronous DCE", TIA IS-101, contains some commands that are useful
when passing audio "data" (that is, data which represents audio information) between the computer and the TA.
Some of the following subclauses describe commands from IS-101 which are central to this TA application. However,
with the exception of necessary extensions, these descriptions are not intended to replace the definitions found in
IS-101. Other novel commands from the interim standard are not included because they are peripheral to TA operation.
NOTE 1: IS-101 also uses V.250 [14] AT commands, but these are not mentioned here.
The standard specifies the following modes:
- command mode, where there is no transfer of audio "data" between the TA and the computer. In command
mode, the computer is neither sending audio data to the TA nor receiving audio data from the TA.
- transmit mode, where audio "data" is being transferred from the computer to the TA. No audio "data" is
transferred from the TA to the computer in this state. A transition back to command mode occurs when an
embedded command indicates "end of play" or "flush data", or an inactivity timer times out.
- receive mode, where audio "data" is being transferred from the TA to the computer. No audio "data" is
transferred from the computer to the TA in this state. A transition back to command mode occurs when any
command is sent from the computer, or an inactivity timer times out. During the receive mode, the TA embeds
result codes into the audio "data". These result codes indicate pertanent events such as "silence detected", "busy
detected", and so on.
Strictly, the standard specifies another mode (translation), but this is not directly of interest here.
NOTE 2: The TA "knows" the type of an incoming call (whether it is voice, data, fax, whatever), and certain POTS
events cannot occur. Hence some standard result codes for indication of events and discrimination of call
type are unnecessary.
There are three possible levels of service:
- a TA supporting level A performs the following operations and detects the following events: audio transmit,
audio receive, DTMF detection, DTMF generation and single tone generation. The following indications are
supported:
Event Description Handset state
3 ring idle
4 DTMF received idle
5 receive buffer overrun receive
6 unsolicited fax request idle
8 phone on/off hook idle
9 presumed hangup receive
10 presumed end of message receive
18 ringback idle
19 busy idle
23 playback buffer underrun transmit

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 172 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
25 fax or data request acknowledged idle
- a TA supporting level B performs the operations and events of level A, and also supports DTMF detection while
in the transmit state.
- a TA supporting level C performs the operations and events of level B, and also supports double DTMF tone
generation.
Since DTMF detection and generation cannot be guaranteed over current digital networks, it follows that none of the
three levels of service can be supported.
C.2 Commands
C.2.1 Select mode +FCLASS
This command puts the TA into a particular mode of operation (data, fax, voice etc.). This causes the TA to process
information in a manner suitable for that type of information (rather than for other types of information). The values and
meanings of parameter <n> are specified in the following table.
<n> Mode
0 data
1 fax class 1 (TIA-578-A)
1.0 fax class 1 (ITU-T T.31 [11])
2 fax (manufacturer specific)
2.0 fax class 2 (ITU-T T.32 [12] and TIA-592)
3...7 reserved for other fax modes
8 voice
9...15 reserved for other voice modes
16..79 reserved
80 VoiceView (Radish)
81..255 reserved
Table C.1: +FCLASS
Command Return
+FCLASS=<n>
+FCLASS? <n>
+FCLASS=?
(list of supported <n>s)

Voice mode is of particular interest here, and has an additional result code +VCON. Specifically, +VCON indicates that
the TA is entering the voice command mode and there is a voice connection to at least one audio input or output. This
presupposes that some mechanism has previously initiated a connection to that audio I/O.
C.2.2 Buffer threshold setting +VBT
This refers to integers <lo> and <hi> that indicate levels within the TA transmit buffer at which flow control is
asserted and deasserted. The buffer is used for averaging out the irregular timing of data from the computer, so that the
data becomes synchronous and may be sent to some audio device.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 173 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Table C.2: +VBT
Command Return
+VBT=<lo>,<hi>
+VBT? <lo>,<hi>
+VBT=?
(list of supported <lo>s),(list of supported <hi>s),(buffer size)

C.2.3 Calling number ID presentation +VCID
The command refers to an integer that allows a called party to enable or disable (<n>=0) the reporting of the ID of
calling parties, and specifies the method of presentation of the ID. This is basically the same as GSM/UMTS
supplementary service CLIP (Calling Line Identification Presentation). The presentation may be either formatted
(<n>=1) or unformatted (<n>=2):
- Formatted presentation : data items are reported in the form of <tag>=<value> pairs.
<tag> <value>
DATE MMDD (month, day)
TIME HHMM (hour, minute)
NMBR calling number or P or O (P = number is private, O = number is unavailable)
NAME subscription listing name
MESG data from other (unknown) tags
- Unformatted presentation : here the data is presented in ASCII hex as printable numbers.
Table C.3: +VCID
Command Return
+VCID=<n>
+VCID? <n>
+VCID=? (0-2)

C.2.4 Receive gain selection +VGR
This refers to the amplification by the TA of audio samples sent from the TA to the computer. The command operates
on an integer <n>, range 0...255. Values larger than 128 indicate a larger gain than nominal. Values less than 128
indicate a smaller gain than nominal. The entire range of 0...255 does not have to be provided. A value of zero implies
the use of automatic gain control by the TA.
Table C.4: +VGR
Command Return
+VGR=<n>
+VGR? <n>
+VGR=?
(list of supported <n>s)

C.2.5 Transmit gain selection +VGT
This refers to the amplification by the TA of audio samples sent from the computer to the TA. The command operates
on an integer <n>, range 0...255. Values larger than 128 indicate a larger gain than nominal. Values less than 128

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 174 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
indicate a smaller gain than nominal. The entire range of 0...255 does not have to be provided. A value of zero implies
the uses of automatic gain control by the TA.
Table C.5: +VGT
Command Return
+VGT=<n>
+VGT? <n>
+VGT=?
(list of supported <n>s)

C.2.6 Initialise voice parameters +VIP
This recalls manufacturer determined settings <n> of voice parameters. The command is write only. The effect of the
command is manufacturer specific.
Table C.6: +VIP
Command Return
+VIP=<n>
+VIP=?
(list of supported <n>s)

C.2.7 Inactivity timer +VIT
This refers to the value of the inactivity timer in the TA. It is used to monitor activity on the connection between the
computer and the TA when the computer is in "transmit" mode and sending audio data to the TA. When the connection
has been inactive for the time set by this command, the TA leaves "transmit" mode and reverts to command mode. An
integer <n> different than zero implies a time of <n>/10 seconds. A value of zero disables the timer.
Table C.7: +VIT
Command Return
+VIT=<n>
+VIT? <n>
+VIT=?
(list of supported <n>s)

C.2.8 Line selection +VLS
This determines the selection of sources and destinations of audio samples. An integer is used to label a particular
combination of sources and destinations. The integer is defined in an entry in IS-101 which assumes as a model a TA, a
local phone and a phone line. Two additional "manufacturer specific" configurations (16,17) are defined.
- label=0: this is the idle state - the phone is not connected to the radio network and no audio paths are used.
- label=1: the phone is connected to the radio network and no audio paths involving the internal microphone or
internal loudspeaker are selected. This allows the computer to transmit audio data over the radio transmitter by
selecting "transmit mode":
Table C.8: +VLS label 1a
loudspeaker computer i/p transmit stage
microphone -->
computer o/p --> *
receiver stage -->


ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 175 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
This also allows the computer to receive audio data from the radio receiver by selecting "receive mode":
Table C.9: +VLS label 1b
loudspeaker computer i/p transmit stage
microphone -->
computer o/p -->
receiver stage --> *

- label=4: the phone is not connected to the radio network but there is an audio path to the internal speaker. This
allows the computer to play sound by selecting "transmit mode".
Table C.10: +VLS label 4
loudspeaker computer i/p transmit stage
microphone -->
computer o/p --> *
receiver stage -->

- label=6: the phone is not connected to the radio network but there is an audio path to the internal microphone.
This allows the computer to record sound by selecting "receive mode".
Table C.11: +VLS label 6
loudspeaker computer i/p transmit stage
microphone --> *
computer o/p -->
receiver stage -->

- label=7: the phone is connected to the radio network. The internal microphone is connected to the radio
transmitter. The radio receiver is connected to the internal loudspeaker. This allows the computer to enable
normal phone operation (a human holding a conversation) by selecting command mode.
Table C.12: +VLS label 7
loudspeaker computer i/p transmit stage
microphone --> *
computer o/p -->
receiver stage --> *

Table C.13: +VLS
Command Return
+VLS=<n> +VCON
+VLS? <n>
+VLS=? complex; refer IS-101

+VCON is returned if an audio path is established or if a connection is made to the radio network.
Manufacturer specific extension (reserved as such by IS-101)
- label=16: the phone is connected to the radio network. There is a path to the internal microphone, which is also
connected to the radio transmitter. There is a path to the radio receiver, which is also connected to the internal
loudspeaker. This allows the computer to record the sum of transmitted and received audio by selecting "receive
mode".

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 176 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Table C.14: +VLS label 16
loudspeaker computer i/p transmit stage
microphone --> * *
computer o/p -->
receiver stage --> * *

- label=17: the phone is connected to the radio system and there is a path to the internal loudspeaker and to the
radio transmitter. This allows the computer to simultaneously play sound and send audio over the radio by
selecting "transmit mode".
Table C.15: +VLS label 17
loudspeaker computer i/p transmit stage
microphone -->
computer o/p --> * *
receiver stage -->

C.2.9 Receive data state +VRX
This action command causes the TA to get audio data from a source determined by the +VLS command, and send it to
the computer. Once the datastream has started, any result codes will be embedded in the data and shielded using the
normal <DLE> methods. The receive process is terminated when the computer sends any command to the TA, or by
time-out of the inactivity timer. The command is write only.
Table C.16: +VRX
Command Return
+VRX CONNECT

C.2.10 Select compression method +VSM
This selects the voice compression method <n1>, the voice sampling rate <n2>, the silence compression sensitivity
<n3>, and a parameter related to silence expansion <n4>. There are several choices of compression method. IS-101
does not specify methods, but here is a list of some usual compression methods:
Name Communications system
GSM/full-rate GSM
GSM/half-rate GSM
ADPCM/G.721 DECT, CT2
ADPCM/G.723 DECT, CT2
ADPCM/G.726 DECT, CT2
ADPCM/G.727 DECT, CT2
SIGNED PCM POTS
Table C.17: +VSM
Command Return
+VSM=<n1>,<n2>,<n3>,<n4>
+VSM? <n1>,<n2>,<n3>,<n4>
+VSM=? complex; refer IS-101

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 177 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8

NOTE: A value of <n3>=0 implies no silence compression sensitivity. A value of <n4>=0 implies no silence
expansion.
C.2.11 DTMF and tone generation +VTS
This command allows the transmission of DTMF tones and arbitrary tones (see note). These tones may be used (for
example) when announcing the start of a recording period. The command is write only. In this profile of commands,
this command does not operate in data or fax modes of operation (+FCLASS=0,1,2-7).
NOTE 1: D is used only for dialling.
The string parameter of the command consists of combinations of the following separated by commas:
1. <DTMF>. A single ASCII character in the set 0-9, #,*,A-D. This is interpreted as a single ACSII character whose
duration is set by the +VTD command.
NOTE 2: In GSM this operates only in voice mode.
2. [<tone1>,<tone2>,<duration>]. This is interpreted as a dual tone of frequencies <tone1> and <tone2>,
lasting for a time <duration> (in 10 ms multiples).
NOTE 3: This does not operate in GSM.
3. {<DTMF>,<duration>}. This is interpreted as a DTMF tone of different duration from that mandated by the
+VTD command.
NOTE 4: In GSM this operates only in voice mode.
Table C.18: +VTS
Command Return
+VTS=as above

+VTS=? (list of supported <tone1>s),(list of supported <tone2>s)
,(list of supported <duration>s)

C.2.12 Tone duration +VTD
This refers to an integer <n> that defines the length of tones emitted as a result of the +VTS command. This does not
affect the D command. A value different than zero causes a tone of duration <n>/10 seconds. The value zero causes a
"manufacturer specific" value.
Table C.19: +VTD
Command Return
+VTD=<n>
+VTD? <n>
+VTD=?
(list of supported <n>s)

NOTE: In GSM/UMTS the value of tone duration is preset and cannot be altered.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 178 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
C.2.13 Transmit data state +VTX
This action command causes the TA to receive audio data from the computer and send it to a destination determined by
the +VLS command. Once the audio datastream has started, commands to the TA shall be embedded in the data stream,
and shielded using the normal <DLE> methods. The transmit process is terminated by the use of embedded commands
or by the time-out of an inactivity timer. It is recommended that the TA has a buffer to allow the TA to convert
potentially bursty data from the computer into synchronous data for "transmission". The command is write only.
Table C.20: +VTX
Command Return
+VTX CONNECT


ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 179 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Annex D (informative):
Bibliography
Informative references:
1) IrDA Serial Infrared Physical Layer Specification.
IrDA Serial Infrared MAC and Link Protocol.
IrDA Serial Infrared Link Access Protocol.
2) PCCA STD-101 Annex I: Data Transmission Systems and Equipment - Serial Asynchronous
Automatic Dialling and Control for Character Mode DCE on Wireless Data Services - Annex I:
Command Extensions for Analog Cellular Data Modems.
3) TIA IS-101 Facsimile Digital Interfaces - Voice Control Interim Standard for Asynchronous DCE.
4) TIA-578-A Facsimile Digital Interfaces - Asynchronous Facsimile DCE Control Standard, Service
Class 1.
5) TIA-592 Facsimile Digital Interfaces - Asynchronous Facsimile DCE Control Standard, Service
Class 2.
6) TIA-617 Data Transmission Systems and Equipment - In-Band DCE Control.
7) ITU-T Recommendation V.80: In-band DCE control and synchronous data modes for
asynchronous DTE.

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 180 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Annex E (informative):
Mobile originated alternating voice/data call example
Figure E.1 illustrates the possible transitions in MO BS 61 call. Responses and result codes generated by TA are in bold
face. In this example, data part of the call is asynchronous non-transparent 9600 bps service.
VOICE
ATD (or ATA)
remote initiated
in-call modification
successful
AT+CHUP
(or ATH
or drop DTR )
remote
hangup
DATA
remote
hangup
(V.24 circuit
109 ON)
OFF-LINE
TA sets +CMOD=0
AT+CBST=7,0,1
OK
AT+COLP=1; +CR=1; +DR=1; +ILRR=1
OK
AT+CMOD=2; +FCLASS=0
OK
OFF-LINE
success
+COLP: +35812345,145
OK
connection failure
NO CARRIER
AT+CEER
+CEER: failure cause
OK
other possible failure codes
BUSY/NO ANSWER/ERROR
in-call modification success
+CR: REL ASYNC
+DR: NONE
+ILRR: 19200
CONNECT 9600
in-call modification failure
ERROR
AT+CEER
+CEER: failure cause
OK
+CR: REL ASYNC
+DR: NONE
+ILRR: 19200
CONNECT 9600
AT+CHUP
OK OK
NO CARRIER NO CARRIER
ATD12345; ATD12345
RLP negotiation failure
+COLP: +35812345,145
+CR: REL ASYNC
NO CARRIER
success
+COLP: +35812345,145
+CR: REL ASYNC
+DR: NONE
+ILRR: 19200
CONNECT 9600
ATH (or drop DTR)
in-call modification success
OK
remote initiated
in-call modification
successful
in-call modification failure
ERROR
AT+CEER
+CEER: failure cause
OK
OK

Figure E.1: MO BS 61 call

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 181 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Annex F (informative):
Mobile terminated voice followed by data call example
Figure F.1 illustrates the possible transitions in MT BS 81 call. Responses and result codes generated by TA are in bold
face. In this example, data part of the call is asynchronous non-transparent 9600 bps service.
VOICE
ATD (or ATA)
remote initiated
in-call modification
successful
AT+CHUP
(or ATH
or drop DTR)
remote
hangup
DATA
remote
hangup
(V.24 circuit
109 ON)
OFF-LINE
TA sets +CMOD=0
AT+CLIP=1; +CR=1; +DR=1; +ILRR=1; +CRC=1
OK
+CRING: VOICE/REL ASYNC
+CLIP: +35812345,145
AT+CMOD=3; +FCLASS=0; A
OFF-LINE
success
OK
connection failure
NO CARRIER
AT+CEER
+CEER: failure cause
OK
general failure
ERROR
in-call modification success
+CR: REL ASYNC
+DR: NONE
+ILRR: 19200
CONNECT 9600
in-call modification failure
ERROR
AT+CEER
+CEER: failure cause
OK
+CR: REL ASYNC
+DR: NONE
+ILRR: 19200
CONNECT 9600
ATH
(or AT+CHUP
or drop DTR)
OK OK
NO CARRIER
NO CARRIER

Figure F.1: MT BS 81 call

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 182 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Annex G (informative):
Voice call example
Figure G.1 illustrates the possible transitions in both MT and MO TS 11 calls. Responses and result codes generated by
TA are in bold face.
VOICE call active
AT+CHUP
(or ATH
or drop DTR)
remote
hangup
AT+CLIP=1; +CRC=1
OK
+CRING: VOICE
+CLIP: +35812345,145
ATA
MT
success
OK
connection failure
NO CARRIER
AT+CEER
+CEER: failure cause
OK
remote busy
BUSY
general failure
ERROR
OK NO CARRIER
AT+COLP=1
OK
ATD12345;
MO with COLP
AT+COLP=0
OK
ATD12345;
MO without COLP
connection failure
NO CARRIER
AT+CEER
+CEER: failure cause
OK
success
+COLP: +35812345,145
OK
(remote ring or
other network
generated tones)
general failure
ERROR
call setup started
OK
connection failure
NO CARRIER
AT+CEER
+CEER: failure cause
OK
(no indication
on successful
call setup)

Figure G.1: TS 11 calls

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 183 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
Annex H (informative):
Change History

TSG TDoc CR R
E
V
PH CAT SUBJECT WORKITEM NEW
_VERS
T#4 TP-
99118
New Creation of 3GPP 27.007 v3.0.0 out of GSM 07.07 v7.2.0 3.0.0
T#4 TP-
99124
001 R99 A Additional result codes for +CLIP +CCWA TEI 3.1.0
T#4 TP-
99124
002 R99 B ECSD additions EDGE 3.1.0
T#4 TP-
99124
003 R99 B ECSD asymmetry (new command +CHSA) EDGE 3.1.0
T#4 TP-
99146
004 R99 A Syntax error in +CHSN command TEI 3.1.0
T#4 TP-
99146
005 R99 A Moving AT commands to 07.07 for 07.60 handover to SMG3 / 3GPP
TSG CN WG3
GPRS 3.1.0
T#5 TP-
99177
006 R99 D ECSD AT command correction EDGE 3.2.0
T#5 TP-
99177
007 R99 B Alarm functionality TEI 3.2.0
T#5 TP-
99177
008 R99 B Phonebook storage TEI 3.2.0
T#5 TP-
99177
009 R99 B Time Zone TEI 3.2.0
T#5 TP-
99177
010 R99 B Additional result code for +CSSN TEI 3.2.0
T#5 TP-
99177
011 R99 B New command for setting of Date format TEI 3.2.0
T#5 TP-
99177
012 R99 B New command for Silent mode TEI 3.2.0
T#5 TP-
99177
013 R99 B New command for setting of Time format TEI 3.2.0
T#5 TP-
99177
014 R99 B GSM 400 Spectrum update GSM 400 3.2.0
T#5 TP-
99177
015 R99 A AT command - Request GPRS service 'D' GPRS 3.2.0
T#6 TP-
99237
016 R99 F Clarification to result codes for +CLIP +CCWA TEI 3.3.0
T#6 TP-
99237
017 R99 B AT command for Frame Tunnelling Mode (FTM) Frame
Tunnelling
Mode
3.3.0
T#6 TP-
99237
018 R99 B New AT command for application protocols activation TEI 3.3.0
T#6 TP-
99237
022 R99 B Add new AT command (+CDIP) to inform the called line identification TEI 3.3.0
T#6 TP-
99237
020 R99 C Packet Domain ATD command syntax GPRS 3.3.0
T#6 TP-
99237
021 R99 B Additional parameter for +CBST TEI 3.3.0
T#6 TP-
99237
019 R99 B AT-commands for Enhanced QoS Support management Enhanced QoS
Support in
GPRS
3.3.0
T#7 TP-
000024
024 R99 F Deletion of the AT+CPROT? read command TEI 3.4.0
T#7 TP-
000024
025 R99 F Adaptations for UMTS TEI 3.4.0
T#7 TP-
000024
026 R99 D References to ASCI Specifications ASCI 3.4.0
T#7 TP-
000024
027 R99 D Abbreviations related to ASCI ASCI 3.4.0
T#7 TP-
000024
028 R99 B Priority indication in +CLCC, List Current Calls ASCI 3.4.0
T#7 TP-
000024
029 R99 B Indication of priority, sub-address, sub-address type and TS 91/TS92 in
+CRC, Cellular Result Codes
ASCI 3.4.0
T#7 TP-
000024
030 R99 B Commands for ASCI ASCI 3.4.0

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 184 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
T#7 TP-
000024
031 R99 B Commands for eMLPP eMLPP 3.4.0
T#7 TP-
000024
032 R99 B Example for usage of priority eMLPP 3.4.0
T#8 TP-
000073
033 R99 B +CSDF,+CCLK and +CALA(4 digits for year field) TEI 3.5.0
T#8 TP-
000073
034 R99 F APN presentation TEI 3.5.0
T#8 TP-
000073
035 R99 F +CAJOIN also serves to join an ongoing group or a broadcast call ASCI 3.5.0
T#8 TP-
000073
036 R99 F +CAULEV, the uplink status presentation in a Voice Group Call ASCI 3.5.0
T#8 TP-
000073
037 R99 F CME ERROR extensions for ASCI Commands ASCI 3.5.0
T#8 TP-
000073
038 R99 F Correction of the description of the +CRC ASCI 3.5.0
T#8 TP-
000073
039 R99 F Definition of the abbreviation of MT ASCI 3.5.0
T#8 TP-
000073
040 R99 F Packet Domain QoS AT-commands TEI 3.5.0
T#9 TP-
000143
041 R99 F TE software implementations must take account of extra parameters TEI 3.6.0
T#9 TP-
000143
042 R99 F APN presentation TEI 3.6.0
T#9 TP-
000144
043 R00 B Introduction of a new AT command +CUUS1 to manage User-to-User
Information element
ASCI 4.0.0
T#9 TP-
000144
044 R00 B Indication of priority and/or sub-address in the unsolicited result code
CCWA
ASCI 4.0.0
T#9 TP-
000144
045 R00 B eMLPP SIM Commands ASCI 4.0.0
T#9 TP-
000144
046 R00 B VBS, VGCS SIM Commands ASCI 4.0.0
T#9 TP-
000144
047 R00 A Extension of dial command for VBS and VGCS ASCI 4.0.0
T#9 TP-
000144
048 R00 A Introduction of a new AT command +COTDI to manage Originator-to-
dispatcher information element
ASCI 4.0.0
T#11 TP-
010028
053 Rel-4 A Clarification of the specification to incorporate UICC/USIM references TI-ATC 4.1.0
T#11 TP-
010028
054 Rel-4 F Update the AT command, +CPBS, that select the phonebooks in the
SIM/UICC
TI-ATC 4.1.0
T#11 TP-
010028
055 Rel-4 F Correction of GSM references TI-ATC 4.1.0
T#11 TP-
010028
056 Rel-4 F Update the AT commands that access the PLMN preferred list in the
SIM/UICC
TI-ATC 4.1.0
T#11 TP-
010028
057 Rel-4 F Update of phonebook AT commands, +CBBS,+CPBR, +CPBF and
+CPBW, to access the hidden phonebook entries
TI-ATC 4.1.0
T#11 TP-
010028
058 Rel-4 A Addition of explicit subscribed value to QoS command TI-ATC 4.1.0
T#11 TP-
010028
059 Rel-4 A Corresponding GMM states for +CGREG command TI-ATC 4.1.0
T#11 TP-
010028
060 Rel-4 F Definition of "class C in GPRS and circuit switched alternate mode" TI-ATC 4.1.0
T#12 TP-
010127
061 Rel-4 A Aligning command AT+CSNS with changes introduced to single
numbering scheme
TEI4 4.2.0
T#12 TP-
010127
064 Rel-4 A Inclusion of multimedia values to command AT+CBST TEI4 4.2.0
T#12 TP-
010127
066 Rel-4 A Modification to Request Packet Domain service 'D' command TEI4 4.2.0
T#12 TP-
010127
068 Rel-4 A Inclusion of IPv6 and removal of X.25 and OSPIH <PDP_type> values TEI4 4.2.0
T#14 TP-
010269
070 1 Rel-4 A Obsolete +CGCLOSP and corrections due to IHOSS and OSP removal TI-ATC 4.3.0
T#14 TP-
010269
072 Rel-4 A Obsolete +CGCLPAD and correstions due to X.25 removal TI-ATC 4.3.0
T#14 TP-
010269
074 Rel-4 A Clarifications to AT commands used with circuit swiched data TI-ATC 4.3.0
T#14 TP-
010269
076 Rel-4 A Correction in the +CGACT command explanation TI-ATC 4.3.0
T#14 TP-
010269
077 Rel-4 F Correction of chapter heading and references TI-ATC 4.3.0
T#14 TP-
010269
079 Rel-4 A Different compression algorithms in AT commands +CGDCONT and
+CGDSCONT
TI-ATC 4.3.0
T#14 TP-
010269
080 Rel-5 B New AT command +CRMC (Ring Melody Control) TEI5 5.0.0

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 185 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
T#14 TP-
010269
081 Rel-5 B Added reference to 23.227 TEI5 5.0.0
T#15 TP-
020014
084 Rel-5 A Alignment of UE architecture with 23.101 TEI5 5.1.0
T#16 TP-
020103
085 Rel-6 B Enhancement of AT command +CIND to indicate SMS rejection TEI6 6.0.0
T#17 TP-
020272
089 Rel-6 A Clarification in the behaviour of AT+W46 TEI6 6.1.0
T#19 TP-
030067
097 1 Rel-6 A Clarification in the behaviour of AT+CGCLASS TEI6 6.2.0
T#19 TP-
030037
101 Rel-6 A Correction ATV0 result codes TEI6 6.2.0
T#19 TP-
030071
105 1 Rel-6 A Correction of AT+WS46 parameter values TEI6 6.2.0
T#19 TP-
030037
109 Rel-6 A AT +CGEQREQ - Required Parameters for Streaming / Conversational
Traffic Class
TEI6 6.2.0
T#20 TP-
030113
110 Rel-6 F Correction of references TEI6 6.3.0
T#21 TP-
030212
111 Rel-6 A Adding reference to 24.008 for the 3G QoS AT-commands TEI5 6.4.0
T#24 TP-
040134
116 1 Rel-6 C Updating error codes description to support UICC TEI6 6.5.0
T#25 TP-
040170
117 Rel-6 F Correction to AT command +CHSN HSCSD 6.6.0
T#25 TP-
040170
118 Rel-6 B Support of logical channels in AT commands TEI6 6.6.0
T#26 TP-
040225
120 Rel-6 A Additional parameter for AT command +CRSM (Restricted SIM
access)
TEI5 6.7.0
T#26 TP-
040225
122 Rel-6 A Corrections to AcTs of PLMN Selection TEI5 6.7.0
T#26 TP-
040225
123 Rel-6 C Improve security in UICC generic access command +CGLA TEI6 6.7.0
T#26 TP-
040225
124 Rel-6 B Support of EAP authentication command TEI6 6.7.0
T#26 TP-
040225
125 Rel-6 F Correction of file identification in +CRLA command TEI6 6.7.0
T#26 TP-
040225
126 Rel-6 B UICC Application Discovery Command +CUAD TEI6 6.7.0
T#26 TP-
040225
127 Rel-6 F Clarification on the use of PIN with (U)SIM TEI6 6.7.0
T#26 TP-
040225
128 Rel-6 D Editorial modifications to +CGLA and +CRLA commands TEI6 6.7.0
T#26 TP-
040225
129 Rel-6 B Add RETRIEVE DATA and SET DATA APDU commands in
+CRSM and +CRLA AT commands
TEI6 6.7.0
T#26 TP-
040225
130 Rel-6 B Extension of read, write and find phonebook entry commands for 3G
phonebooks
TEI6 6.7.0
T#27 TP-
050012
131 Rel-6 F Align time zone range of AT+CCLK (CLOCK) TEI 6.8.0
T#27 TP-
050012
132 Rel-6 A Illogical response in +CGDSCONT test command ( REL 6) TEI5 6.8.0
CT#31 CP-
060126
137 Rel-7 F QoS additions for the AT commands +CGEQREQ and +CGEQMIN TEI7 7.0.0
CT#32 CP-
060276 0138
Rel-7
F Access technology added to AT commands +CREG and +CGREG
TEI7 7.1.0
CT#32 CP-
060276 0139
Rel-7
F Enhancement of parameter CI in AT commands +CREG and +CGREG
TEI7 7.1.0
CT#33 CP-
060506 0140
1 Rel-7
F Support for UTF-8 in AT-command +CSCS
TEI7 7.2.0
CT#35 CP-
070155 0141
2 Rel-7
B Addition of preferred network in AT command
TEI7 7.3.0
CT#36 CP-
070371 0147 -
Rel-7
A Extension of AT-command +CEAP
TEI6 7.4.0
CT#36 CP-
070458 0145 1
Rel-7
A Correction for AT-commands +CEAP, +CERP and +CUAD
TEI6 7.4.0
CT#36 CP-
070395 0144 3 Rel-8 B Introduction of the new AT command AT+CPSB TEI8 8.0.0
CT#36 CP-
070395 0148 2 Rel-8 B
Extension of parameter <Act> to include HSDPA- & HSUPA-
capability TEI8 8.0.0
CT#37 CP-
070604 0149 3 Rel-8 C Extension for AT-commands +CPBW, +CPBF and +CPBR TEI8 8.1.0
CT#37 CP-
070604 0150 3 Rel-8 B AT-command +CVMOD to set the voice call preference TEI8 8.1.0
CT#38 CP-
070815 0152 2 Rel-8 B AT-commands for location handling TEI8 8.2.0

ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 186 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
CT#39 CP-
080136 0153 Rel-8 Corrections to +CMOLRG TEI8 8.3.0


ETSI
ETSI TS 127 007 V8.3.0 (2008-04) 187 3GPP TS 27.007 version 8.3.0 Release 8
History
Document history
V8.1.0 January 2008 Publication
V8.2.0 January 2008 Publication
V8.3.0 April 2008 Publication

You might also like